20-F
Table of Contents

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 20-F

 

¨ Registration statement pursuant to Section 12(b) or 12(g) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

or

 

x Annual report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

For the Fiscal Year Ended December 31, 2013

or

 

¨ Transition report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

For the transition period from/to

or

 

¨ Shell company report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

Date of event requiring this shell company report:

Commission file number 000–12033

TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)

LM ERICSSON TELEPHONE COMPANY

(Translation of Registrant’s Name Into English)

Kingdom of Sweden

(Jurisdiction of Incorporation or Organization)

SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden

(Address of Principal Executive Offices)

Roland Hagman, Vice President Group Function Financial Control

Telephone: +46 10 719 53 80, E-mail: roland.hagman@ericsson.com

SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden

(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile Number and Address of Company Contact Person)

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of Each Class

 

Name of Each Exchange on Which registered

American Depositary Shares (each representing one B share)   The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC
B Shares *   The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC

 

* Not for trading, but only in connection with the registration of the American Depositary Shares representing such B Shares pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

None

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:

None

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the Annual Report:

 

B shares (SEK 5.00 nominal value)

     3,043,295,752   

A shares (SEK 5.00 nominal value)

     261,755,983   

C shares (SEK 1.00 nominal value)

     0   

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  x    No  ¨

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.    Yes  ¨    No  x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  x    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  ¨     No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer” and “large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

x  Large accelerated filer             ¨  Accelerated filer             ¨  Non-accelerated filer

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

US GAAP   ¨    International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board  x    Other  ¨

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.     Item 17  ¨     Item 18  ¨

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  ¨    No  x


Table of Contents

CONTENTS

 

FORM 20-F 2013 CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE

     i   

THIS IS ERICSSON

     1   

2013 AT A GLANCE

     3   

LETTER FROM THE CEO

     5   

MARKET TRENDS

     7   

OUR MARKETS

     10   

OUR STRATEGY

     11   

HOW WE CREATE VALUE

     13   

HOW WE WORK

     15   

SUSTAINABILITY AND CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY

     17   

OUR SOLUTIONS

     19   

OUR PERFORMANCE

     23   

REGIONAL DEVELOPMENT

     25   

FIVE-YEAR SUMMARY

     26   

LETTER FROM THE CHAIRMAN

     27   

BOARD OF DIRECTORS’ REPORT

     28   

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

     41   

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     42   

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     49   

MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

     93   

RISK FACTORS

     94   

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

     102   

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT 2013

     104   

REMUNERATION REPORT

     127   

SHARE INFORMATION

     131   

SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION

     135   

RECONCILIATIONS TO IFRS

     150   

GLOSSARY

     152   

FINANCIAL TERMINOLOGY

     153   

SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION

     154   

SIGNATURES

     155   


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

FORM 20-F 2013 CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE

This document comprises the English version of our Swedish Annual Report for 2013 and our Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2013. Reference is made to the Form 20-F 2013 cross-reference table on pages i to vi hereof and the Supplemental Information beginning on page 135, which contains certain other information required by Form 20-F. Only (i) the information in this document that is referenced in the Form 20-F 2013 cross-reference table, (ii) the Supplemental Information, and (iii) the Exhibits required to be filed pursuant to the Form 20-F shall be deemed to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission for any purpose, including incorporation by reference into the Registration Statement on Form F-3 filed on April 23, 2012 (File No. 333-180880) and any other documents filed by us pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, which incorporates by reference the 2013 Form 20-F. Any information herein which is not referenced in the Form 20-F 2013 cross-reference table or filed as an exhibit thereto shall not be deemed to be so incorporated by reference.

This annual report includes financial measures that were not calculated or presented in accordance with IFRS, and we refer to these measures as non-IFRS financial measures. Reconciliations of these non-IFRS financial measures to the most directly comparable IFRS financial measures can be found on pages 150-151 of this annual report.

Market data and certain industry forecasts used herein were obtained from internal surveys, market research, publicly available information and industry publications. While we believe that market research, publicly available information and industry publications we use are reliable, we have not independently verified market and industry data from third-party sources. Moreover, while we believe our internal surveys are reliable, they have not been verified by any independent source.

The information included on the websites that appear in the Annual Report on Form 20-F is not incorporated by reference in the report.

The following cross-reference table indicates where information required by Form 20-F may be found in this document.

 

Form 20-F Item Heading

  

Location in Document

   Page
Number
 

PART I

     

1

  Identity of Directors, Senior management and advisers.    N/A   

2

 

Offer statistics and timetable

   N/A   

3

 

Key information

     
  A   

Selected financial data

   Five-year summary      26   
        Reconciliations to IFRS      150-151   
        Financial terminology      153   
        Supplemental information   
       

Exchange rates

     153   
  B   

Capitalization and indebtedness

   N/A      -   
  C   

Reason for offer and use of proceeds

   N/A      -   
  D   

Risk factors

   Risk factors      94-101   

4

 

Info on the Company

     
  A   

History and development of the Company

   Our Business   
       

2013 at a glance—2013 in review

     4   
       

Board of Directors’ Report

  
       

Business in 2013

     28   
       

Capital expenditures

     31   
       

Notes to the Consolidated financial statements

  
       

Note C26—Business combinations

     84   
       

Supplemental information

  
       

General facts on the Company

     135   
       

Company history and development

     135   

 

i


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Form 20-F Item Heading

  

Location in Document

   Page
Number
 
  B    Business overview      
        Our business   
       

This is Ericsson

     1   
       

Our markets

     10   
       

Our strategy

     11-12   
       

How we create value

     13-14   
       

Our solutions

     19-22   
       

Regional development

     25   
        Board of Directors’ report   
       

Business in 2013

     28   
       

Financial highlights—Research and development, patents and licensing

     30   
       

Financial highlights—Seasonality

     31   
       

Business results—Segments

     32   
       

Business results—Regions

     32-33   
       

Material contracts

     35   
       

Sourcing and supply

     36   
       

Sustainability and corporate responsibility

     36-38   
       

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
       

Note C3—Segment information

     59-61   
        Risk factors   
       

Market, technology and business risks

     94-99   
       

Regulatory, compliance and corporate governance risks

     99-100   
       

Corporate governance report 2013

  
       

Regulation and compliance

     105   
       

Form 20-F 2013 cross reference table

     i   
       

Supplemental information

  
       

Disclosure pursuant to Section 219 of the Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2013 (ITRA)

     147   
  C    Organizational structure      
       

Supplemental information

  
       

General facts on the company

     135   
       

Investments

     148-149   
  D    Property, plants and equipment      
       

Our business

  
       

Sustainability and corporate responsibility

     17-18   
        Supplemental information   
       

Primary manufacturing and assembly facilities

     135   
        Notes to the consolidated financial statements   
       

Note C11—Property, plant and equipment

     67   
       

Note C27—Leasing

     86   
        Board of Directors’ report   
       

Financial highlights—Capital expenditures

     31   
       

Sustainability and corporate responsibility

     36-38   
        Risk factors   
       

Regulatory, compliance and corporate governance risks

     99-100   

4A

  Unresolved staff comments         -   

5

 

Operating and financial review and prospects

        -   
  A    Operating results      
       

Our business

  
       

Our segments

     2   
       

2013 at a glance

     3   
       

Our performance

     23-24   
       

Regional development

     25   
       

Five-year summary

     26   
       

Board of Directors’ report

  
       

Business in 2013

     28   
       

Financial highlights

     28-31   
       

Business results—Segments

     32   
       

Business results—Regions

     32-33   
       

Risk management

     36   
       

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
       

Note C1—Significant accounting policies

     49-57   
       

Note C20—Financial risk management and financial instruments—Foreign exchange risk

     79-80   

 

ii


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Form 20-F Item Heading

  

Location in Document

   Page
Number
 
        Risk Factors   
       

Market, technology and business risks

     94-99   
        Supplemental information   
       

Operating results

     136-142   
  B   

Liquidity and capital resources

     
        Board of Directors’ report   
       

Financial highlights—Balance sheet and other performance indicators

     29-30   
       

Financial highlights—Seasonality

     31   
       

Financial highlights—Capital expenditures

     31   
       

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
       

Note C19—Interest-bearing liabilities

     78   
       

Note C20—Financial risk management and financial instruments

     79-82   
       

Note C25—Statement of cash flows

     83   
        Supplemental information   
       

Financial position

     137-138   
       

Cash flow

     139   
  C   

R&D, Patents and licenses, etc.

     
        Five-year summary      26   
        Our business   
       

How we work—Technology and services leadership

     15   
        Board of Directors’ report   
       

Financial highlights—Research and development, patents and licensing

     30   
        Supplemental information   
       

Financial results of operations—Operating expenses

     136   
        Consolidated financial statements   
       

Consolidated income statement

     42   
  D   

Trend information

   Our business   
       

Market trends

     7-9   
       

Our strategy

     11-12   
  E   

Off-balance sheet arrangements

     
        Board of Directors’ report   
       

Financial highlights—Off-balance sheet arrangements

     31   
       

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
       

Note C14—Trade receivables and customer finance, Transfers of financial assets

     71   
       

Note C24—Contingent liabilities

     83   
  F   

Tabular disclosure of contractual obligations

     
       

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
       

Note C31—Contractual obligations

     92   
6  

Directors, senior management and employees

     
  A   

Directors and senior management

     
        Corporate governance report 2013   
       

Members of the Board of Directors

     114-117   
       

Members of the Executive Leadership Team

     122-123   
  B    Compensation      
       

Board of Directors’ report

  
       

Corporate governance—Remuneration

     34-35   
       

Corporate Governance Report 2013

  
       

Remuneration to Board members

     113   
        Remuneration report      127-130   
       

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
       

Note C17—Post-employment benefits

     73-76   
       

Note C28—Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees

     87-92   
  C    Board practices      
       

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
       

Note C28—Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees Remuneration to the Board of Directors

     87   
       

Corporate governance report 2013

  
       

Board of Directors

     108-110   
       

Committees of the Board of Directors—Audit committee

     111-112   
       

Committees of the Board of Directors—Remuneration committee

     112-113   

 

iii


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Form 20-F Item Heading

  

Location in Document

   Page
Number
 
 

D

   Employees      
        Five-year summary      26   
       

Notes to the Consolidated financial statements

  
       

Note C28—Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees
Employee numbers, wages and salaries

     91   
 

E

   Share ownership      
        Share Information   
       

Shareholders

     134   
        Corporate governance report 2013   
       

Shareholders

     105-106   
       

Members of the Board of Directors

     114-117   
       

Members of the Executive Leadership Team

     122-123   
        Remuneration report   
       

Total remuneration

     128-130   
        Notes to the consolidated financial statements   
       

Note C28—Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees

     87-92   

7

 

Major shareholders and related party transactions

     
  A    Major shareholders      
        Corporate governance report 2013   
       

Shareholders

     105-106   
        Share information   
       

Shareholders

     134   
  B    Related party transactions      
        Notes to the consolidated financial statements   
       

Note C29—Related party transactions

     92   
  C    Interests of experts and counsel    N/A   

8

 

Financial information

     
 

A

  

Consolidated statements and other financial information

     
        Board of Directors’ report   
       

Legal proceedings

     38-39   
       

Parent company—Proposed disposition of earnings

     39-40   
       

Consolidated financial statements

     42-48   
       

Please see also Item 17 cross-references

  
        Report of independent registered public accounting firm      41   
        Notes to the consolidated financial statements      49-92   
        Supplemental information   
       

Memorandum and articles of association—Dividends

     142   
 

B

   Significant changes    N/A   

9

 

The offer and listing

     
 

A

   Offer and listing details      
        Share Information   
       

Share and ADS prices

     133   
 

B

   Plan of distribution    N/A   
 

C

   Markets      
        Share Information   
       

Stock exchange trading

     131   
 

D

   Selling shareholders    N/A   
 

E

   Dilution    N/A   
 

F

   Expenses of the issue    N/A   

 

iv


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

   

Form 20-F Item Heading

  

Location in Document

  

Page
Number

 
 

10

 

Additional information

  
    A    Share capital   

N/A

  
    B    Memorandum and articles of association   
         

Supplemental information

  
         

Memorandum and articles of association

     142-143   
    C    Material contracts      
         

Board of Directors’ report

  
         

Material contracts

     35   
         

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
         

Note C31—Contractual obligations

     92   
    D    Exchange controls      
         

Supplemental information

  
         

Exchange controls

     143   
    E    Taxation      
         

Supplemental information

  
         

Taxation

     143-146   
    F    Dividends and paying agents   

N/A

  
    G    Statement by experts   

N/A

  
    H    Documents on display      
         

Supplemental information

  
         

General facts on the Company

     135   
    I    Subsidiary information   

  
 

11

 

Quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk

     
    A    Quantitative information about market risk      
         

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
         

Note C20—Financial risk management and financial instruments

     79-82   
    B    Qualitative information about market risk      
         

Board of Directors’ Report

  
         

Risk management

     36   
         

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

  
         

Note C20—Financial risk management and financial instruments

     79-82   
         

Corporate governance report 2013

  
         

Management—Risk management

     119-121   
    C    Interim periods   

N/A

  
    D    Safe harbor   

N/A

  
    E    Small business issuers   

N/A

  
 

12

 

Description of securities other than equity securities

     
    A    Debt securities   

N/A

  
    B    Warrants and rights   

N/A

  
    C    Other securities   

N/A

  
    D    American Depositary Shares      
         

Supplemental information

  
         

Depositary fees and charges

     146   
 

PART II

     
 

13

 

Defaults, Dividends, Arrearages and Delinquencies

  

N/A

  
 

14

 

Material modifications to the rights of security holders and use of proceeds

  

N/A

  
 

15

 

Controls and Procedures

     
    A    Disclosure controls and procedures      
         

Corporate governance report 2013

  
         

Disclosure controls and procedures

     124-125   
    B   

Management’s annual report on internal control over financial reporting

     
         

Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting

     93   
    C   

Attestation report of the registered public accounting firm

  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     41   
    D   

Changes in internal control over financial reporting

     
         

Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting

     93   

 

v


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Form 20-F Item Heading

  

Location in Document

   Page
Number
 

16

 

Reserved

     
 

A

   Audit Committee financial expert      
        Corporate governance report 2013   
       

Committees of the Board of Directors—

  
       

Audit Committee—Members of the Audit Committee

     111-112   
 

B

   Code of Ethics      
        Our business   
       

How we work—Governance

     16   
        Corporate governance report 2013   
       

Code of business ethics

     105   
        Form 20-F 2013 cross-reference table   
       

Part III—Item 19—Exhibit 11

     vi   
        Board of Directors’ report   
       

Corporate governance—Business integrity

     33   
 

C

   Principal accountant fees and services      
        Supplemental information   
       

Audit committee pre-approval policies and procedures

     146   
        Notes to the consolidated financial statements   
       

Note C30—Fees to auditors

     92   
 

D

  

Exemptions from the listing standards for Audit Committees

     
        Supplemental information   
       

Corporate governance requirements

     146   
 

E

  

Purchase of equity securities by the issuer and affiliated purchasers

          
 

F

  

Change in registrant’s certifying accountant

          
 

G

   Corporate governance      
        Supplemental information   
       

Corporate governance requirements

     146   
 

H

   Mine safety disclosure         N/A   

PART III

     

17

 

Financial statements

     
       

Consolidated income statement and Consolidated statement of comprehensive income

     42-43   
        Consolidated balance sheet      44   
        Consolidated statement of cash flows      45   
        Consolidated statement of changes in equity      46-48   
        Notes to the consolidated financial statements      49-92   
        Report of independent registered public accounting firm      41   

18

 

Financial statements

   N/A   

19

 

Exhibits

     
     Exhibit 1    Articles of Association *   
     Exhibit 6   

Please see Notes to the consolidated financial statements, Note C1 Significant accounting policies

     49-57   
     Exhibit 7   

For definitions of certain ratios used in this report, please see Financial terminology

     153   
     Exhibit 8    Please see Supplemental Information—Investments      148-149   
     Exhibit 11   

Our Code of business ethics is included on our web site at www.ericsson.com/code-of-business-ethics

  
     Exhibit 12    302 Certifications   
     Exhibit 13    906 Certifications   
     Exhibit 15.1    Consent of independent registered public accounting firm   

 

* (Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 1 to the Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2011 filed by the registrant on April 4, 2012 (File No. 000-12033).)

Note: The Company’s holding in ST-Ericsson SA meets the requirements of Rule 3-09 under Regulation S-X for the provision of separate financial statements of ST-Ericsson SA, a non-listed Swiss company that has a December 31 fiscal year end.

The Company intends to file the financial statements of ST-Ericsson SA as of and for the year ended December 31, 2013 as an amendment to this Annual Report on Form 20-F as soon as practicable after they become available.

 

vi


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

THIS IS ERICSSON

We are a world-leading provider of communications networks, telecom services and support solutions. Here we look at some of the factors that make Ericsson unique.

Life in the Networked Society is becoming a reality for billions of people and millions of businesses around the world. As everything becomes connected, our world is changing. Our lives are changing. At Ericsson, we are proud of the central role we are playing in this evolution, using innovation to empower people, business and society. The solutions we provide allow people to communicate, work, study, do business and live more freely. They help create more efficient and more sustainable societies.

We have been leaders in telecommunications and related services ever since Lars Magnus Ericsson founded the company in 1876. Today, we are expanding into the Information and Communications Technology (ICT) arena, and becoming a major ICT solutions provider.

It is a natural progression: our research and innovations made mobile communications and broadband possible, and those technologies are powering modern technologies such as cloud computing, smart grids, machine-to-machine (M2M) communication and m-commerce. Every time you make a call or use an app on your smartphone, tablet or mobile computer, you are probably using one of our solutions and one of the networks provided or managed by us. When you watch video or TV, there is a good chance that one of our solutions is behind it—maybe even one of the technologies that have won us four Emmy awards.

As well as the advanced technology, we also provide world-leading services, software and infrastructure, mainly to telecom operators.

Ericsson has always been a company driven by innovation—in technology and business. That is why we were the pioneers in managed services. That is why we hold so many standards-essential patents. We see our leadership in technology and services as one of the foundations of our business.

 

   

Some 40 percent of global mobile traffic runs through networks we have supplied

 

   

Every major telecom operator in the world buys solutions or services from Ericsson

 

   

We manage networks that serve more than 1 billion subscribers globally

 

   

With more than 35,000 granted patents, we have one of the industry’s strongest patent portfolios.

 

LOGO

OUR REGIONS

As a global company, we have created an efficient go-to-market organization based on 10 regions. Backed by our collective global knowledge, our regional competence and close customer relationships provide a solid foundation for profitable growth. In each of our regions, we work closely with customers to develop innovative, scalable solutions that help them increase revenue and reduce costs.

We share best practices across regions, which boosts both quality and efficiency. When a successful customer solution is identified and proven in one region, we can roll it out around the world, sharing common processes, methods and tools.

This knowledge-sharing, the expertise and local knowledge gained through working closely with customers combine to create global scale, another of the pillars of our business success.

Operators look to long-term partners such as Ericsson for support in every aspect of their business. To ensure a consistent offering towards all customers and enable economies of scale, the same set of engagement practices operate in each region: Mobile Broadband; Communication Services; Fixed Broadband and Convergence; Managed Services; Operations and Business Support Systems; and Television and Media Management.

BUSINESS UNITS

To best reflect our business, Ericsson reports four business segments. They are reflected in the four business units, each of which is responsible for developing and maintaining its specific portfolio of products, solutions and services.

 

1


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

OUR SEGMENTS

Today, Ericsson has more than 114,000 people serving customers in over 180 countries. Our business is divided into four segments:

 

NETWORKS  

GLOBAL SERVICES

 

SUPPORT SOLUTIONS

 

MODEMS

We provide the network infrastructure needed for mobile and fixed communication, including 2G, 3G and 4G radio networks, and IP core and transport networks. Our cost-efficient networks offer superior performance and ensure a quality user experience.   Through our 64,000 services professionals around the world, we deploy, operate and evolve networks and related support systems. Global Services includes professional services and network rollout.   The Support Solutions segment focuses on software for operations and business support systems (OSS and BSS), as well as TV and media management, and m-commerce.  

A new segment in 2013, for design, development and sales of LTE multi-mode thin modems. The modem portfolio targets smartphone and tablet manufacturers.

Multi-technology and multi-band connectivity is essential for the Networked Society.

Revenue   Market share   Revenue   Market share   Revenue   Market share    
SEK 117.7 BN   estimate   SEK 97.4 BN   estimate   SEK 12.2 BN   estimate    
(2012: 117.3 bn)   25% in network equipment, key segments*   (2012: 97.0 bn)  

13%

in telecom services

  (2012: 13.5 bn)  

25%

in IPTV

   
Operating   Market   Operating   Market   Operating   Market   Operating  
margin   position   margin   position   margin   position   income  
10%   #1   6%   #1   12%   #1   –0.5 BN  
(2012: 6%)   in radio access   (2012: 6%)   in telecom services   (2012: 9%)   in OSS and BSS    

 

* Key segments include Radio, IP and Transport as well as Core.

 

LOGO

 

2


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

2013 AT A GLANCE

A look at some of the most important measures of our performance, and a summary of business highlights from around the world during 2013.

 

LOGO

 

3


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

2013 IN REVIEW

JANUARY – MARCH

 

   

In line with Ericsson’s services strategy to broaden its IT capabilities, the Company announced the intention to acquire Devoteam Telecom & Media operations in France, bringing consulting and systems integration capabilities.

 

   

Ericsson signed managed services agreements comprising fixed and mobile networks for telecom operators in India and Russia. Ericsson is responsible for network operations and field maintenance, and for driving modernization of tools, processes and best practices, in order to maximize operational efficiencies.

 

   

UK operator O2 signed an agreement with Ericsson to provide a 4G/ LTE-compatible core network and to deploy RBS 6000 multi-standard radio base stations for 50% of O2’s radio access network in the UK.

 

   

Ericsson introduced a service to provide testing and verification for devices and applications in its global device labs. Devices can be tested before launch to help make them more network-friendly, as well as to make networks themselves more device-friendly.

 

   

At Mobile World Congress (MWC), Ericsson met numerous customers, showcased a series of world firsts and launched new products and services, including in the areas of mobile broadband, operation and business support systems (OSS and BSS), m-commerce and managed services. Ericsson also announced its network-enabled cloud concept, a business platform that enables operators to generate new revenues and evolve network capabilities.

APRIL – JUNE

 

   

Ericsson announced its intention to acquire Microsoft Mediaroom, making Ericsson a leading player for innovative video distribution and IPTV across multiple networks and devices. The importance of video distribution capabilities is increasing as more and more LTE networks are deployed.

 

   

Energy company E.ON selected Ericsson to operate more than 600,000 smart metering points for its Swedish operations. Ericsson provides a hosted solution, including consulting and systems integration services.

 

   

Ericsson was named the global leader in telecom operations management by industry analyst firm Gartner.

 

   

Following the acquisition of Canadian Wi-Fi company BelAir Networks, Ericsson announced its 3GPP-compliant Wi-Fi network solution. It enables operators to incorporate telecom-grade Wi-Fi into their heterogeneous networks so that smartphone traffic can seamlessly shift between 3GPP and Wi-Fi networks.

 

   

Ericsson reached a milestone by providing managed services to networks that serve 1 billion subscribers.

 

   

Russian operator MTS selected Ericsson to build an LTE network covering approximately half of Russia. Ericsson supplies hardware and services for radio access and core networks. Under the three-year agreement, MTS’s 2G and 3G networks will also be further developed in several Russian regions.

JULY – SEPTEMBER

 

   

Acquisition of Canadian Telcocell broadened Ericsson’s systems integration capabilities for business support systems (BSS) in North America and strengthened its full ICT transformation services. Multi-vendor BSS systems integration and consulting are of great importance at the intersection of IT and telecom.

 

   

South Korean operator LG U+ commercially launched Ericsson’s LTE-Advanced (LTE-A) with carrier aggregation, combining spectrum bands for higher broadband speeds.

 

   

Ericsson and STMicroelectronics completed the split-up of the former ST-Ericsson joint venture on August 2.

 

   

Ericsson announced it would build three Global ICT Centers to support R&D in developing and verifying solutions, bringing innovations to the market faster.

 

   

Redefining the small-cell market, Ericsson announced the Ericsson Radio Dot System: a cellular radio unit that is small enough to fit in a hand, and provides enough indoor network coverage for a crowd. It enables operators and enterprises to offer a complete indoor solution for mobile broadband and voice services.

 

   

Russian operator Rostelecom, a provider of broadband and pay TV, has deployed the world’s largest operator content-delivery network (CDN) through a solution developed and integrated by Ericsson. The CDN is ground-breaking in terms of both capability and geographic span.

OCTOBER – DECEMBER

 

   

To meet the demand from traffic streams generated by innovative cloud services, Ericsson announced a new multiple-application board for the family of Smart Services Routers (SSR). This board is powered by the SNP 4000, a revolutionary processor introduced by Ericsson in March 2013.

 

   

As the world’s first LTE broadcast on a live network, Australian operator Telstra activated Ericsson’s LTE Broadcast solution on its commercial network to deliver high-quality video without buffering.

 

   

Ericsson’s complete Voice-over-LTE (VoLTE) solution was selected by Japanese operator SoftBank Mobile. Ericsson’s VoLTE solution offers telecom-grade HD voice and video calling alongside simultaneous enriched multimedia services on LTE smartphones.

 

   

Ericsson was selected by China Mobile to deploy LTE in 15 provinces in mainland China. Ericsson is the main supplier of the core network and will deploy a radio access network based on its RBS 6000 radio base station. The contract also includes network design and optimization services.

 

   

Japanese operator KDDI selected Ericsson as one of the prime vendors to deploy its LTE system and Evolved Packet Core (EPC) network. This was the first time that KDDI selected Ericsson to implement a radio access network, based on RBS 6000. In addition to network solutions, Ericsson will provide related services such as network rollout and systems integration.

 

4


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

LETTER FROM THE CEO

Ericsson is on a journey of transformation. Building on our technology and services leadership in telecoms, we are becoming a leader in Information and Communications Technology (ICT), a driving force in the Networked Society. Let us look at some milestones from last year, and explore the road ahead.

DEAR SHAREHOLDERS

As the world is changing into a Networked Society, it is starting to transform virtually all industries. The music industry was early out with digital distribution and new business models as a result of mobility, broadband and cloud creating new opportunities. The networks are becoming more relevant not only to people using their smartphones, but also to businesses and society at large. In light of this development, both operators and vendors are making strategic choices based on their respective assets. It is a truly exciting time in the industry.

Let’s look more closely at developments at Ericsson in 2013. In our core business, we redefined the small-cell market with our Radio Dot System. We have established ourselves in the Chinese 4G market with TD-LTE, after a weaker position in 3G where we did not participate in the TD-SCDMA technology. The majority of the European network modernization projects, which put pressure on our margins in recent years, are now behind us; in line with our strategy we now have a strong installed base in Europe. In parallel, we have strengthened in services across North America and are now the leaders in both infrastructure and telecom services in the world’s most advanced ICT market.

We have continued with our strategy of expanding into targeted areas such as TV and media, IP, cloud, as well as OSS and BSS. And we have refocused our position in modems, winding up the ST-Ericsson joint venture and establishing our own thin modems business. We further strengthened our global services capabilities all over the world. And we continue to invest in research and development—SEK 162 billion in the past five years alone. We build on our core assets—our technology and services leadership and our global scale—as part of our constant evolution, something that is vital for maintaining our leading position in a transforming industry.

Our technology leadership is built on our investments in R&D and evidenced by more than 35,000 granted patents, one of the industry’s strongest patent portfolios. During the year we closed an IPR (intellectual property rights) and licensing agreement with Samsung that is important not only to Ericsson but to the whole industry as it shows the benefits of sharing technology on fair, reasonable and non-discriminatory (FRAND) terms. The multi-year agreement, which ends the patent-related legal disputes between the companies, consists of an initial payment and ongoing royalty payments going forward.

Profitability

Our focus on profitability is now starting to pay off, with stable margins in Professional Services and a steady improvement in Networks during the year. Operating income was up from SEK 10.5 billion in 2012 to SEK 17.8 billion in 2013, with our operating margin increasing from 5% to 8%.

In North America we saw a strong start to the year as two major coverage projects peaked, with a subsequent weaker second half of 2013. We expect more capacity projects in Networks, continued momentum for Professional Services and growth in Support Solutions such as TV and media following the acquisition of Mediaroom from Microsoft.

As I mentioned earlier, the big European network modernization projects are coming to an end and we expect the telecom industry in Europe to improve, driven by macroeconomic improvements as well as a recent investment announcement by a large operator that could trigger others to invest.

It was a challenging year in Northeast Asia. This was primarily due to reduced activity and currency headwinds in Japan, where we are approaching completion of a major project, and a structural decline in GSM sales in China.

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

5


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

But late in the year we won important contracts for rolling out 4G both in China and Japan.

And now we have integrated Modems into the business, providing the device connectivity that is so important in the Networked Society.

Growth

From 2012 to 2016, we expect a compound annual growth rate of more than 4% in the market segments that we address, measured in USD, with some variation between market segments and years.

The underlying fundamentals for growth in the industry are intact. Mobile broadband continued to grow, with subscriptions increasing 40% to 2.1 billion during 2013. By 2019, we expect to see 9 billion mobile subscriptions, with three times as many smartphones as today, and 8 billion mobile broadband subscriptions.

Sustainable development was high on the agenda during 2013 and we lead the industry in working holistically with sustainability issues to drive growth in a way that positively impacts the triple bottom line. We focus on the issues where we can make the biggest difference: accessibility and affordability of mobile communication; the energy and materials performance of our products and solutions and our own activities; climate change and urbanization, business ethics, and employee engagement. We have made progress during the year and we will continue to use our strength to ensure that technology is a force for positive, lasting change in the world.

Strategic direction

We have set out a clear long-term strategy framework, where we are determined to evolve to become the industry leader in the Networked Society. This framework has three components:

 

   

Excel in our core business—radio, core and transmission, and telecom services

 

   

Establish leadership in targeted areas—modems, cloud, IP networks, TV and media, as well as OSS and BSS

 

   

Expand business in new areas.

The road ahead

The key focus areas outlined at our 2013 Investor Day remain the foundation for our strategy for 2014 and the years ahead.

 

   

We will continue to pursue profitable growth, by making the most out of our existing footprint, increasing sales in new and targeted areas, increasing the share of IPR and software sales, and improving earnings in network rollout.

 

   

We will continue to reduce costs and improve efficiency, thanks to a better order-to-cash process and structural improvements; by industrializing, centralizing and automating our processes, and getting the most out of our global skills base; and by continuing to implement lean and agile ways of working across our R&D.

 

   

And we will keep on demonstrating commercial excellence, by evolving our infrastructure software model to a complete ICT environment, through consistent price management and by getting a price premium for first-class network performance.

The long-term fundamentals in the industry remain attractive and we are in a strong position to capture the opportunities that lie ahead. To assist me in achieving this, I have a dedicated, global organization with talented employees who work tirelessly to ensure that Ericsson continues to generate sustainable value for our shareholders and customers.

Hans Vestberg

President and CEO

 

6


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

MARKET TRENDS

New ICT solutions are transforming the way people, business and society communicate and collaborate.

The Networked Society brings innovation and progress to private life, business and society. New forms of collaboration, participation and sharing, as well as new ways to meet customer needs and build value, are making the network more and more essential to all aspects of everyday life.

All around the world, people are demanding greater mobility, better broadband and more access to cloud-based services. These three factors are driving the evolution of the Networked Society.

MOBILE BROADBAND OPPORTUNITIES

Connections are the starting point of the Networked Society. There are currently approximately 6.7 billion mobile subscriptions around the world, and the proportion of the global population with mobile network access—known as population coverage—is constantly increasing as more radio base stations are deployed. And the different generations of mobile technology are reaching out to more and more people every year.

GSM/EDGE technology has by far the widest reach today, covering more than 85% of global population. The areas yet to be reached by GSM/EDGE in those countries that use the technology are sparsely populated.

Further expansion of WCDMA/HSPA will be driven by increased user demand for internet access, the growing affordability of smartphones and regulatory requirements to connect the unconnected.

Even in the early days of LTE rollout, at the end of 2012, it was estimated that the technology covered 10% of the world’s population. Looking ahead six years, Ericsson predicts that this will increase to more than 65%.

In 2013, global smartphone shipments outnumbered those of classic feature phones. The 1.9 billion smartphones subscriptions today are mainly in mid-to-high-end markets; the next billion is set to be mass-market phones now being introduced at USD 50-100. The continued growth in smartphones is changing consumer behavior and creating new lifestyles around the world. Another factor is the accelerating usage of tablets of which only around 25% are currently connected to mobile networks.

A large proportion of the increasing data traffic—for smartphones, tablets and computers—comes from video, on websites, and through streaming, downloads, video applications and gaming. Video is more sensitive to network

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

7


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

quality than many other forms of data traffic, a fact that makes network performance even more important.

The opportunities that these factors represent will increase demand for networks, drive the expansion of mobile broadband and pave the way for growth in new information services and data business.

 

LOGO

CHANGING CONSUMER EXPECTATIONS

Today’s social, collaborative and sharing culture brings individual empowerment, new consumption patterns and stronger civic participation. It also brings an expectation of an always-on connection to the network and access to services wherever you are. For many people, a service delivered over the network—rather than ownership—is becoming the preferred way to consume and access content such as music and video, and is also becoming increasingly important in areas such as health, education and other public services.

 

LOGO

INNOVATION IN ENTERPRISES

Industries such as media, commerce, utilities, transportation, health and education are using ICT to create new business and improve performance of today’s operations. New, disruptive players, such as Spotify and Netflix, are challenging the prevailing models of their respective music and television/video industries. This accelerating innovation power is based on the combination of skilled, demanding users who expect better ways to get what they want, the availability of highly capable networks, and powerful ICT-based business platforms.

OPERATOR BUSINESS DEVELOPMENT

Operators are at the center of the development of the Networked Society. Significantly, they are capitalizing on the growth in mobile broadband growth by introducing new pricing and revenue models. Rather than the all-you-can-eat models of a few years ago, we now see better-targeted offerings based on usage patterns, capacity, service bundles, multi-device plans and real-time features such as top-up plans. Operators are also increasing investments in, and focus on, developing new businesses in media and entertainment, cloud and IT services, machine-to-machine communications and enterprise offerings, as well as industry solutions in areas such as connected cars, health services and mobile money.

DIFFERENTIATION THROUGH NETWORK PERFORMANCE

In a smartphone and tablet-centric world, broadband becomes the main enabler and applications a key service model. The consumer and business user experience is increasingly determined by the actual performance of applications, and the network needs not only to provide access but also safeguard and optimize the actual performance of the applications used. Research by Ericsson ConsumerLab provides clear evidence of the business value of a superior consumer experience.

Operators that establish, demonstrate and promote a better user experience can take a lead in terms of satisfaction, loyalty and business value. Ericsson has established an approach to assessing and securing the performance of networks in relation to a real application experience. We call it App Coverage and have developed a set of indicators to measure and ensure network performance in terms of the application experience. We discuss this concept further in the Mobile Broadband section on Page 19.

OPERATOR TRANSFORMATION

Higher data volumes, more devices, demanding applications and new service offerings to consumers, enterprises and industries all increase pressure on operators to meet customer expectations. This calls for a rapid transformation where improved network performance, more efficient processes and better structured OSS and BSS implementations enable the proactivity, agility and performance that the business portfolio requires.

The combination of Ericsson’s technology and services leadership with business expertise and wide network of partners allows us to contribute to both network and business transformation for operators in markets around the world.

 

8


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

OPERATOR EVOLUTION

Many operators are focusing on the user experience as a means of differentiation, with improved customer service and added-value services in order to increase customer loyalty and reduce retention costs. Increased focus on improved efficiency and core business is in many cases leading to new operational practices such as outsourcing and managed services partnerships.

Operators are also taking a sharper strategic focus. The three roles here are representative strategies adopted by several customers:

 

   

Network developers concentrate on connectivity and communication services. Network performance and efficiency are key priorities.

 

   

Service enablers establish systems and platforms that enable new enterprise practices such as IT cloud services and business processes as well as added-value services to enrich the consumer experience.

 

   

Service creators take the lead in providing innovative new services, and are active participants in the establishment of new ecosystems in markets such as digital health, connected cars, smart homes and cities.

Ericsson works closely with operators to support their different strategic development ambitions, providing solutions that grow business and meet the operational priorities of all three roles. Among our key offerings are:

 

   

High-performance networks that meet the most demanding service requirements from users and are open for the development of new business in areas such as new connectivity services, machine-to-machine, IP, heterogeneous networks, cloud and data monetization.

 

   

Network and business transformation to increase efficiency and provide a differentiated customer experience.

 

   

Business support solutions that allow the agile introduction of new pricing models and offerings with appealing combinations of new subscription packages with added-value services and partnerships.

 

   

Systems integration expertise and communication solutions that provide expansion opportunities and new enterprise offerings.

 

   

Platforms and development projects to expand into industry-specific solutions with machine-to-machine and applications for specific industries.

Ericsson’s technical and business expertise and solutions make it possible for operators to explore new roles and capture the new opportunities they can offer.

 

LOGO

 

9


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

OUR MARKETS

Understanding of our customers and their businesses helps us provide innovative offerings that ensure we and they stay ahead in every market.

CUSTOMERS IN MORE THAN 180 COUNTRIES

Ericsson’s business is characterized by long-term relationships, mainly with large telecom operators. We serve more than 500 operator customers, and an increasing number of non-operator customers, in more than 180 countries. We have been in many of these markets for more than 100 years.

We provide solutions and services to all major telecom operators in the world. Sales to telecom operators represent the vast majority of our revenues. Our ten largest customers, of which half are multinational, account for 44% of our net sales.

Our customers operate in a variety of markets and are at various levels of technological maturity. Their business focuses also differ depending on the maturity of their markets.

The installed base of radio networks is the foundation for Ericsson’s business with mobile operators. We are also expanding into other domains such as IP core networks, OSS and BSS, as well as the TV and media markets.

Over the past ten years, we have built a significant services business, representing 43% of net sales in 2013 (42% in 2012). Ericsson pioneered managed services, and continues to be the undisputed leader. Success in areas such as managed services, consulting and systems integration in turn creates opportunities for more business.

 

LOGO

In recent years, we have expanded into TV and media. Users are consuming more video, which is an increasing source of data traffic in mobile networks—35% at the end of 2013. Video is forecast to account for more than half of all mobile network traffic in 2019. In this domain, we can reuse skills, methods and tools from our telecom managed services in the operation of broadcast services for TV and media companies.

Through the acquisition of Tandberg Television in 2007 and Microsoft’s Mediaroom in 2013, we are now also a leader in the IPTV and video compression business, with multi-screen solutions for TV Anywhere.

REINVENTING THE WAY COMPANIES CREATE VALUE

To build the Networked Society, we have to offer our innovations more widely than to operators alone. This requires new ways to extend our reach. Today we also engage directly with customers in selected industry verticals—particularly utilities, transport and public safety.

Our aim is to reuse products, solutions and services for these customers. They either have similar business models to telecom operators, or gain from mobile broadband and the larger opportunity to connect anything that benefits from being connected. Connectivity is helping these sectors reinvent the way they create value.

Sometimes we do business in direct collaboration with these companies, and sometimes together with our operator customers. Business requirements—such as handling large volumes of subscription data, in machine-to-machine applications, for example—are often a common factor. Our strategy is to explore and commercialize emerging opportunities within and between these sectors.

Since the split-up of our joint venture ST-Ericsson in 2013, and the establishment of the Modems segment, handset and device manufacturers have become a new customer segment, to whom we will supply multi-mode thin modems.

 

10


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

OUR STRATEGY

We aim to become a leading Information and Communications Technology (ICT) solutions provider by combining our core assets: Our people, our technology and services leadership, and global scale.

VISION AND MISSION

Ericsson’s vision is to be the prime driver in an all-communicating world. By using innovation to empower people, business and society, we are enabling the Networked Society, in which everything that benefits from a connection will be connected.

 

LOGO

OUR STRATEGY

Ericsson’s strategy builds directly on our vision of a connected world in which broadband, mobility and the cloud combine to create the Networked Society.

The strategy is based on four pillars:

 

   

Excel in networks

 

   

Expand in services

 

   

Extend in support solutions

 

   

Establish a leading position in Networked Society enablers.

We are executing this strategy by leveraging our technology and services leadership combined with our global scale. These competitive advantages, together with the skills and experience of our employees, make Ericsson a true end-to-end business partner for network operators and customers in selected industry verticals as the Networked Society becomes a reality.

Our go-to-market approach is built on business units and regions. The business units develop solutions for specific business areas, while the regions cultivate strong relationships with our customers. This allows us to address customers’ needs, keep them satisfied and ensure we always deliver what we promise.

Our position and our influence also give us an opportunity – and a responsibility – to help address urgent global challenges such as poverty, human rights and climate change.

EXCEL IN NETWORKS

We will excel with a leading portfolio for high-performance networks. Our wanted position is to remain No.1 in networks for service providers and lead the transition to the network architecture that will enable the Networked Society.

 

11


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

We intend to simplify the management of every component of an operator’s network, while exploring opportunities to build new services based on areas such as big data and analytics on top of networks.

As the leader in radio evolution, Ericsson will continue to drive the introduction of new standards and technologies, while defending our existing business with a strong migration story. We can build on our leading position in mobile backhaul and packet core networks to grow our footprint in IP and transport, and use our network experience to create compelling cloud solutions.

EXPAND IN SERVICES

We expect to expand our No.1 position in services for operators by becoming a professional services partner to new types of customers in selected industry verticals. The strength of our services business proves the value of combining local capabilities with global scale, and we will continue with this proven strategy while prioritizing innovation, competence and cost control.

Top of the agenda is ensuring the continued transformation of our professional services capabilities. This means continuing to build capabilities in IT services and ensuring we reuse and standardize as much as possible – a process we refer to as services industrialization. We expect to also expand in product-related services, where we will extend our capabilities in designing and optimizing networks and move into services for heterogeneous networks, wireless networks that use a range of access technologies.

We expect to continue to lead in managed services. At the same time, we intend to build our consulting and systems integration competencies further, with an increased focus on extending our OSS, BSS and IP network transformation offerings, and continuing to explore opportunities in industry verticals.

EXTEND IN SUPPORT SOLUTIONS

Our priority is to extend our support solutions business with OSS and BSS as well as TV and media solutions to get the most out of networks. Ericsson strives to provide solutions that contribute to the best customer experience, business innovation and business efficiency.

We intend to build on our extensive installed OSS and BSS base to strengthen our position even further. In particular, we continue to focus on customer experience management and analytics, cloud and next-generation business intelligence. In addition, we intend to use our m-commerce strength in developing markets to provide banking capabilities to everyone. Our acquisition of Microsoft’s Mediaroom shows our commitment to capturing the opportunities created by the ongoing transformation of TV and media. Our ambition is to be the industry’s TV and media partner of choice, and we strive to enable the most efficient video-delivery networks, exploit the growing need for on-demand content management and lead in the multi-screen and multi-platform market.

ESTABLISH A LEADING POSITION IN NETWORKED SOCIETY ENABLERS

With the Networked Society becoming a reality, we are establishing ourselves in the emerging new business landscape. Building on our technology and services leadership with intellectual property rights, machine-to-machine platforms and modems, we are creating new business with players across the selected industry verticals of the utility, transportation and public safety industries.

Ericsson’s capabilities, combined with our proven record of commercializing advanced ICT solutions, position us perfectly to build solutions that bring new innovative capabilities into these industry verticals while providing new efficiencies of scale.

LONG-TERM STRATEGY FRAMEWORK

Evolving to be the industry leader in the Networked Society, based on our core business, we expect to grow in targeted areas and invest in new areas.

 

   

We are focusing on increasing profit from the portfolio in our core business.

 

   

We aim to establish leadership in the targeted areas of OSS and BSS, TV and Media, IP Networks, Cloud and Modems.

 

   

We are seeking to expand business in new areas that are critical to the Networked Society and where our capabilities will make a significant difference.

As we allocate capital to support this strategy, investment in services capabilities goes hand in hand with investment in product development. Our growth strategy, leveraging our market footprint, is primarily through organic growth, but also in combination with acquisitions and partnerships.

 

12


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

HOW WE CREATE VALUE

Ericsson develops and applies various business models for different types of businesses and different parts of the portfolio. Here we discuss two of our main business models targeting telecom operators.

Ericsson has worked for many years with large network-infrastructure projects. The operation of the resulting complex networks created a demand for managed services. The advent of mobile data led to a need for software-based support systems to monetize data services. Over the years, the business models have evolved to meet customer demand. All have similar basic investment-to-value models, but with some significant differences.

They all start with an initial investment phase, such as research and the development of new products, solutions and services.

The early phases of both infrastructure coverage and managed services projects have lower margins and profits, as explained in the diagrams on the next page. Profitability improves in both cases as the projects develop and mature.

 

LOGO

 

13


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

MOBILE BROADBAND INFRASTRUCTURE BUSINESS MODEL

Our most traditional business model is in network infrastructure, delivering and rolling out a physical network including all necessary hardware and software. The first phase involves building coverage across one or more geographical areas and often includes network rollout services. Subsequent phases include increasing network capacity, and adding functionality. Services include network design and optimization, and systems integration.

The initial build and rollout phase can take several years, is capital-intensive, open to competitive bidding, and usually involves lower margins. The later phases, extending the capacity and functionality of the established footprint, often involve a lower share of hardware but more professional services and software, which can be deployed remotely. These phases generally produce higher margins. The differing nature of the phases makes it important that we find a beneficial mix of coverage and capacity projects, in order to secure a good balance between growth and profitability.

 

LOGO

MANAGED SERVICES BUSINESS MODEL

A different model applies to our managed services business. We take over aspects of a customer’s business operation, or even the entire operation, for a period of up to seven years. Staff and expertise are often transferred from the customer to Ericsson. The initial transition and transformation phases can involve significant costs up front. But by simplifying, implementing and consolidating resources, tools, methods and processes, we step by step reduce the costs and improve our returns. Most such contracts are subsequently renewed. We have a good balance of contracts in the transition, transformation and optimization phases – with the vast majority of the business in the optimization phase – which has a beneficial effect on revenue and cash flow.

 

LOGO

 

14


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

HOW WE WORK

Our competitive advantages and core values, our people and our ways of working, all combine to ensure we are always innovative and efficient, and do business responsibly and sustainably.

TECHNOLOGY AND SERVICES LEADERSHIP

Innovative solutions and unparalleled service offerings

We support our customers in the new ICT landscape by combining the advantages of our leadership in technology and services capabilities.

Our technical expertise is driven by innovation, research and development, delivering high network performance and enabling our customers to be first to market where it matters. We hold one of the largest patent portfolios in the industry, with more than 35,000 granted patents worldwide. We supplied the world’s first LTE network and have maintained our leading LTE position since the first rollout of LTE in 2009. We are also a leading support systems provider.

Ericsson is also the largest telecom services provider in the world, supporting operators in creating competitive, attractive and appealing offerings to consumers, while providing managed services to networks that serve more than 1 billion subscribers worldwide. We pioneered managed services for the telecom industry more than 10 years ago and remain the leader today.

GLOBAL SCALE

Local presence combined with global scale

With operations and customers in more than 180 countries, we have established relationships with all the world’s major telecom operators. We use worldwide standards, combined with global economies of scale in research and development, production and service delivery, to ensure that our products and services are efficient and of high quality wherever they are deployed.

Our technology handles approximately 40% of the world’s mobile traffic and around 50% of all global LTE smartphone traffic goes through networks delivered by Ericsson. Our capabilities and business understanding in telecom, datacom and media are prerequisites for large-scale ICT transformation projects. Every year, we deliver approximately 1500 consulting, systems integration and learning services projects in multi-vendor and multi-technology environments.

Ericsson’s core values

Our values are the foundation of our culture. They guide us in our daily work, in how we relate to each other and the world around us, and in the way we do business.

 

 

LOGO

 

15


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

OUR PEOPLE

People have made Ericsson what it is today. Our people with their ingenuity and professionalism are at the heart of the success we achieve today and aspire to tomorrow. By working with Ericsson, they are helping build the Networked Society and create a more sustainable world.

 

LOGO

Our people work with us because we can help them fulfill their career ambitions and reward their effort and commitment. Working for Ericsson encourages and stimulates creativity and initiative in an environment that embraces innovation and rapid change.

To attract the best people, help them reach their full potential and engage them on the way, our People Strategy has four objectives:

Attract talent

To attract exceptional talent, we take a strategic approach to becoming an employer of choice wherever we operate. We want to be recognized as the company that will fulfill the personal and career ambitions of a potential employee.

Develop talent

Talent needs to be nurtured and encouraged, and we place great emphasis on identifying talented professionals early in their careers. We have a structured approach to identifying and assessing talent, and have created an environment in which employees can achieve their full potential. Our comprehensive career and competence model, supported by online and classroom training from Ericsson Academy and on-the-job development helps employees to build their careers and develop capabilities that contribute to the company’s continued success.

 

LOGO

Develop leaders

Strong leaders are essential for Ericsson to keep our technology and services leadership amid evolving business conditions. That is why we constantly reexamine the leadership skills and competencies required to maintain our leading position. An annual process identifies, assesses and develops people to assume strategic roles in the company. Our leadership pipeline is under continual review to ensure that we develop the right leadership capabilities at all levels in the organization.

Embrace diversity

Different people bring different points of view and different solutions to challenges – essential factors in our constant search for better, more effective solutions for our customers. We strive for our management teams and employee base to be as diverse as the world in which we live.

A diverse and inclusive workforce drives innovation and leads to high-performing teams and superior business results.

TOOLS, METHODS AND PROCESSES

As a global organization, Ericsson uses a system of standardized tools, processes and methods to ensure simplicity and efficiency, guarantee aligned service offerings and quality levels, and deliver economies of scale.

Our regional organizations, all of which include six engagement practices, allow us to identify best practices, methods and processes from any individual market, and then adapt and reuse them globally.

The Ericsson Group Management System (EGMS) is used in all operations covering all units around the world. Its consistency and global reach helps ensure that the way we work meets the objectives of Ericsson’s major stakeholders, building trust. The EGMS framework defines structure, rules and requirements for compliance with applicable laws, listing requirements, governance standards and other requirements.

In addition, we employ a system of audits and assessments to determine compliance and to provide valuable information for understanding, analyzing and continually improving performance.

GOVERNANCE

Good corporate governance forms the basis for building a robust corporate culture throughout a global organization. Ericsson maintains a constant focus on corporate governance issues including the establishment of efficient and reliable controls and procedures, and on promoting sustainable and responsible business practices. It is crucial that such business practices are valued and followed by all people in the organization.

All Ericsson employees are responsible for adhering to Ericsson’s Code of Business Ethics, which summarizes the Group’s basic policies and directives, and emphasizes the importance of integrity in all business activities.

 

16


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

SUSTAINABILITY AND CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY

Sustainability and corporate responsibility are integral aspects of our business, reflected in our strategy and governance.

Ericsson aims to lead the industry in providing significant and measureable contributions to a sustainable Networked Society. Through our commitment and actions, we demonstrate that we are a trusted partner for our stakeholders.

Our Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility program has three key focus areas closely connected to our business and where we can have the greatest impact:

 

   

Conducting business responsibility

 

   

Maximizing environmental and energy performance

 

   

Advocating Technology for Good.

CONDUCTING BUSINESS RESPONSIBLY

Ericsson is committed to upholding the UN Global Compact Principles, and reported in line with the Global Compact Advanced level for the first time in 2013.

We are also committed to the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights, and work actively to respect human rights throughout our operations.

In Myanmar we received a Corporate Social Responsibility Special Recognition Award from Télécoms Sans Frontiéres. Ericsson was also recognized by Swedish insurance company Folksam as a “role model company” for our work with human rights.

As part of our zero tolerance for corruption, we have continued to develop our anti-corruption program. This included a new version of an anti-corruption e-learning course which has now been completed by approximately 85,000 employees.

MAXIMIZING ENVIRONMENTAL AND ENERGY PERFORMANCE

We continue to improve energy efficiency across our entire portfolio. Our latest generation of network infrastructure equipment provides better performance than previous generations while consuming less electricity.

Examples include:

 

   

The RBS 6000 radio base station, part of our core portfolio, which provides energy-efficient coverage and capacity.

 

   

Increasing deployment of our energy-efficient Psi coverage solution in markets such as Egypt, Bangladesh, Brazil and Turkey. These deployments have shown energy savings of 40% compared with traditional solutions.

 

   

By reducing indoor cell sizes and bringing the network closer to users, the Radio Dot System can reduce indoor solution power requirements. It also prolongs the battery life of devices such as smartphones and tablets frequently used in enterprise environments.

 

   

Our own operations are also yielding significant energy savings, in areas such as business travel, the efficiency of Ericsson facilities and the way we ship our products. We are working toward a five-year target of reducing CO2 emissions per employee by 30% and keeping absolute CO2 emissions at 2011 levels, despite forecast growth in sales and employees.

 

   

When we take back our products, we reuse or recycle 98% of the materials. We also continued to expand our ecology management program in 2013.

 

LOGO

 

17


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

SUSTAINABILITY ADVOCACY

In early 2013, the Broadband Commission on Digital Development established a Task Force on Sustainable Development, chaired by our CEO Hans Vestberg, to explore some of the issues surrounding how broadband can best contribute to development goals. The Ericsson-led Broadband Commission Task Force report “Transformative Solutions for 2015 and Beyond” examines the role broadband and ICT can play as transformative solutions for achieving sustainable development for all.

Hans Vestberg was also a member of the Leadership Council for the Sustainable Development Solutions Network, which submitted a report to the UN Secretary-General, “An Action Agenda for Sustainable Development,” in 2013.

Our Energy and Carbon Report analyzed the growing use of ICT. It showed that while the expansion of ICT is stimulating economic growth and development, the resulting increase in carbon emissions is expected to be marginal, with the sector as a whole not seen as contributing more than 2% of global CO2 emissions.

At Ericsson’s NEST thought-leadership event in 2013, we announced a collaboration with UN-Habitat for research and involvement in promoting sustainable cities, getting maximum value out of ICT investments, and carrying out collaborative research and specific initiatives that provide valuable insights for city leaders and policy makers.

TECHNOLOGY FOR GOOD

Our Technology For Good program continues to work with several initiatives helping people and communities address global challenges at the local, regional and international levels.

Connect to Learn is a global initiative providing quality secondary education to children, especially girls, worldwide. From its inception in 2010 up to late 2013, Connect to Learn had been established in 15 countries in cooperation with 10 operators. The initiative benefits nearly 40,000 students in schools across three continents.

Our work with Refugees United progressed over the year with the launch of the service in the Democratic Republic of Congo. By year-end, there were more than 250,000 refugees registered on the platform, so we are a quarter of the way toward our 2015 goal of helping 1 million people separated by conflict or disaster come in contact with loved ones.

Ericsson supported the Whitaker Development and Peace Initiative’s (WPDI) Harmonizer program in Mexico. Harmonizer encourages social change and transformation in urban areas affected by violence and conflict, while the WPDI provides training in areas such as conflict resolution, community building and ICT for vulnerable youth living through the aftermath of violence and conflict.

This project is part of the Youth Peacemaker Network (YPN), a program that has been already established by the WPDI in South Sudan and Uganda, where Ericsson is also a partner. The YPN is a global initiative that seeks to nurture a new generation of leaders committed to reconciliation and conflict prevention.

At the request of our partners at the World Food Programme and the Emergency Telecommunications Cluster, Ericsson Response, our employee volunteer program, deployed volunteers to the Philippines in response to the disaster caused by the super typhoon Haiyan/Yolanda. The wireless internet access provided to more than 2,500 humanitarian aid workers allowed them to organize their disaster relief operations.

 

18


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

OUR SOLUTIONS

We have the competence, the skills and the solutions our customers need to tackle the challenges of today and tomorrow.

MOBILE BROADBAND

 

   

Providing, upgrading and transforming network infrastructure

 

   

Supporting operators in adoption of new data-centric business models

 

   

Helping operators meet demand by introducing the ‘App Coverage’ approach

 

   

Building heterogeneous networks using small cells, improving indoor and urban coverage

Mobile data traffic continued to grow rapidly in 2013. The rising number of smartphone subscriptions is a key driver for mobile data traffic growth, together with the fact that users are consuming more data per subscription – mainly driven by video. Total smartphone subscriptions reached 1.9 billion during 2013 and the number of subscriptions for mobile PCs, tablets and mobile routers reached 300 million. The majority of mobile broadband subscribers are connected using 3G/WCDMA networks, but increasing numbers are gaining access to 4G/LTE.

With our offerings, operators can cost-effectively meet consumer and enterprise demand for services anywhere, anytime. Besides increasing coverage, speed and capacity, operators are differentiating their services and adapting them to new business models.

 

LOGO

LOGO

A change in perspective

Operators need new ways to define performance so they can build and manage their networks in the most efficient way. Ericsson’s “App Coverage” concept advances the definition of performance beyond traditional population coverage, measuring whether a network delivers the performance required to run a particular application with acceptable quality.

Using this app-centric approach, our services and tools help operators determine where and when coverage and capacity need to be added or improved for an optimal user experience.

To increase network coverage and capacity in densely populated urban areas, we are building heterogeneous networks, improving our macro radio base stations while complementing them with smaller base stations including Wi-Fi. This provides the required App Coverage and sufficient capacity in high-load areas, such as malls, transport hubs, hotels and offices.

We expect LTE to keep expanding from 175 million subscriptions in 2013, reaching around 2.6 billion in 2019 and covering more than 65% of the world’s population. We also see 2G/GSM/ EDGE networks continuing to be an important part of the ecosystem, and a complement to 3G/WCDMA/HSPA and 4G/LTE coverage.

The building blocks

We build network infrastructure with the following main components:

 

   

The RBS 6000 multi-standard platform for radio base stations. It supports GSM/EDGE, CDMA, WCDMA/HSPA and LTE in a single unit, ensuring a smooth transition to new technologies. Upgrades and expansions usually involve software and services, often delivered remotely.

 

   

The Ericsson Blade System for network control functionality in fixed and mobile core networks.

 

   

The SSR 8000 family of smart services routers for network gateways. The multi-application, high-capacity platform improves network performance and supports service differentiation in fixed and mobile networks.

 

   

Optimized backhaul solutions. The introduction of heterogeneous networks means many new sites, challenging traditional solutions for backhaul and synchronization. Our backhaul solutions use technologies such as microwave, optical and satellite.

 

19


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

   

Our network design and optimization services ensure that networks can handle high levels of data traffic while maintaining service quality and user experience.

 

   

Ericsson’s network rollout services.

COMMUNICATION SERVICES

 

   

New opportunities for communication between people, enterprises and machines

 

   

Evolution driven by Voice over LTE (VoLTE), High Definition Voice and Video, Enriched Communication Services, all enabled by IP Multimedia Subsystem (IMS)

 

   

Cloud-based solutions, such as the Device Connection Platform, pushing the borders of communication beyond people

Consumers and business users want to communicate with more people, in more contexts and for more reasons than ever before. Operators are using this growing demand to drive business, providing new functionality and richer offerings across networks, devices and country borders.

Operators are already providing communication services, such as voice, text and multimedia messaging based on industry standards, ensuring global interoperability across all devices and all subscriptions.

Our IMS solutions enable operators to offer communication in new ways, such as high-definition voice, video calling and conferencing, multi-party chat with presence information, and screen sharing. IMS is also providing Voice and video over LTE (VoLTE), enhancing the user experience and reducing costs. In addition we offer machine-to-machine solutions to operators as a cloud service.

We help operators leverage the value of their networks by exploiting these new opportunities, providing enhanced communication services that are secure, reliable and simple to use.

All our applications are moving to virtualized deployments, complying with the ongoing Network Functions Virtualization industry group’s specifications.

FIXED BROADBAND AND CONVERGENCE

 

   

Fourth-generation IP network portfolio

 

   

Real-time cloud capabilities

 

   

Unlocks full potential of mobility, video and the cloud

Legacy telecom networks were designed to deliver a limited number of services. Our IP-based multi-service networks create opportunities for operators to unlock the full potential of mobility, video and the cloud.

Our fourth-generation IP network portfolio allows operators to use their complete network as a single business resource as opposed to the fragmented and complex reality of most legacy networks. It also allows for increasingly virtualized network features, adding flexibility and paving the way for cooperation with new partners.

As a first step we introduced the ability to deliver telephony, internet and TV over fixed and mobile broadband networks. By combining operators’ software-defined networks (SDN) and cloud solutions, we are now adding real-time

LOGO

 

20


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

capabilities to the cloud – essential qualities for evolving consumer and enterprise services and to create new vertical applications in areas such as safety and traffic monitoring.

LOGO

MANAGED SERVICES

 

   

Experience-centric engagement approach allows operators to get more out of managed services

 

   

Managing and evolving network and IT environments for operators to improve efficiency and strengthen competitiveness

 

   

Established in media, the cloud and IT Managed Services, expanding into utilities and transport sectors

Managed services traditionally involve taking over activities operators once handled in-house, from designing, planning and building a network, to managing operations. The main driving factor has been cost savings, but as competitive pressures have increased, operators have also needed to adapt their positions in the value chain.

We have developed managed services as a way to enhance the customer experience and increase business differentiation. We create new value by combining technical, service and customer experience expertise. Our experience-centric approach enhances the performance that subscribers actually get. Starting with the operator’s business objectives, we define the level of customer experience necessary to meet those objectives and work together to make it happen.

Our traditional telecom managed services model focuses on reducing cost and complexity. Other models such as wholesale network sharing allow operators to choose between investing in their own infrastructure and sharing it to varying degrees with partners.

We handle complex issues such as convergence, quality and capacity management, while freeing up operator resources to focus on strategy, marketing and customer care.

We provide managed services to networks that serve more than 1 billion subscribers in more than 100 countries. These networks are typically multi-vendor, multi-technology environments, with more than half the equipment coming from non-Ericsson sources. We operate four Global Network Operations Centers (GNOCs) offering a universal approach to managed services based on years of innovation and global best practice. We rely on our global set of tools, methods and processes, and invest to ensure they remain at the leading edge.

We are expanding our established model for network and IT managed services to adjacent areas such as cloud services, TV and media, and selected industry verticals.

OPERATIONS AND BUSINESS SUPPORT SYSTEMS (OSS AND BSS)

 

   

Enabling operators to become agile

 

   

Providing systems to manage increasingly complex networks and services

 

   

Solutions to improve user experience and to create new business opportunities

OSS and BSS are used to run the networks – not just from a technical perspective, but also to manage how services are delivered and paid for, keep track of revenues and maintain customer relationships.

The shift in focus from voice to data services is both a challenge and an opportunity for operators. The growth of mobile broadband is leading operators to evolve their OSS and BSS in order to monetize the increasing amount of data flowing through their networks while managing the increasing complexity of networks and services. Our solutions cater for user needs and help identify new revenue streams, in addition to running and maintaining operations. Our extensive expertise and global experience makes us unique in our approach to OSS and BSS.

We enable our customers to become more agile – fast, flexible and in control of their business in a dynamic and fast-paced market. Our solutions help them capture, analyze and report user data, providing insights for more cost-efficient business decisions, identifying new revenue streams and enabling increased personalization and user control.

Our portfolio is designed around measurable performance improvement in an operator’s business processes, with software that is scalable, configurable and which provides end-to-end capabilities. This, together with our expertise in consulting and systems integration, makes us a world-class software company.

The integration of the former Telcordia products, and those of ConceptWave, has contributed to our comprehensive OSS and BSS portfolio.

 

LOGO

 

21


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

LOGO

TV AND MEDIA MANAGEMENT

 

   

A broad suite of standards-based solutions, products and services

 

   

Enabling content owners, broadcasters, TV service providers and network operators to create and deliver the future of TV on all consumer devices

 

   

Managing and monetizing the strong growth in video traffic

TV is transforming into an immersive, connected and social experience on every smart device a consumer owns and interacts with. The convergence of media and telecoms, especially through the global uptake of mobile broadband, is accelerating a change in the way consumers get premium entertainment. It also changes industry players’ roles in that value chain.

Our position in this transformation – with 20 years of media and video experience, and global leadership in networks and telecoms – is a crucial advantage to our customers as we help them innovate in TV Anywhere services and manage the strong growth in data traffic driven by video.

Our Mediaroom and Multiscreen TV solutions – enabling TV service providers to deliver on the TV Anywhere future – is powering more than 70 TV services for over 14 million subscribers. Our On-Demand Content Management Solution provides the content management and packaging needed to ensure unified access to infinite amounts of relevant content.

Ericsson’s Media Delivery Network solution, LTE Broadcast and advanced video compression transform video efficiency, while maximizing the value of content and network assets.

Our broad portfolio is enhanced by global services capability to consult, integrate and manage business operations for TV.

CONNECTED DEVICES

 

   

Complete solutions for device connectivity

 

   

Compact ‘modems-on-a-chip’ for smartphones, tablets and other small devices

Following the 2013 split-up of the ST-Ericsson joint venture between STMicroelectronics and Ericsson, Ericsson will offer LTE multi-mode thin modem solutions, including 2G, 3G and 4G interoperability. Device manufacturers will get a complete solution to ensure end-to-end device support and network functionality.

Our modems are designed for smartphones, tablets and other connected devices, important for our vision of 50 billion connected devices in the Networked Society.

Our modems support all major access technologies.

The Ericsson Device Connection Platform (DCP) is a cloud service enabling operators to offer connectivity management to enterprise customers. It enables operators to address new revenue streams from a variety of devices while simplifying the process and reducing the cost of connecting them.

OPPORTUNITIES IN INDUSTRY VERTICALS

 

   

Creating new value for non-operator businesses through ICT innovation

The rapid proliferation of connected devices, self-service applications, machine-to-machine communication and automation is changing the way companies do business. The mobile network is fundamental to this development and we serve several select industry verticals, specifically, utilities, the transport sector and public safety.

Our resources in technology, consulting, systems integration and managed services on a global scale give us a unique position. This lets us support customers with everything from connectivity to customer relationship management – not just with technology but also from a business transformation perspective.

 

22


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

OUR PERFORMANCE

Our overall goal is to create shareholder value. We use a range of financial and non-financial targets to drive business performance.

 

What we aim for     

GROWING SALES FASTER

THAN

THE MARKET

  

BEST-IN-CLASS OPERATING

MARGIN

Why we measure it      Outperforming our market confirms the validity of our strategic direction.    A clear focus on operating margins demonstrates our commitment to profitable growth.

 

Our performance

    

 

LOGO

  

 

LOGO

 

23


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

What we aim for    STRONG CASH CONVERSION    EMPLOYEE ENGAGEMENT    CUSTOMER SATISFACTION
Why we measure it    A strong cash position supports new business activity, enables appropriate acquisition opportunities and provides resilience to external economic volatility.    Engaged employees are motivated to contribute to the success of Ericsson and are willing to go the extra mile to meet the organization’s goals.    Customer satisfaction is a prerequisite for customer loyalty. We strive to ensure that our customers perceive us as a thought leader and their preferred business partner.
Our performance    LOGO   

LOGO

 

Our score is 8 percentage points higher than the external benchmark average, as measured across over 250 companies. We started to measure the engagement index in 2011.

   LOGO

 

24


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

REGIONAL DEVELOPMENT

Ericsson is a truly global player, with customers in more than 180 countries. We have been present in many countries, such as China, Brazil and India, for more than 100 years.

NORTH AMERICA

Net sales: SEK 59.3 SEK billion (+5%).

Networks sales declined. The first half of the year was strong as a result of the two large mobile broadband coverage projects that peaked, while the second half was weaker. While executing on the large rollout projects in the US, Ericsson has also strengthened its professional services position and capabilities. Global Services sales increased by 20%.

LATIN AMERICA

Net sales: SEK 22.0 billion (+0%).

LTE deployments ramped up after a slow start and together with 3G network quality investments drove sales growth for the full year 2013. However, macroeconomic development in mainly Brazil and Mexico continued to slow down during the year.

NORTHERN EUROPE AND CENTRAL ASIA

Net sales: SEK 11.6 billion (+2%).

The sales growth was mainly driven by Networks sales in Russia. Operators continued to show high interest in OSS and BSS.

WESTERN AND CENTRAL EUROPE

Net sales: SEK 18.5 billion (+6%).

The sales growth was driven by network modernization projects in several countries and also by a high activity level in managed services.

MEDITERRANEAN

Net sales: SEK 24.2 billion (+4%).

Sales grew, driven by 3G deployments in Northwest Africa and modernization projects.

MIDDLE EAST

Net sales: SEK 17.4 billion (+12%).

Sales grew, driven by increased investments in mobile broadband.

SUB-SAHARAN AFRICA

Net sales: SEK 10.0 billion (–11%).

Sales came from 2G and 3G deployment and managed services, although the deployment pace slowed down in the latter part of the year. Long-term industry fundamentals remain positive as mobile broadband and smartphone penetration is still at low levels.

INDIA

Net sales: SEK 6.1 billion (–5%).

Sales were negatively impacted by poor macroeconomic environment and delays in regulatory legislation. Global Services grew largely due to an increase in managed services.

NORTH EAST ASIA

Net sales: SEK 27.4 billion (–24%).

Sales declined. Japan was negatively impacted by currency and reduced activity. GSM in China structurally declined whilst LTE deployments commenced towards the end of the year. In Japan, KDDI has selected Ericsson as one of the prime vendors to deploy its LTE system and evolved packet core network.

SOUTH EAST ASIA AND OCEANIA

Net sales: SEK 15.8 billion (+5%).

Sales grew, with 3G deployments in Thailand and LTE deployments in Singapore and Australia. In Indonesia major capacity projects were finalized. Smartphone penetration continued to increase from a low level.

OTHER

Net sales: SEK 15.0 billion (+22%).

Includes revenues generated across all regions through licensing, sales of cables, broadcast services, power modules and other businesses. Sales increased, positively impacted by the Samsung agreement but negatively impacted by the divestment of IPX in 2012 and the exit of the power cable businesses in 2013.

 

25


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

FIVE-YEAR SUMMARY

For definitions of the financial terms used, see Glossary and Financial terminology.

Five-year summary

 

      2013     Change     2012     2011     2010     2009  

Income statement items, SEK million

                                    

Net sales

     227,376        0     227,779        226,921        203,348        206,477   

Operating income

     17,845        71     10,458        17,900        16,455        5,918   

Financial net

     –747        —          –276        221        –672        325   

Net income

     12,174        105     5,938        12,569        11,235        4,127   

Year-end position

                                    

Total assets

     269,190        –2     274,996        280,349        281,815        269,809   

Working capital as defined1)

     106,940        6     100,619        109,552        105,488        99,079   

Capital employed as defined1)

     180,903        2     176,653        186,307        182,640        181,680   

Gross cash as defined1)

     77,089        0     76,708        80,542        87,150        76,724   

Net cash as defined1)

     37,809        –2     38,538        39,505        51,295        36,071   

Property, plant and equipment

     11,433        –1     11,493        10,788        9,434        9,606   

Stockholders’ equity

     140,204        2     136,883        143,105        145,106        139,870   

Non-controlling interest

     1,419        –11     1,600        2,165        1,679        1,157   

Interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits

     39,280        3     38,170        41,037        35,855        40,653   

Per share indicators

                                    

Earnings per share, basic, SEK, as defined

     3.72        107     1.80        3.80        3.49        1.15   

Earnings per share, diluted, SEK, as defined

     3.69        107     1.78        3.77        3.46        1.14   

Cash flow from operating activities per share, SEK

     5.39        –21     6.85        3.11        8.31        7.67   

Cash dividends per share, SEK, as defined

     3.00 2)      9     2.75        2.50        2.25        2.00   

Cash dividends per ADS, USD

     0.47 2)      12     0.42        0.38        0.37        0.28   

Stockholders’ equity per share, SEK, as defined

     43.39        2     42.51        44.57        45.34        43.79   

Number of shares outstanding (in millions)

                                    

end of period, basic

     3,231        —          3,220        3,211        3,200        3,194   

average, basic

     3,226        —          3,216        3,206        3,197        3,190   

average, diluted

     3,257        —          3,247        3,233        3,226        3,212   

Other information, SEK million

                                    

Additions to property, plant and equipment

     4,503        –17     5,429        4,994        3,686        4,006   

Depreciation and write-downs/impairments of property, plant and equipment

     4,209        5     4,012        3,546        3,296        3,502   

Acquisitions/capitalization of intangible assets

     4,759        —          13,247        2,748        7,246        11,413   

Amortization and write-downs/impairments of intangible assets

     5,928        1     5,877        5,490        6,657        8,621   

Research and development expenses

     32,236        –2     32,833        32,638        31,558        33,055   

as percentage of net sales

     14.2     —          14.4     14.4     15.5     16.0

Ratios

                                    

Operating margin

     7.8     —          4.6     7.9     8.1     2.9

EBITA margin as defined1)

     9.8     —          6.6     9.9     11.0     6.7

Cash conversion as defined1)

     79     —          116     40     112     117

Return on equity as defined1)

     8.7     —          4.1     8.5     7.8     2.6

Return on capital employed as defined1)

     10.7     —          6.7     11.3     9.6     4.3

Equity ratio as defined

     52.6     —          50.4     51.8     52.1     52.3

Capital turnover as defined

     1.3        —          1.3        1.2        1.1        1.1   

Inventory turnover days as defined

     62        —          73        78        74        68   

Trade receivables turnover as defined

     3.4        —          3.6        3.6        3.2        2.9   

Payment readiness, SEK million, as defined

     82,631        –3     84,951        86,570        96,951        88,960   

as percentage of net sales

     36.3     —          37.3     38.1     47.7     43.1

Statistical data, year-end

                                    

Number of employees

     114,340        4     110,255        104,525        90,261        82,493   

of which in Sweden

     17,858        1     17,712        17,500        17,848        18,217   

Export sales from Sweden, SEK million

     108,944        2     106,997        116,507        100,070        94,829   

 

1) These financial measures as defined by us may constitute non-IFRS measures. For a reconciliation to the most directly comparable IFRS measures, see pages 150–151
2) For 2013, as proposed by the Board of Directors.

 

26


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

LETTER FROM THE CHAIRMAN

DEAR SHAREHOLDERS

Looking back on my third year as chairman of Ericsson, I have to say it is exciting to be part of this industry. The rapid pace of change I mentioned last year shows no signs of slowing, and the transformative power of technology is becoming increasingly felt all around the world. It is a true privilege to be the chairman of a company that is leading and driving that development.

Much of our time on the Ericsson Board is spent examining longer-term strategic issues and the Board needs to form a long-term view. But particularly in an environment and a market like Ericsson’s, we also have to consider short-term changes and opportunities that arise, and respond appropriately.

2013 was a very eventful year in which Ericsson and the Board addressed a number of important matters including acquisitions, divestments and refinancing. Two events that came up for much discussion during 2013 were the dissolution of the ST-Ericsson joint venture, with thin modems being integrated into Ericsson’s operations, and the important patent agreement with Samsung.

Attracting and retaining talent

The Board also pays much attention to talent management. We have a committed and experienced leadership team, led by our CEO and President, Hans Vestberg. We also see it as important to have a good leadership talent pool, so that future leaders can be developed and prepared, to secure the Company’s leading position.

Another main area for the Board is corporate governance, sustainability and responsible business practice. Ericsson is a large company with a unique global reach and it is essential that our high standards are met in all our dealings across diverse markets. Ericsson has set the bar high: every part of the Company is required to meet demanding financial, social, and environmental standards. Good governance ensures that risks are addressed and managed. Ericsson works continuously to uphold these standards as evidenced by the high trust that our stakeholders put in us.

Proposal to raise the dividend

We are also entrusted with the capital structure of the Company which is always an important topic of discussion. Part of this, particularly during the fourth quarter of each year, involves a proposal for dividend to the annual general meeting. This discussion is based on our dividend policy, which takes into account the previous year’s earnings and balance sheet structure, as well as coming years’ business plans and expected economic development. Ericsson’s strategy is one of industry leadership which requires large investments into R&D as well as a continued focus on building on the core business and expanding into new areas.

With all this taken into account the Board’s proposal is to increase the dividend from SEK 2.75 in 2012 to SEK 3 per share for 2013.

Ericsson is a dynamic, progressive company operating in an exciting, growing market, with good long-term prospects. I am proud of the people of Ericsson and it is an honor to be the Chairman of the Board.

Leif Johansson

Chairman of the Board of Directors

 

27


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

BOARD OF DIRECTORS’ REPORT

BUSINESS IN 2013

Ericsson’s sales ended at SEK 227.4 billion. The focus on profitability started to pay off and operating margin for the Group gradually improved in 2013, despite significant currency headwind, driven primarily by improvements in Networks and Network Rollout.

The business mix, with a higher share of coverage projects than capacity projects, started to shift towards more capacity during the year.

As anticipated, sales came under some pressure towards the end of the year. As previously communicated, the major reasons behind this development are the two large mobile broadband coverage projects, which peaked in North America in the first half of 2013, and the impact from reduced activity in Japan.

While executing on the large rollout projects in the US, Ericsson has also strengthened its professional services position and capabilities. In the second half of the year, Global Services accounted for more than half of the region’s sales and today the Company is the market leader in both telecom services and mobile infrastructure in one of the world’s most advanced and dynamic ICT markets.

The LTE tenders in China continued and so far the two major operators that have made their vendor selections have included Ericsson as a vendor. In the latter part of the year, sales in China improved as a result of deliveries to ongoing mobile broadband coverage projects.

Also in the latter part of 2013, Ericsson continued to grow in some of its European key markets. During the last years, the position in Europe has been strengthened through the network modernization projects. These have been delivered according to plan and the major part of the negative margin impact from these projects is now over. Over time, it is expected that the telecom industry in Europe will improve.

During 2013, Ericsson executed on a number of strategic initiatives to both manage the ongoing technology transition in the industry and to transform the company for future business opportunities. Ericsson has solidified its core business as well as taken important steps to build a leadership position in new and targeted key areas. This includes consolidation of the modems business and the acquisition of the IPTV business Mediaroom from Microsoft. The Company will gradually increase resource and capital allocation in these areas as well as in IP, Cloud, OSS and BSS.

The Company has also successfully completed an IPR cross-licensing agreement with Samsung. This agreement ends complaints made by both companies against each other before the International Trade Commission (ITC) as well as the lawsuits before the U.S. District Court for the Eastern District of Texas.

The long-term fundamentals in the industry remain attractive and with ongoing strategic initiatives Ericsson is well positioned to continue to support its customers in a transforming ICT market.

The Company has worked diligently to improve working capital and ended the year with a strong operating cash flow of SEK 17.4 (22.0) billion and a full-year cash conversion of 79%, above the target of 70%, giving Ericsson a solid balance sheet to continue to execute on its strategy.

 

LOGO

FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

Impact of Samsung IPR agreement

On January 27, 2014, Ericsson and Samsung signed an agreement on global patent licenses between the two companies.

The industry is built on scale and a strong tradition of sharing technologies through licensing on fair, reasonable and non-discriminatory (FRAND) terms. The agreement shows the value of Ericsson’s R&D investments and enables both companies to continue to innovate and bring new technologies to the market. The cross-license agreement covers patents relating to GSM, UMTS, and LTE standards for both networks and handsets.

The agreement includes an initial payment and ongoing royalty payments from Samsung to Ericsson for the term of the new multi-year license agreement.

The transaction contributed to net sales of SEK 4.2 billion, operating income of SEK 4.2 billion and net income of SEK 3.3 billion in 2013. Ericsson expects that the initial payment will impact operating cash flow in the beginning of 2014. This specific agreement impacts segments Networks and Support Solutions.

Income statement

Reported sales for 2013 were flat and amounted to SEK 227.4 (227.8) billion. During the year sales were negatively impacted by strong currency headwind and lower sales in North East Asia, driven by lower GSM investments in China combined with lower project activity in

 

28


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Japan and South Korea. In North America CDMA sales declined by –50% to SEK 4.2 (8.4) billion.

Revenues for IPR and licensing were SEK 10.6 (6.6) billion, of which the Samsung agreement contributed with SEK 4.2 billion.

With a large share of coverage projects in the beginning of the year and with slightly improved business mix from the second quarter, the commodity mix remained stable compared to last year. Software represented 24% (23%), hardware 34% (35%) and services 42% (42%) of total sales.

Restructuring charges amounted to SEK 4.5 (3.4) billion, mainly related to continued execution of the service delivery strategy and headcount reductions in Sweden. The proactive work to drive efficiency and cost reductions continues.

Gross margin increased to 33.6% (31.6%), due to the agreement with Samsung, reduced negative effect from network modernization projects in Europe and improved business mix. The Global Services share of Group sales was flat at 43%.

Total operating expenses were basically flat and amounted to SEK 58.5 (58.9) billion. Expenses related to the modems business added SEK –0.5 billion to operating expenses. A one-time charge related to the acquisition of Airvana Network Solutions Inc. impacted the operating expenses negatively by SEK –0.4 billion. Excluding restructuring charges, operating expenses were down –2% compared to 2012. Selling, general and administrative expenses (SG&A) amounted to SEK 26.3 (26.0) billion and represented 11.6% of sales compared to 11.4% in 2012. For comments on research and development expenses (R&D), see the section “Research and development, patents and licensing.”

Other operating income and expenses decreased to SEK 0.1 (9.0) billion. During the year, one-time charges related to the divestment of Applied Communication Sciences (ACS), the former research and engineering arm of Telcordia Technologies, and the exiting of the telecom and power cable operations of SEK –0.9 billion impacted other operating income negatively. For new hedges taken in 2013, hedge accounting is not applied. The total re-evaluation effect for 2013 hedges on other operating income was SEK 0.5 billion. In 2012, other operating income included a gain related to the divestment of Sony Ericsson of SEK 7.7 billion and to Multimedia brokering (IPX) of SEK 0.2 billion.

Ericsson’s share in earnings of JV and associated companies was SEK –0.1 (–11.7) billion. In 2012 a non-cash charge of SEK –8.0 billion related to ST-Ericsson was made.

Operating income, including JV, increased to SEK 17.8 (10.5) billion, positively impacted by improved gross margin, and no negative effect from ST-Ericsson. Operating income was negatively impacted by one-time charges of SEK –1.3 billion related to the divestment of ACS, the exiting of the telecom and power cable operations and the acquisition of Airvana. Operating margin, including JV, was 7.8% (4.6%). Operating income including JV and excluding the Samsung agreement was SEK 13.6 billion with an operating margin of 6.1%. 2012 included a gain of SEK 7.7 billion related to the divestment of Sony Ericsson.

Financial net amounted to SEK –0.7 (–0.3) billion. The difference is partly attributable to lower interest income as an effect of lower interest rates during 2013 compared to 2012. The tax rate for 2013 was 29% compared to 42% in 2012, positively impacted by product and market mix. Tax costs were SEK –4.9 (–4.2) billion.

Net income increased to SEK 12.2 (5.9) billion, positively impacted by the Samsung agreement by SEK 3.3 billion.

EPS diluted was SEK 3.69 (1.78).

 

LOGO    LOGO    LOGO

Balance sheet and other performance indicators

Compared to December 31, 2012, trade receivables increased from SEK 63.7 billion to 71.0 billion, mainly due to the Samsung agreement. Days sales outstanding (DSO) increased from 86 to 97 days.

Inventory decreased from SEK 28.8 billion to 22.8 billion, positively impacted by improved business mix and efficiency measures.

Inventory turnover days (ITO) improved from 73 to 62 days. Accounts payable days decreased from 57 to 53 days.

During the year, Ericsson concluded the following refinancing activities to extend the average debt maturity profile:

 

   

A EUR 313 million bond was repaid

 

   

Ericsson refinanced a USD 2 billion Revolving Credit Facility (RCF). The new facility is a five-year facility with two one-year extension options

 

   

A USD 684 million European Investment Bank (EIB) loan was disbursed. The loan agreement was signed in 2012 and the loan supports R&D activities. The loan will mature in 2020.

A SEK 4 billion EIB loan, with original maturity in 2015, will be repaid early 2014.

Provisions amounted to SEK 5.4 (8.6) billion by the end of the year. The reduction was mainly due to utilization of the 2012 ST-Ericsson provision.

 

29


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Cash flow from operating activities was positive at SEK 17.4 (22.0) billion, negatively impacted by higher working capital. There was no impact on cash flow from the Samsung agreement.

Cash outlays for regular investing activities decreased to SEK –5.0 (–6.5) billion. Acquisitions and divestments during the year were net SEK –2.7 (–2.1) billion. Cash flow from short-term investments for cash management purposes and other investing activities was net SEK –3.4 (3.7) billion, mainly attributable to changes between short-term investments and cash and cash equivalents.

Cash flow from financing activities was SEK –9.5 (–9.4) billion, mainly impacted by dividend paid of SEK –9.2 (–8.6) billion. Other financing activities net amounted to SEK –0.3 (–0.8) billion.

Cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments amounted to SEK 77.1 (76.7) billion. The net cash position decreased from SEK 38.5 to 37.8 billion. Cash conversion for 2013 ended at 79%.

In 2013, the net number of employees increased by 4,085, of which 3,293 were in services and 741 in R&D. By the end of 2013, the total number of employees was 114,340 (110,255) of which 5,377 people joined Ericsson through acquisitions and through managed services contracts. At the same time, approximately 13,000 employees left Ericsson, reflecting the natural attrition rate and ongoing company transformation.

 

LOGO    LOGO

Research and development, patents and licensing

To secure continued technology leadership, focus is on innovation and R&D. R&D expenses (see table below) amounted to SEK 32.2 (32.8) billion. During 2014, R&D expenses, excluding expenses related to Modems, Mediaroom and restructuring, are expected to increase somewhat, mainly due to investments in IP.

Research and development, patents and licensing

 

     2013     2012     2011  

Expenses (SEK billion)

     32.2        32.8        32.6   

As percent of Net sales

     14.2     14.4     14.4

Employees within R&D as of December 311)

     25,300        24,100        22,400   

Patents1)

     35,000        33,000        30,000   

IPR revenue, net (SEK billion)

     10.6        6.6        6.2   

 

1) The number of employees and patents are approximate.

 

LOGO

 

30


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

Seasonality

The Company’s sales, income and cash flow from operations vary between quarters, generally lowest in the first quarter of the year and highest in the fourth quarter. This is mainly a result of the seasonal purchase patterns of network operators.

Most recent five-year average seasonality of sales

 

     First
quarter
    Second
quarter
    Third
quarter
    Fourth
quarter
 

Sequential change

     –21     6     –3     24

Share of annual sales

     23     24     24     29

Off-balance sheet arrangements

There are currently no material off-balance sheet arrangements that have, or would be reasonably likely to have, a current or anticipated material effect on the Company’s financial condition, revenues, expenses, result of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.

Capital expenditures

For 2013, capital expenditures amounted to SEK 4.5 billion, 2% of sales. Annual capital expenditures are normally around 2% of sales. This corresponds to the needs for keeping and maintaining the current capacity level, including the introduction of new technology and methods. Expenditures are largely related to test sites and equipment for R&D and network operations centers as well as manufacturing and repair operations. The Board of Directors reviews the Company’s investment plans and proposals.

Ericsson is planning to invest in three new global ICT Centers, of which two in Sweden and one in Canada, over the coming five years. The centers will support R&D and Services in developing and verifying solutions, bringing innovation to the market faster. Apart from this investment Ericsson believes that the Company’s property, plant and equipment and the facilities the Company occupies are suitable for its present needs in most locations. As of December 31, 2013, no material land, buildings, machinery or equipment were pledged as collateral for outstanding indebtedness.

The Company believes it has sufficient cash and cash generation capacity to fund expected capital expenditures without external borrowings in 2014.

Capital expenditures 2009–2013

 

SEK billion

   2013     2012     2011     2010     2009  

Capital expenditures

     4.5        5.4        5.0        3.7        4.0   

of which in Sweden

     1.9        1.3        1.7        1.4        1.3   

Share of annual sales

     2.0     2.4     2.2     1.8     1.9

 

LOGO

 

31


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

BUSINESS RESULTS—SEGMENTS

Networks

Sales were basically flat. The Samsung agreement and increased sales in Latin America, Europe and the Middle East impacted sales positively, but this was partly offset by lower sales in North America, where CDMA related sales declined by –50%. North East Asia sales declined as an effect of lower project activities in Japan and South Korea and lower GSM investments in China.

At the end of the year there was solid demand for our IMS and data layered architecture UDC (User Data Consolidation). However, this was not enough to offset the continued structural decline in circuit-switched core.

Operating margin gradually improved during the year and ended at 10% (6%) This was a result of the Samsung agreement, reduced negative effect from network modernization projects in Europe, improved business mix and strong focus on improving profitability. Restructuring charges amounted to SEK –2.2 (–1.3) billion. This was primarily related to reductions of operations in Sweden and dismantling of the CDMA operations. Operating margin excluding the Samsung agreement was 7%.

 

LOGO

Global Services

Reported sales for Global Services were flat in comparison to a strong 2012. Network Rollout reported sales grew 4% driven by high coverage project activities, primarily in North America. Professional Services had a strong development in region North America and India.

Global Services operating margin was 6% (6%). Network Rollout margin gradually improved during the year due to the declining dilutive effect from European network modernization projects as well as the ongoing efficiency programs. Professional Services operating margin was 14% (14%).

Restructuring charges amounted to SEK –2.0 (–1.9) billion.

 

LOGO

Support Solutions

Sales development was primarily driven by portfolio changes and decline in sales of TV compression technology while OSS and BSS showed stable development. The Samsung agreement had an overall positive impact on sales.

Operating margin increased to 12% (9%) due to the Samsung agreement. Lower sales and a charge related to the divestment of ACS had a negative impact on the margin.

 

LOGO

From ST-Ericsson to segment Modems

ST-Ericsson was created in 2008 as a joint venture between Ericsson and STMicroelectronics. Early in 2013, the parents agreed to split up and close the joint venture.

Ericsson decided to take over the design, development and sales of the thin LTE multimode modem solutions as these are seen as an important part of the Ericsson vision of 50 billion connected devices in the Networked Society. The ambition is to be among the top three suppliers in the thin-modem market.

In 2013, all ST-Ericsson businesses have been transferred to parents or divested. In 2012, Ericsson made a provision of SEK 3.3 billion, related to the ongoing implementation of strategic options at hand.

Ericsson now has a highly focused thin-modem operation with industry-leading technology and intellectual property. A new segment was established as of October 1, 2013, and the modems business is now consolidated into Ericsson. For 2013, segment Modems generated an operating loss of SEK –0.5 billion, primarily related to R&D expenses.

BUSINESS RESULTS—REGIONS

 

   

North America: Networks sales declined in 2013, with a strong first half while the second half was weaker as a result of the two large mobile broadband coverage projects that peaked in the first half of the year. While executing on the large rollout projects in the US, Ericsson has also strengthened its professional services position and capabilities. Global Services accounted for more than 50% of the region’s sales in the second half of the year.

 

   

Latin America: LTE deployments ramped up after a slow start, and together with 3G network quality investments, drove sales growth for 2013. However, macroeconomic development mostly in Brazil and Mexico continued to slow down during the year.

 

   

Northern Europe and Central Asia: Sales growth was mainly driven by Networks sales in Russia. Operators continued to show high interest in OSS and BSS.

 

   

Western and Central Europe: Sales growth was driven by network modernization projects in several countries and also by a high activity level in managed services.

 

32


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

   

Mediterranean: Sales in 2013 grew, driven by 3G deployments in Northwest Africa and modernization projects.

 

   

Middle East: Sales grew in 2013, driven by increased investments in mobile broadband.

 

   

Sub-Saharan Africa: Sales came from 2G and 3G deployment and managed services, although the deployment pace slowed down in the latter part of the year. Long-term industry fundamentals remain positive as mobile broadband and smartphone penetration is still at low levels.

 

   

India: Sales were negatively impacted by poor macroeconomic environment and delays in regulatory legislation. Global Services grew largely due to an increase in Managed Services.

 

   

North East Asia: Sales declined in 2013. Japan was negatively impacted by currency and reduced activity. GSM in China structurally declined whilst LTE deployments commenced towards the end of the year. In Japan, KDDI has selected Ericsson as one of the prime vendors to deploy its LTE system and evolved packet core network.

 

   

South East Asia and Oceania: Sales grew in 2013 with 3G deployments in Thailand and LTE deployments in Singapore and Australia. In Indonesia major capacity projects were finalized. Smartphone penetration continues to increase from a low level.

 

   

Other: Sales increased, positively impacted by the Samsung agreement but negatively impacted by the divestment of IPX in 2012 and the exit of the telecom and power cable business. Sales of broadcast services, cables, power modules and other businesses are also included in “Other.”

Sales per region and segment 2013 and percent change from 2012

 

     Networks     Global Services     Support Solutions              

SEK billion

   2013     Percent
change
    2013     Percent
change
    2013     Percent
change
    Total
2013
    Percent
change
 

North America

     28.5        –7     28.2        20     2.6        –5     59.3        5

Latin America

     11.3        16     9.5        –10     1.1        –30     22.0        0

Northern Europe and Central Asia

     7.2        14     4.2        –8     0.3        –46     11.6        2

Western and Central Europe

     7.6        24     10.3        –3     0.6        –14     18.5        6

Mediterranean

     10.8        14     12.6        –3     0.7        –6     24.2        4

Middle East

     8.5        26     7.6        4     1.3        –9     17.4        12

Sub-Saharan Africa

     5.0        –22     4.1        6     0.9        –9     10.0        –11

India

     3.1        –13     2.7        11     0.3        –32     6.1        –5

North East Asia

     16.7        –26     10.4        –22     0.4        –30     27.4        –24

South East Asia and Oceania

     8.9        12     6.4        –3     0.5        1     15.8        5

Other1)

     10.1        28     1.4        17     3.5        10     15.0        22
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     117.7        0     97.4        0     12.2        –9     227.4        0

Share of total

     52       43       5       100  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Region “Other” includes licensing revenues, sales of cables, broadcast services, power modules and other businesses. The acquired Technicolor Broadcast Service Division is reported in region “Other.” Multimedia brokering (IPX) was part of region “Other” and divested end Q312. The power cable business was divested in Q313.

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

In accordance with the Annual Accounts Act ((SFS 1995:1554), Chapter 6, Sections 6 and 8) and the Swedish Corporate Governance Code (the “Code”), a separate Corporate Governance Report, including an Internal Control section, has been prepared and attached to this Annual Report.

Continued compliance with the Swedish Corporate Governance Code

Ericsson is committed to complying with best-practice corporate governance standards on a global level wherever possible. In 2013, Ericsson did not report any deviations from the Code.

Business integrity

Ericsson’s Code of Business Ethics summarizes the Group’s basic policies and directives governing its relationships internally, with its stakeholders and with others. It also sets out

 

33


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

how the Group works to secure that business activities are conducted with a strong sense of integrity. There have been no amendments to Ericsson’s Code of Business Ethics or waivers from a provision of the Code to any member of Group management.

Board of Directors

The Annual General Meeting held on April 9, 2013, re-elected Leif Johansson Chairman of the Board. Roxanne S. Austin, Sir Peter L. Bonfield, Börje Ekholm, Alexander Izosimov, Ulf J. Johansson, Sverker Martin-Löf, Hans Vestberg and Jacob Wallenberg were re-elected and Nora Denzel, Kristin Skogen Lund and Pär Östberg were elected new members of the Board. Pehr Claesson, Kristina Davidsson and Karin Åberg were appointed employee representatives by the unions, with Rickard Fredriksson, Karin Lennartsson and Roger Svensson as deputies.

Management

Hans Vestberg has been President and CEO of the Group since January 1, 2010. The President and CEO is supported by the Group management, consisting of the Executive Leadership Team (ELT).

A global management system is in place to ensure that Ericsson’s business is well controlled and has the ability to fulfill the objectives of major stakeholders within established risk limits. The management system also monitors internal control and compliance with applicable laws, listing requirements and governance codes.

Remuneration

Remuneration to the members of the Board of Directors and to Group management, as well as the Guidelines for remuneration to Group Management resolved by the Annual General Meeting 2013, are reported in Notes to the consolidated financial statements—Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees”.

As of December 31, 2013, there were no loans outstanding from and no guarantees issued to or assumed by Ericsson for the benefit of any member of the Board of Directors or senior management.

The Board of Directors’ proposal for guidelines for remuneration to Group management

The Board of Directors proposes that the Annual General Meeting resolves on the following guidelines for remuneration to Group management for the period up to the 2015 Annual General Meeting. Compared to the guidelines resolved by the 2013 Annual General Meeting, a reference to the normally applicable pensionable age has been deleted.

Guidelines for remuneration to Group management

For Group management consisting of the Executive Leadership Team, including the President and CEO, total remuneration consists of fixed salary, short- and long-term variable compensation, pension and other benefits. The following guidelines apply to the remuneration of the Executive Leadership Team:

 

   

Variable compensation is in cash and stock-based programs awarded against specific business targets derived from the long-term business plan approved by the Board of Directors. Targets may include financial targets at either Group or unit level, operational targets, employee engagement targets and customer satisfaction targets.

 

   

All benefits, including pension benefits, follow the competitive practice in the home country taking total compensation into account.

 

   

By way of exception, additional arrangements can be made when deemed necessary. An additional arrangement can be renewed but each such arrangement shall be limited in time and shall not exceed a period of 36 months and twice the remuneration that the individual would have received had no additional arrangement been made.

 

   

The mutual notice period may be no more than six months. Upon termination of employment by the Company, severance pay amounting to a maximum of 18 months fixed salary is paid. Notice of termination given by the employee due to significant structural changes, or other events that in a determining manner affect the content of work or the condition for the position, is equated with notice of termination served by the Company.

Executive Performance Stock Plan

The Company has a Long-Term Variable remuneration program (LTV). It builds on a common platform, but consists of three separate plans: one targeting all employees, one targeting key contributors and one targeting senior managers. The program is designed to encourage long-term value creation in alignment

 

34


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

with shareholders’ interests. The aim of the plan for senior managers is to attract, retain and motivate executives in a competitive market through performance-based share-related incentives and to encourage the build-up of significant equity stakes. The performance criteria for senior managers under the Executive Performance Stock Plan are revised yearly and approved by the Annual General Meeting. Performance criteria for the 2014 Executive Performance Stock Plan will be communicated in the notice to the Annual General Meeting.

The targets for the 2011, 2012 and 2013 Executive Performance Stock Plans are shown in the illustration below. The performance criteria are:

 

   

Up to one-third of the award will vest if the target for compound annual growth rate of consolidated net sales is achieved

 

   

Up to one-third of the award will vest if the target for compound annual growth rate of consolidated operating income, including earnings in joint ventures and restructuring, is achieved. For the 2011 plan, base year 2010 excludes restructuring charges of SEK 6.8 billion. For the 2013 plan, base year 2012 excludes a non-cash charge of SEK 8.0 billion for ST-Ericsson.

 

   

Up to one-third of the award will vest if cash conversion is at or above 70% during each of the years and vesting one-ninth of the award for each year the target is achieved.

The cash conversion target was reached in 2013 and 2012 but not reached in 2011.

Before the number of performance shares to be matched are finally determined, the Board of Directors shall examine whether the performance matching is reasonable considering the Company’s financial results and position, conditions on the stock market and other circumstances, and if not, reduce the number of performance shares.

 

LOGO

MATERIAL CONTRACTS

Material contractual obligations are outlined in Note C31, “Contractual obligations.” These were entered into in the ordinary course of business and were primarily related to operating leases for office and production facilities, purchase contracts for outsourced manufacturing, R&D and IT operations, and the purchase of components for the Company’s own manufacturing.

Ericsson is party to certain agreements, which include provisions that may take effect or be altered or invalidated by a change in control of the Company as a result of a public takeover offer. Such provisions are not unusual for certain types of agreements, such as financing agreements and certain license agreements. However, considering among other things the Company’s strong financial position, none of the agreements currently in effect would entail any material consequence to Ericsson due to a change in control of the Company.

 

35


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

RISK MANAGEMENT

Risks are defined in both short-term and long-term perspective. They are categorized into industry and market risks, commercial risks, operational risks and compliance risks. Ericsson’s risk management is based on the following principles, which apply universally across all business activities and risk types:

 

   

Risk management is an integrated part of the Ericsson Group Management System

 

   

Each operational unit is accountable for owning and managing its risks according to policies, directives and process tools. Decisions are made or escalated according to defined delegation of authority. Financial risks are coordinated through Group Function Finance

 

   

Risks are dealt with during the strategy process, annual planning and target setting, continuous monitoring through monthly and quarterly steering group meetings and during operational processes (customer projects, customer bid/contract, acquisition, investment and product development projects). They are subject to various controls such as decision tollgates and approvals.

At least twice a year, in connection with the approval of strategy and targets, risks are reviewed by the Board of Directors.

A central security unit coordinates management of certain risks, such as business interruption, information security and physical security. The Crisis Management Council deals with events of a serious nature.

For information on risks that could impact the fulfillment of targets and form the basis for mitigating activities, see the other sections of the Board of Directors’ report, Notes C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” C14, “Trade receivables and customer finance,” C19, “Interest-bearing liabilities,” C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments” and the chapter Risk factors.

SOURCING AND SUPPLY

Ericsson’s hardware largely consists of electronics. For manufacturing, the Company purchases customized and standardized components and services from several global providers as well as from local and regional suppliers. Certain types of components, such as power modules, are produced in-house.

The production of electronic modules and sub-assemblies is mostly outsourced to manufacturing services companies, of which the vast majority are in low-cost countries. Production of radio base stations is largely done in-house and on-demand. This consists of assembling and testing modules and integrating them into complete units. Final assembly and testing are concentrated to a few sites. Ericsson has 14 manufacturing sites in Brazil, China, Estonia, India, Italy, Mexico and Sweden.

A number of suppliers design and manufacture highly specialized and customized components. The Company generally attempts to negotiate global supply agreements with its primary suppliers. Ericsson’s suppliers are required to comply with the requirements of Ericsson’s Code of Conduct.

Where possible, Ericsson relies on alternative supply sources and seeks to avoid single source supply situations. A need to switch to an alternative supplier may require allocation of additional resources. This process could take some time to complete.

Variations in market prices for raw materials generally have a limited effect on total cost of goods sold. For more information, see the chapter Risk factors.

SUSTAINABILITY AND CORPORATE RESPONSIBILITY

The Company has implemented strong social, environmental and ethical standards supporting value creation and risk management. This commitment generates positive business impacts, which in turn benefits society.

Ericsson’s approach to Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility (CR) is integrated into its core business operations throughout its value chain. The Board of Directors considers these aspects in governance decision-making. Group policies and directives ensure consistency across global operations. Ericsson publishes an annual Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility Report, which provides additional information.

Responsible business practices

Since 2000, Ericsson has supported the UN Global Compact, and endorses its ten principles regarding human rights and labor standards, anti-corruption and environmental protection.

In 2013, Ericsson reported its Communication on Progress at the Global Compact Advanced

 

36


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

level. The Ericsson Group Management System (EGMS) includes a Code of Business Ethics, a Code of Conduct and a Sustainability Policy which reflect responsible business practices. These practices are reinforced by employee awareness training, workshops and monitoring, including a global assessment plan run by an external assurance provider.

Ericsson has adopted an anti-corruption program which is reviewed and evaluated by the Audit Committee of the Board of Directors annually. The program continues to evolve and a new version of the Company’s e-learning regarding anti-corruption was launched during the year. Approximately 85,000 employees have completed the training.

Human rights

The Code of Business Ethics reflects the Company’s ongoing commitment to respect human rights, and the UN Guiding Principles on Business and Human Rights. Ericsson has worked actively to strengthen its internal governance processes and has a Sales Compliance Board which considers potential human rights impacts in its decisions. The human rights risk tools used by the Sales Compliance Board include external global risk indices. Ericsson joined the Shift Business Learning Program to further strengthen its framework on Human Rights across the Company which included conducting a Human Rights Impact Assessment in Myanmar, in accordance with the UN Guiding Principles.

Responsible sourcing

All suppliers must comply with the requirements of Ericsson’s Code of Conduct. Approximately 190 employees, covering all regions, are trained as Code of Conduct auditors. The Company uses a risk-based approach to ensure that the high risk portfolio areas, and highest risk markets, are targeted first. For prioritized areas, Ericsson performs regular audits and works with suppliers to ensure measurable and continuous improvements. Findings are followed up to ensure that improvements are made.

Ericsson addresses the issue of conflict minerals, including compliance with the US Dodd-Frank Act and the disclosure rule adopted by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) through measures in its sourcing and product management processes.

Ericsson has actively engaged with its suppliers on this issue and suppliers within scope have been queried on the smelters in their supply chain. Ericsson’s supply chain is complex and both Ericsson and its suppliers are often many tiers away from the smelters.

Ericsson also participates in industry initiatives such as the Conflict-Free Sourcing Initiative (CFSI), driven by the Global e-Sustainability Initiative (GeSI), and the Electronic Industry Citizenship Coalition (EICC).

 

LOGO

Reducing environmental impact

Energy use of products in operation remains the Company’s most significant environmental impact. Ericsson works proactively with its customers to encourage network and site energy optimization, through innovative products, software, solutions and advisory services. Processes and controls are in place to ensure compliance with relevant product-related environmental, customer and regulatory requirements.

The Company works actively to reduce its environmental impact, with a focus on Design for Environment, which includes product energy efficiency and materials management. Continuously improving sustainability performance is fundamental to Ericsson’s strategy – and a priority remains improving the life-cycle carbon footprint. Last year, Ericsson reported that it reached its five-year target to reduce carbon footprint intensity by 40% one year ahead of schedule. Ericsson continues to report on this performance for the final year. The target comprises two focus areas: Ericsson’s own activities and the life-cycle impacts of products in operation. Results for the five-year target: A 56% reduction in direct emission intensity from own activities, including business travel, product transportation and facilities’ energy use. A 47% reduction in indirect emission intensity from life-cycle impacts of products in operation.

Ericsson set a new long-term objective for its own operations in 2012, which is to maintain absolute CO2e emissions from Ericsson’s own activities for business travel, product transportation and facilities energy use in 2017 at the same level as in 2011. To achieve this long-term objective, the Company aims to reduce CO2e emissions per employee by 30% over five years. The Company achieved a 10% reduction of CO2e emissions per employee in 2013.

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

Ericsson Ecology Management is a program to take responsibility for products at the end of their life and to treat them in an environmentally preferable way. The program also ensures that

 

37


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Ericsson fulfills its producer responsibility and is offered to all customers globally free of charge, not only in markets where it is required by law.

Radio waves and health

Ericsson employs rigid product testing and installation procedures with the goal of ensuring that radio wave exposure levels from products and network solutions are below established safety limits. The Company also provides public information on radio waves and health, and supports independent research to further increase knowledge in this area. Since 1996, Ericsson has co-sponsored over 100 studies related to electromagnetic fields and health, primarily through the Mobile Manufacturers Forum. To assure scientific independence, firewalls were in place between the industrial sponsors and the researchers conducting these studies. Independent expert groups and public health authorities, including the World Health Organization, have reviewed the total amount of research and have consistently concluded that the balance of evidence does not demonstrate any health effects associated with radio wave exposure from either mobile phones or radio base stations.

Reporting according to GRI 3.0

Ericsson publishes an annual Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility report and full key performance data is made available on the Ericsson website according to the Global Reporting Initiative (GRI). The performance data is assured by a third party.

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

In November 2012, Ericsson filed two patent infringement lawsuits in the US District Court for the Eastern District of Texas against Samsung. Ericsson sought damages and an injunction. Ericsson also asked the Court to adjudge that Samsung breached its commitment to license any standard-essential patents it owns on fair, reasonable, and non-discriminatory terms and to declare Samsung’s allegedly standard essential patents to be unenforceable. In March 2013, Samsung filed its answers and counterclaims in the Ericsson suits in Texas, USA.

In November 2012, Ericsson also filed a complaint with the US International Trade Commission (ITC), seeking an exclusion order blocking Samsung from import of certain products into the USA.

In December 2012, Samsung filed a complaint with the ITC seeking an exclusion order blocking Ericsson from import of certain products into the USA.

On January 27, 2014, Ericsson announced that an agreement had been signed with Samsung on global patent licenses between the two companies. The cross-license agreement covers patents relating to GSM, UMTS, and LTE standards for both networks and handsets.

The agreement ends the complaints made by both companies against each other before ITC as well as the lawsuits before the U.S. District Court for the Eastern District of Texas.

On January 10, 2013, Adaptix Inc. filed two lawsuits against Ericsson, AT&T, AT&T Mobility and MetroPCS Communications in the US District Court for Eastern District of Texas alleging that certain Ericsson products infringe five US patents assigned to Adaptix. Adaptix seeks damages and an injunction.

On January 18, 2013, Adaptix filed a complaint with the Tokyo District Court alleging certain Ericsson products infringe two Japanese patents assigned to Adaptix. Adaptix seeks damages and an injunction.

On January 25, 2013, Adaptix filed a complaint with the US International Trade Commission (ITC) requesting that the commission open a patent infringement investigation into certain Ericsson products. In December 2013, this complaint was dismissed by the ITC based on Adaptix’s withdrawal of the complaint.

In 2013, Ericsson filed a patent infringement lawsuit in the Delhi High Court against Indian handset company Micromax, seeking damages and an injunction. Ericsson alleged that Micromax products, compliant with the 2G/3G standard, infringe eight of Ericsson’s Indian patents. As part of its defence, Micromax has filed a complaint to the Competition Commission of India (CCI) and the CCI has decided to refer the case to the Director General’s Office for an in-depth investigation.

In 2012, Wi-LAN Inc., a US patent licensing company, filed a complaint against Ericsson in the US District Court of Southern Florida alleging that Ericsson’s LTE products infringe three of Wi-LAN’s US patents. Ericsson was sued in 2010 by Wi-LAN in another patent infringement lawsuit in the US District Court for the Eastern District of Texas. Wi-LAN alleged that Ericsson products, compliant with the 3GPP standard, infringe three US patents assigned to Wi-LAN.

In June 2013, a District Court Judge in the Florida case granted Ericsson’s request for a Summary

 

38


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Judgment and dismissed Wi-LAN’s claims against Ericsson. Wi-LAN has appealed this decision. In July 2013, a jury in Tyler, Texas, found in Ericsson’s favor in the Texas case. Wi-LAN may appeal the final decision by the Court.

In 2012, Airvana Networks Solutions Inc. sued Ericsson in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, alleging that Ericsson had violated key contract terms and misappropriated Airvana trade secrets and proprietary information. Ericsson announced on September 6, 2013 that it has acquired Airvana Network Solutions’ EVDO business. The lawsuit filed by Airvana against Ericsson has now been dismissed.

In 2011, TruePosition sued Ericsson, Qualcomm, Alcatel-Lucent, the European Telecommunications Standards Institute (ETSI) and the Third Generation Partnership Project (3GPP) in the US District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania for purported federal antitrust violations. The complaint alleged that Ericsson, Qualcomm and Alcatel-Lucent illegally conspired to block the adoption of TruePosition’s proprietary technology into the new mobile positioning standards for LTE, while at the same time ensuring that their own technology was included into the new standards. The case is proceeding to discovery.

In 2007, H3G S.p.A, (H3G) filed arbitral proceedings in Italy against Ericsson. H3G claimed compensation from Ericsson for alleged breach of contract. In June 2013, the parties settled the dispute. The settlement did not have a material impact on Ericsson’s business, operating results or liquidity.

In addition to the proceedings discussed above, Ericsson companies are, and in the future may be, involved in various other lawsuits, claims and proceedings incidental to the ordinary course of business.

PARENT COMPANY

The Parent Company business consists mainly of corporate management, holding company functions and internal banking activities. It also handles customer credit management, performed on a commission basis by Ericsson Credit AB.

The Parent Company has 5 (6) branch offices. In total, the Group has 81 (71) branch and representative offices.

Financial information

Income after financial items was SEK 7.2 (–4.9) billion. The Parent Company had no sales in 2013 or 2012 to subsidiaries, while 30% (34%) of total purchases of goods and services were from such companies.

Major changes in the Parent Company’s financial position for the year included:

 

   

In 2012, a provision of SEK 3.3 billion was recognized, which provides for Ericsson’s share of obligations for the wind-down of ST-Ericsson. In 2013, SEK 2.1 billion has been utilized or reversed, which resulted in a net liability of SEK 1.2 billion

 

   

Decreased current and non-current receivables from subsidiaries of SEK 7.1 billion

 

   

Decreased other current receivables of SEK 2.0 billion

 

   

Increased cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments of SEK 1.1 billion

 

   

Decreased current and non-current liabilities to subsidiaries of SEK 5.2 billion

 

   

Decreased other current liabilities of SEK 0.9 billion.

At year-end, cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments amounted to SEK 58.5 (57.4) billion.

Share information

As of December 31, 2013, the total number of shares in issue was 3,305,051,735, of which 261,755,983 were Class A shares, each carrying one vote, and 3,043,295,752 were Class B shares, each carrying one tenth of one vote. Both classes of shares have the same rights of participation in the net assets and earnings.

The two largest shareholders at year-end were Investor AB and AB Industrivärden holding 21.50% and 15.21% respectively of the voting rights in the Parent Company.

In accordance with the conditions of the Long-Term Variable Remuneration Program (LTV) for Ericsson employees, 10,829,917 treasury shares were sold or distributed to employees in 2013. The quotient value of these shares was SEK 5.00, totaling SEK 54.1 million, representing less than 1% of capital stock, and compensation received for shares sold and distributed shares amounted to SEK 116.6 million.

The holding of treasury stock at December 31, 2013 was 73,968,178 Class B shares. The quotient value of these shares is SEK 5.00, totaling SEK 369.8 million, representing 2.2% of capital stock, and the purchase price amounts to SEK 571.6 million.

Proposed disposition of earnings

The Board of Directors proposes that a dividend of SEK 3.0 (2.75) per share be paid to shareholders duly registered on the record date April 16, 2014, and that the Parent Company shall retain the remaining part of non-restricted equity.

The Class B treasury shares held by the Parent Company are not entitled to receive dividend. Assuming that no treasury shares remain on the record date, the Board of Directors proposes that earnings be distributed as follows:

 

Amount to be paid to the shareholders

     SEK 9,915,155,205   

Amount to be retained by the Parent Company

     SEK 13,882,835,598   
  

 

 

 

Total non-restricted equity of the Parent Company

     SEK 23,797,990,803   

 

39


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

As a basis for its dividend proposal, the Board of Directors has made an assessment in accordance with Chapter 18, Section 4 of the Swedish Companies Act of the Parent Company’s and the Group’s need for financial resources as well as the Parent Company’s and the Group’s liquidity, financial position in other respects and long-term ability to meet their commitments. The Group reports an equity ratio of 53% (50%) and a net cash amount of SEK 37.8 (38.5) billion.

The Board of Directors has also considered the Parent Company’s result and financial position and the Group’s position in general. In this respect, the Board of Directors has taken into account known commitments that may have an impact on the financial positions of the Parent Company and its subsidiaries.

The proposed dividend does not limit the Group’s ability to make investments or raise funds, and it is the Board of Directors’ assessment that the proposed dividend is well-balanced considering the nature, scope and risks of the business activities as well as he capital requirements for the Parent Company and the Group in addition to coming years’ business plans and economic development.

BOARD ASSURANCE

The Board of Directors and the President declare that the consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS, as adopted by the EU, and give a fair view of the Group’s financial position and results of operations. The financial statements of the Parent Company have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in Sweden and give a fair view of the Parent Company’s financial position and results of operations.

The Board of Directors’ Report for the Ericsson Group and the Parent Company provides a fair view of the development of the Group’s and the Parent Company’s operations, financial position and results of operations and describes material risks and uncertainties facing the Parent Company and the companies included in the Group.

 

40


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Shareholders of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ)

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, shareholders equity and cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2013 and 2012, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2013, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board and in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework (1992) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in “Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting”. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) and International Standards on Auditing. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Stockholm, April 8, 2014

 

By:   /s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers
Name:   PricewaterhouseCoopers AB

 

41


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT

 

January–December, SEK million

   Notes      2013     2012     2011  

Net sales

     C3, C4         227,376        227,779        226,921   

Cost of sales

        –151,005        –155,699        –147,200   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross income

        76,371        72,080        79,721   

Gross margin (%)

        33.6     31.6     35.1

Research and development expenses

        –32,236        –32,833        –32,638   

Selling and administrative expenses

        –26,273        –26,023        –26,683   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

        –58,509        –58,856        –59,321   

Other operating income and expenses

     C6         113        8,965 1)      1,278   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income before shares in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies

        17,975        22,189        21,678   

Operating margin before shares in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies (%)

        7.9     9.7     9.6

Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies

     C3, C12         –130        –11,731        –3,778   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income

        17,845        10,458        17,900   

Financial income

     C7         1,346        1,708        2,882   

Financial expenses

     C7         –2,093        –1,984        –2,661   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income after financial items

        17,098        10,182        18,121   

Taxes

     C8         –4,924        –4,244        –5,552   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

        12,174        5,938        12,569   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income attributable to:

         

Stockholders of the Parent Company

        12,005        5,775        12,194   

Non-controlling interest

        169        163        375   

Other information

         

Average number of shares, basic (million)

     C9         3,226        3,216        3,206   

Earnings per share attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company, basic (SEK)2)

     C9         3.72        1.80        3.80   

Earnings per share attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company, diluted (SEK)2)

     C9         3.69        1.78        3.77   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Includes gain on sale of Sony Ericsson of SEK 7.7 billion.
2) Based on Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company.

 

42


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

 

January–December, SEK million

   2013      2012      2011  

Net income

     12,174         5,938         12,569   

Other comprehensive income

        

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

        

Remeasurements of defined benefits pension plans including asset ceiling

     3,214         –451         –6,963   

Tax on items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

     –1,235         –59         1,810   

Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

        

Cash flow hedges

        

Gains/losses arising during the period

     251         1,668         996   

Reclassification adjustments for gains/losses included in profit or loss

     –1,072         –568         –2,028   

Adjustments for amounts transferred to initial carrying amount of hedged items

     —           92         —     

Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations

        

Fair value remeasurement

     71         6         —     

Changes in cumulative translation adjustments

     –1,687         –3,947         –964   

Share of other comprehensive income of joint ventures and associated companies

     –14         –486         –262   

Tax on items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

     179         –363         348   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

     –293         –4,108         –7,063   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     11,881         1,830         5,506   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income attributable to:

        

Stockholders of the Parent Company

     11,712         1,716         5,081   

Non-controlling interests

     169         114         425   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

43


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET

 

December 31, SEK million

   Notes      2013      2012  

Assets

        

Non-current assets

        

Intangible assets

     C10         

Capitalized development expenses

        3,348         3,840   

Goodwill

        31,544         30,404   

Intellectual property rights, brands and other intangible assets

        12,815         15,202   

Property, plant and equipment

     C11, C26, C27         11,433         11,493   

Financial assets

        

Equity in joint ventures and associated companies

     C12         2,568         2,842   

Other investments in shares and participations

     C12         505         386   

Customer finance, non-current

     C12         1,294         1,290   

Other financial assets, non-current

     C12         5,684         3,964   

Deferred tax assets

     C8         9,103         12,321   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        78,294         81,742   

Current assets

        

Inventories

     C13         22,759         28,802   

Trade receivables

     C14         71,013         63,660   

Customer finance, current

     C14         2,094         4,019   

Other current receivables

     C15         17,941         20,065   

Short-term investments

     C20         34,994         32,026   

Cash and cash equivalents

     C25         42,095         44,682   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        190,896         193,254   

Total assets

        269,190         274,996   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity and liabilities

        

Equity

        

Stockholders’ equity

     C16         140,204         136,883   

Non-controlling interest in equity of subsidiaries

        1,419         1,600   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        141,623         138,483   

Non-current liabilities

        

Post-employment benefits1)

     C17         9,825         9,503   

Provisions, non-current

     C18         222         211   

Deferred tax liabilities

     C8         2,650         3,120   

Borrowings, non-current

     C19, C20         22,067         23,898   

Other non-current liabilities

        1,459         2,377   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        36,223         39,109   

Current liabilities

        

Provisions, current

     C18         5,140         8,427   

Borrowings, current

     C19, C20         7,388         4,769   

Trade payables

     C22         20,502         23,100   

Other current liabilities1)

     C21         58,314         61,108   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
        91,344         97,404   

Total equity and liabilities2)

        269,190         274,996   
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) As of January 1, 2013 the provision for the Swedish special payroll taxes, amounting to SEK 1.8 billion, which was previously included in Other current liabilities, has been re-classified as pension liability in line with the implementation of IAS 19R.
2) Of which interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits SEK 39,280 (38,170) million.

 

44


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS

 

January–December, SEK million

   Notes      2013      2012     2011  

Operating activities

          

Net income

        12,174         5,938        12,569   

Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash

     C25         9,828         13,077        12,613   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
        22,002         19,015        25,182   

Changes in operating net assets

          

Inventories

        4,868         2,752        –3,243   

Customer finance, current and non-current

        1,809         –1,259        74   

Trade receivables

        –8,504         –1,103        –1,700   

Trade payables

        –2,158         –1,311        –1,648   

Provisions and post-employment benefits

        –3,298         –1,920        –5,695   

Other operating assets and liabilities, net

        2,670         5,857        –2,988   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
        –4,613         3,016        –15,200   

Cash flow from operating activities

        17,389         22,031        9,982   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing activities

          

Investments in property, plant and equipment

     C11         –4,503         –5,429        –4,994   

Sales of property, plant and equipment

        378         568        386   

Acquisitions of subsidiaries and other operations

     C25, C26         –3,147         –11,529 1)      –3,181   

Divestments of subsidiaries and other operations

     C25, C26         465         9,452        53   

Product development

     C10         –915         –1,641        –1,515   

Other investing activities

        –1,330         1,540        –900   

Short-term investments

        –2,057         2,151        14,692   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from investing activities

        –11,109         –4,888        4,541   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow before financing activities

        6,280         17,143        14,523   

Financing activities

          

Proceeds from issuance of borrowings

        5,956         8,969        2,076   

Repayment of borrowings

        –5,094         –9,670        –1,259   

Proceeds from stock issue

        —           159        —     

Sale/repurchase of own shares

        90         –93        92   

Dividends paid

        –9,153         –8,632        –7,455   

Other financing activities

        –1,307         –118        52   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from financing activities

        –9,508         –9,385        –6,494   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash

        641         –1,752        –217   

Net change in cash

        –2,587         6,006        7,812   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period

        44,682         38,676        30,864   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of period

     C25         42,095         44,682        38,676   
     

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Includes payment of external loan of SEK -6.2 billion attributable to the acquisition of Telcordia.

 

45


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY

Equity and Other comprehensive income 2013

 

SEK million

   Capital
stock
     Additional
paid in
capital
     Retained
earnings
    Stock-
holders’
equity
    Non-
controlling
interest
     Total
equity
 

January 1, 2013

     16,526         24,731         95,626        136,883        1,600         138,483   

Net income

               

Group

     —           —           12,135        12,135        169         12,304   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           –130        –130        —           –130   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income

               

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

               

Remeasurements related to post-employment benefits

               

Group

     —           —           3,214        3,214        —           3,214   

Tax on items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

     —           —           –1,235        –1,235        —           –1,235   

Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

               

Cash flow hedges

               

Gains/losses arising during the year

               

Group

     —           —           251        251        —           251   

Reclassification adjustments for gains/losses included in profit or loss

     —           —           –1,072 1)      –1,072        —           –1,072   

Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations

               

Group

     —           —           71        71        —           71   

Changes in cumulative translation adjustments

               

Group

     —           —           –1,687 2)      –1,687        0         –1,687   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           –14        –14        —           –14   

Tax on items that may be reclassified to profit or loss3)

     —           —           179        179        —           179   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

     —           —           –293        –293        —           –293   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     —           —           11,712        11,712        169         11,881   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Transactions with owners

               

Stock issue

     —           —           —          —          —           —     

Sale/repurchase of own shares

     —           —           90        90        —           90   

Stock purchase plans

               

Group

     —           —           388        388        —           388   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           —          —          —           —     

Dividends paid

     —           —           –8,863        –8,863 4)      –290         –9,153   

Transactions with non-controlling interest

     —           —           –6        –6        –60         –66   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

December 31, 2013

     16,526         24,731         98,947        140,204        1,419         141,623   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) SEK –754 million is recognized in Net sales, SEK –495 million is recognized in Cost of sales, SEK 177 million is recognized in R&D expenses.
2) Changes in cumulative translation adjustments include changes regarding revaluation of goodwill in local currency of SEK –204 million (SEK –1,400 million in 2012 and SEK 46 million in 2011), gain/loss from hedging activities of foreign entities, SEK 0 million (SEK 0 million in 2012 and SEK 9 million in 2011), and realized gain/losses net from sold/liquidated companies, SEK –20 million (SEK –461 million in 2012 and SEK 192 million in 2011).
3) For further disclosures, see Note C8, “Taxes.”
4) Dividends paid per share amounted to SEK 2.75 (SEK 2.50 in 2012 and SEK 2.25 in 2011).

 

46


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Equity and Other comprehensive income 2012

 

SEK million

   Capital
stock
     Additional
paid in
capital
     Retained
earnings
     Stock-
holders’
equity
     Non-
controlling
interest
     Total
equity
 

January 1, 2012

     16,367         24,731         102,007         143,105         2,165         145,270   

Net income

                 

Group

     —           —           17,411         17,411         163         17,574   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           –11,636         –11,636         —           –11,636   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income

                 

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

                 

Remeasurements related to post-employment benefits

                 

Group

     —           —           –451         –451         —           –451   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           50         50         —           50   

Tax on items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

     —           —           –59         –59         —           –59   

Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

                 

Cash flow hedges

                 

Gains/losses arising during the year

                 

Group

     —           —           1,668         1,668         —           1,668   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           –25         –25         —           –25   

Reclassification adjustments for gains/losses included in profit or loss

     —           —           –568         –568         —           –568   

Adjustments for amounts transferred to initial carrying amount of hedged items

     —           —           92         92         —           92   

Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations

                 

Group

     —           —           6         6         —           6   

Changes in cumulative translation adjustments

                 

Group

     —           —           –3,898         –3,898         –49         –3,947   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           –511         –511         —           –511   

Tax on items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

     —           —           –363         –363         —           –363   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

     —           —           –4,059         –4,059         –49         –4,108   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     —           —           1,716         1,716         114         1,830   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Transactions with owners

                 

Stock issue

     159         —           —           159         —           159   

Sale/repurchase of own shares

     —           —           –93         –93         —           –93   

Stock purchase plans

                 

Group

     —           —           405         405         —           405   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           —           —           —           —     

Dividends paid

     —           —           –8,033         –8,033         –599         –8,632   

Transactions with non-controlling interest

     —           —           –376         –376         –80         –456   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

December 31, 2012

     16,526         24,731         95,626         136,883         1,600         138,483   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

47


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Equity and Other comprehensive income 2011

 

SEK million

   Capital
stock
     Additional
paid in
capital
     Retained
earnings
     Stock-
holders’
equity
     Non-
controlling
interest
     Total
equity
 

January 1, 2011

     16,367         24,731         104,008         145,106         1,679         146,785   

Net income

                 

Group

     —           —           15,727         15,727         375         16,102   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           –3,533         –3,533         —           –3,533   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income

                 

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

                 

Remeasurements related to post-employment benefits

                 

Group

     —           —           –6,963         –6,963         —           –6,963   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           –212         –212         —           –212   

Tax on items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

     —           —           1,810         1,810         —           1,810   

Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

                 

Cash flow hedges

                 

Gains/losses arising during the year

                 

Group

     —           —           996         996         —           996   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           11         11         —           11   

Reclassification adjustments for gains/losses included in profit or loss

     —           —           –2,028         –2,028         —           –2,028   

Changes in cumulative translation adjustments

                 

Group

     —           —           –1,014         –1,014         50         –964   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           –61         –61         —           –61   

Tax on items that may be reclassified to profit or loss

     —           —           348         348         —           348   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income, net of tax

     —           —           –7,113         –7,113         50         –7,063   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income

     —           —           5,081         5,081         425         5,506   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Transactions with owners

                 

Sale of own shares

     —           —           92         92         —           92   

Stock purchase plans

                 

Group

     —           —           413         413         —           413   

Joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —           —           —           —           —     

Dividends paid

     —           —           –7,207         –7,207         –248         –7,455   

Transactions with non-controlling interest

     —           —           –380         –380         309         –71   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

December 31, 2011

     16,367         24,731         102,007         143,105         2,165         145,270   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

48


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

C1    SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Introduction

The consolidated financial statements comprise Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, the Parent Company, and its subsidiaries (“the Company”) and the Company’s interests in joint ventures and associated companies. The Parent Company is domiciled in Sweden at Torshamnsgatan 21, SE-164 83 Stockholm.

The consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2013 have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as endorsed by the EU and RFR 1 “Additional rules for Group Accounting,” related interpretations issued by the Swedish Financial Reporting Board (Rådet för finansiell rapportering), and the Swedish Annual Accounts Act. For the financial reporting of 2013, the Company has applied IFRS as issued by the IASB (IFRS effective as of December 31, 2013) and with early application in relation to the amendment to IAS 36, “Impairment of assets” on recoverable amount disclosures. There is no difference between IFRS effective as of December 31, 2013, and IFRS as endorsed by the EU, nor is RFR 1 related interpretations issued by the Swedish Financial Reporting Board (Rådet för Finansiell Rapportering) or the Swedish Annual Accounts Act in conflict with IFRS, for all periods presented.

The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on March 5, 2014. The balance sheets and income statements are subject to approval by the Annual General Meeting of shareholders.

New standards, amendments of standards and interpretations, effective as from January 1, 2013 are as follows:

 

   

Amendment to IAS 1, “Financial statement presentation regarding Other comprehensive income”. The main change resulting from this amendment is a requirement for entities to group items presented in “other comprehensive income” (OCI) on the basis of whether or not they are potentially recycled to profit or loss (reclassification adjustments).

 

   

Amendment to IAS 19, “Employee benefits” eliminates the corridor approach and calculates finance costs on a net funding basis. The Company implemented the immediate and full recognition of actuarial gains/losses in “Other comprehensive income” (OCI) in 2006, meaning that the corridor method has not been applied by the Company as from that date and therefore the transition to the revised IAS 19 has not had an effect on the present obligation and equity except for the reclassification described below. The main issue to address is the implementation of the net interest cost/income, which integrates the interest cost and expected interest income on assets to be based on a common discount rate. The impact for fiscal year 2012 in relation to this amendment would have been an increase in pension costs for 2012 of SEK 0.4 billion if it had been restated.

The Company has addressed the taxes to be incorporated into the defined benefit obligation. The Swedish special payroll taxes have been reclassified from “Other current liabilities” to “Post-employment benefits” with an amount of SEK 1.8 billion as of January 1, 2013. The amendment also includes additional disclosure requirements on yearly financial and demographic assumptions, sensitivity analysis, duration and multi-employer plans.

 

   

Amendment to IFRS 7, “Financial instruments: Disclosures’ on asset and liability offsetting.” This amendment requires disclosure of gross amounts related to financial instruments for which offset has been made.

 

   

IFRS 10, “Consolidated financial statements.” The objective of IFRS 10 is to establish principles for the presentation and preparation of consolidated financial statements when an entity controls one or more other entities to present consolidated financial statements. It defines the principle of control, and establishes control as the basis for consolidation. It sets out how to apply the principle of control to identify whether an investor controls an investee and therefore must consolidate the investee. An entity controls an investee if the entity has power over the investee, has the ability to use the power and is exposed to variable returns. It also sets out the accounting requirements for the preparation of consolidated financial statements.

 

   

IFRS 11, “Joint arrangements” focuses on the rights and obligations of the arrangement rather than its legal form. There are two types of joint arrangement: joint operations and joint ventures. Proportional consolidation of joint ventures is no longer allowed. The Company did not apply the proportionate consolidation method prior to 2013.

 

   

IFRS 12, “Disclosures of interests in other entities” includes the disclosure requirements for all forms of interests in other entities, including joint arrangements, associates, structured entities and other off-balance-sheet vehicles as well as non-controlling interests in the subsidiaries of the Company. The conclusion from the Company’s adoption analysis of IFRS 12 is that as of December 31, 2013 the Company experienced no material impact as a result of this new standard that would require separate disclosures of non-controlling interests or associated companies or joint ventures as of this date. An exception to this relates to the Company’s ownership in the associated company Rockstar Inc.

 

   

IFRS 13, “Fair value measurement” does not extend the use of fair value accounting but provides guidance on how it should be applied where its use is already required or permitted by other standards within IFRS. This standard has also added disclosure requirements to IAS 34, Interim Financial Reporting, regarding the disclosure for financial instruments.

 

   

IAS 27 (revised 2011), “Separate financial statements” includes the provisions on separate financial statements that remain after the control provisions of IAS 27 have been included in the new IFRS 10.

 

   

IAS 28 (revised 2011), “Associates and joint ventures” includes the requirements for joint ventures, as well as associates, to be equity accounted following the issue of IFRS 11.

 

   

Amendment to IAS 36, “Impairment of assets” on recoverable amount disclosures. This amendment addresses the disclosure of information about the recoverable amount of impaired assets if that amount is based on fair value less costs of disposal.

None of the new or amended standards and interpretations have had any significant impact on the financial result or position nor on the disclosure of the Company.

For information on “New standards and interpretations not yet adopted,” refer to the end of this Note.

 

49


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Change of hedge accounting

Due to cost efficiency reasons the Company has changed the hedge accounting.

The Company hedges highly probable forecast transactions related to sales and purchases with the purpose to limit the impact related to currency fluctuations on these forecasted transactions. This will not be changed.

The Company has, however, decided to discontinue hedge accounting for this type of hedges. Until 2012 the Company applied cash flow hedge accounting for highly probable forecast transactions. Revaluation of these hedges (incepted prior to January 1, 2013) has, prior to release, been reported under “Other comprehensive income” and is at release recycled to Sales, Cost of sales and R&D expenses respectively.

As from 2013, revaluation of new hedges (inception as from January 1, 2013) is reported under “Other operating income and expenses” in the Income statement.

Basis of presentation

The financial statements are presented in millions of Swedish Krona (SEK). They are prepared on a historical cost basis, except for certain financial assets and liabilities that are stated at fair value: derivative financial instruments, financial instruments held for trading, financial instruments classified as available-for-sale and plan assets related to defined benefit pension plans. Financial information in the consolidated income statement, the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, the consolidated statement of cash flows and the consolidated statement of changes in equity with related notes are presented with two comparison years while for the consolidated balance sheet financial information with related notes is presented with only one comparison year.

Basis of consolidation and composition of the group

The consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with the purchase method. Accordingly, consolidated stockholders’ equity includes equity in subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated companies earned only after their acquisition.

As from January 1, 2013, subsidiaries are all companies for which Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, directly or indirectly, is the parent. To be classed as a parent, Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, directly or indirectly, must control another company which requires that the Parent Company has power over that other company, is exposed to variable returns from its involvement and has the ability to use its power over that other company. The financial statements of subsidiaries are included in the consolidated financial statements from the date that control commences until the date that such control ceases.

Before 2013, subsidiaries were all companies in which Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, directly or indirectly, had an ownership interest, including effective potential voting rights; companies over which the Company had the power to govern the financial and operating policies generally associated with ownership of more than one half of the voting rights; or companies over which Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, directly or indirectly, by agreement had control. The financial statements of subsidiaries were included in the consolidated financial statements from the date that control commenced until the date that control ceases. The change as from 2013 was made due to a change of IFRS, as disclosed under Introduction: see IFRS 10, “Consolidated financial statements.”

Intra-group balances and any unrealized income and expense arising from intra-group transactions are fully eliminated in preparing the consolidated financial statements. Unrealized losses are eliminated in the same way as unrealized gains, but only to the extent that there is no evidence of impairment.

The Company is composed of a parent company, Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, with generally fully-owned subsidiaries in many countries of the world. The largest operating subsidiaries are the fully-owned telecom vendor companies Ericsson AB, incorporated in Sweden and Ericsson Inc., incorporated in the US.

Business combinations

At the acquisition of a business, the cost of the acquisition, being the purchase price, is measured as the fair value of the assets given, and liabilities incurred or assumed at the date of exchange, including any cost related to contingent consideration. Transaction costs attributable to the acquisition are expensed as incurred. The acquisition cost is allocated to acquired assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities based upon appraisals made, including assets and liabilities that were not recognized on the acquired entity’s balance sheet, for example intangible assets such as customer relations, brands, patents and financial liabilities. Goodwill arises when the purchase price exceeds the fair value of recognizable acquired net assets. In acquisitions with non-controlling interests full or partial goodwill can be recognized. Final amounts are established within one year after the transaction date at the latest.

In case there is a put option for non-controlling interest in a subsidiary a corresponding financial liability is recognized.

Non-controlling interest

The Company treats transactions with non-controlling interests as transactions with equity owners of the Company. For purchases from non-controlling interests, the difference between any consideration paid and the relevant share acquired of the carrying value of net assets of the subsidiary is recorded in equity. Gains or losses on disposals to non-controlling interests are also recorded in equity.

When the Company ceases to have control, any retained interest in the entity is remeasured to its fair value, with the change in carrying amount recognized in profit or loss. The fair value is the initial carrying amount for the purposes of subsequently accounting for the retained interest in an associate, joint venture or financial asset. In addition, any amounts previously recognized in Other comprehensive income in respect of that entity are accounted for as if the Company had directly disposed of the related assets or liabilities. This may mean that amounts previously recognized in Other comprehensive income are reclassified to profit or loss.

At acquisition, there is a choice on an acquisition-by-acquisition basis to measure the non-controlling interest in the acquiree either at fair value or at the non-controlling interest’s proportionate share of the acquiree’s net assets.

Joint ventures and associated companies

Both joint ventures and associated companies are accounted for in accordance with the equity method. Under the equity method, the investment in an associate or joint venture is initially recognized at cost and the carrying amount is increased or decreased to recognize the investor’s share of the profit or loss of the investee after the date of acquisition. If the Company’s interest in an associated company or joint venture is nil, the Company shall not, as prescribed by IFRS, recognize its part of any future losses. Provisions related to obligations for such an interest shall, however, be recognized in relation to such an interest.

As from January 1, 2013, JVs are classed as ownership interests under which the Company has joint control of another company, as prescribed under IFRS 11, “Joint Arrangements,” a new standard effective as from 2013: see Introduction. Prior to 2013, JVs were classed as ownership interests where a joint influence was obtained through agreement. IFRS 11 has not changed the Company’s accounting treatment of JVs.

Investments in associated companies, i.e. when the Company has significant influence and the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of the associated company, but is not in

 

50


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

control or joint control over those policies. Normally this is the case in voting stock interest, including effective potential voting rights, which stand at at least 20% but not more than 50%.

The Company’s share of income before taxes is reported in item “Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies”, included in Operating Income. This reflects the fact that these interests are held for operating rather than investing or financial purposes. Ericsson’s share of income taxes related to joint ventures and associated companies is reported under the line item Taxes in the income statement.

Unrealized gains on transactions between the Company and its associated companies and joint ventures are eliminated to the extent of the Company’s interest in these entities. Unrealized losses are also eliminated unless the transaction provides evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred.

Shares in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies included in consolidated equity which are undistributed are reported in Retained earnings in the balance sheet.

Impairment testing as well as recognition or reversal of impairment of investments in each joint venture is performed in the same manner as for intangible assets other than goodwill. The entire carrying value of each investment, including goodwill, is tested as a single asset. See also description under “Intangible assets other than goodwill” below.

If the ownership interest in an associate is reduced but significant influence is retained, only a proportionate share of the amounts previously recognized in Other comprehensive income are reclassified to profit or loss where appropriate.

In Note C2, “Critical Accounting Estimates and Judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Foreign currency remeasurement and translation

Items included in the financial statements of each entity of the Company are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates (‘the functional currency’). The consolidated financial statements are presented in Swedish Krona (SEK), which is the Parent Company’s functional and presentation currency.

Transactions and balances

Foreign currency transactions are translated into the functional currency using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of each respective transactions. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the translation at period-end exchange rates of monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognized in the income statement, unless deferred in Other comprehensive income under the hedge accounting practices as described below.

Changes in the fair value of monetary securities denominated in foreign currency classified as available-for-sale are analyzed between translation differences resulting from changes in the amortized cost of the security and other changes in the carrying amount of the security. Translation differences related to changes in the amortized cost are recognized in profit or loss, and other changes in the carrying amount are recognized in OCI.

Translation differences on non-monetary financial assets and liabilities are reported as part of the fair value gain or loss.

Group companies

The results and financial position of all the group entities that have a functional currency different from the presentation currency are translated into the presentation currency as follows:

 

   

Assets and liabilities for each balance sheet presented are translated at the closing rate at the date of that balance sheet

 

   

Income and expenses for each income statement are translated at average exchange rates

 

   

All resulting net exchange differences are recognized as a separate component of OCI.

On consolidation, exchange differences arising from the translation of the net investment in foreign operations, and of borrowings and other currency instruments designated as hedges of such investments, are accounted for in OCI. When a foreign operation is partially disposed of or sold, exchange differences that were recorded in OCI are recognized in the income statement as part of the gain or loss on sale.

Goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on the acquisition of a foreign entity are treated as assets and liabilities of the foreign entity and translated at the closing rate.

There is no significant impact due to any currency of a hyperinflationary economy.

Statement of cash flows

The statement of cash flow is prepared in accordance with the indirect method. Cash flows in foreign subsidiaries are translated at the average exchange rate during the period. Payments for subsidiaries acquired or divested are reported as cash flow from investing activities, net of cash and cash equivalents acquired or disposed of, respectively.

Cash and cash equivalents consist of cash, bank, and short-term investments that are highly liquid monetary financial instruments with a remaining maturity of three months or less at the date of acquisition.

Revenue recognition

Background

The Company offers a comprehensive portfolio of telecommunication and data communication systems, professional services, and multimedia solutions. Products, both hardware and software as well as services, are in general standardized. The impact of this is that any acceptance terms are normally only formal requirements. In Note C3, “Segment information,” the Company’s products and services are disclosed in more detail as per operating segment.

The Company’s products and services are generally sold under delivery-type or multi-year recurring services contracts. The delivery type contracts often contain content from more than one segment.

Accounting treatment

Sales are based on fair values of consideration received and recorded net of value added taxes, goods returned and estimated trade discounts. Revenue is recognized when risks and rewards have been transferred to the customer, with reference to all significant contractual terms, when:

 

   

The product or service has been delivered

 

   

The revenue amount is fixed or determinable

 

   

The customer has received and activation has been made of separately sold software

 

   

Collection is reasonably assured

Estimations of contractual performance criteria impact the timing and amounts of revenue recognized and may therefore defer revenue recognition until the performance criteria are met. The profitability of contracts is periodically assessed, and provisions for any estimated losses are made immediately when losses are probable.

Allocation and/or timing criteria specific to each type of contract are:

 

   

Delivery-type contracts – These contracts relate to delivery, installation, integration of products and provision of related services, normally under multiple elements contracts. Under multiple elements contracts, accounting is based on that the revenue recognition criteria are applied to the separately identifiable components of the contract. Revenue, including the impact of any discount or rebate, is allocated to each element based on relative fair values. Networks, Global Services and Support Solutions have contracts that relate to this type of arrangement.

 

51


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

 

   

Contracts for services – These relate to multi-year service contracts such as support – and managed service contracts and other types of recurring services. Revenue is recognized when the services have been provided, generally pro rata over the contract period. Global Services has contracts that relate to this type of arrangement.

 

   

Contracts generating license fees from third parties for the use of the Company’s intellectual property rights – License fees are normally measured as a percentage of sales or currency amount per unit and recognized over the license period as the amount of the consideration becomes reasonably certain. Networks and Support Solutions have contracts that relate to this type of arrangement.

For sales between consolidated companies, associated companies, joint ventures and segments, the Company applies arm’s length pricing.

In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” a further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Earnings per share

Basic earnings per share are calculated by dividing net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company by the weighted average number of shares outstanding (total number of shares less treasury stock) during the year.

Diluted earnings per share are calculated by dividing net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company, when appropriate adjusted by the sum of the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding and dilutive potential ordinary shares. Potential ordinary shares are treated as dilutive when, and only when, their conversion to ordinary shares would decrease earnings per share.

Rights to matching shares are considered dilutive when the actual fulfillment of any performance conditions as of the reporting date would give a right to ordinary shares.

Financial assets

Financial assets are recognized when the Company becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. Regular purchases and sales of financial assets are recognized on the settlement date.

Financial assets are derecognized when the rights to receive cash flows from the investments have expired or have been transferred and the Company has transferred substantially all risks and rewards of ownership. Separate assets or liabilities are recognized if any rights and obligations are created or retained in the transfer.

The Company classifies its financial assets in the following categories: at fair value through profit or loss, loans and receivables, and available-for-sale. The classification depends on the purpose for which the financial assets were acquired. Management determines the classification of its financial assets at initial recognition.

Financial assets are initially recognized at fair value plus transaction costs for all financial assets not carried at fair value through profit or loss. Financial assets carried at fair value through profit or loss are initially recognized at fair value, and transaction costs are expensed in the income statement.

The fair values of quoted financial investments and derivatives are based on quoted market prices or rates. If official rates or market prices are not available, fair values are calculated by discounting the expected future cash flows at prevailing interest rates. Valuations of foreign exchange options and Interest Rate Guarantees (IRG) are made by using the Black-Scholes formula. Inputs to the valuations are market prices for implied volatility, foreign exchange and interest rates.

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss are financial assets held for trading. A financial asset is classified in this category if acquired principally for the purpose of selling or repurchasing in the near term.

Derivatives are classified as held for trading, unless they are designated as hedges. Assets in this category are classified as current assets.

Gains or losses arising from changes in the fair values of the “Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss” category (excluding derivatives) are presented in the income statement within Financial income in the period in which they arise. Derivatives are presented in the income statement either as Cost of sales, Other operating income, Financial income or Financial expense, depending on the intent with the transaction.

Loans and receivables

Receivables, including those that relate to customer financing, are subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective interest rate method, less allowances for impairment charges. Trade receivables include amounts due from customers. The balance represents amounts billed to customers as well as amounts where risk and rewards have been transferred to the customer but the invoice has not yet been issued.

Collectability of the receivables is assessed for purposes of initial revenue recognition.

Available-for-sale financial assets

Available-for-sale financial assets are non-derivatives that are either designated in this category or not classified in any of the other categories. They are included in non-current assets unless management intends to dispose of the investment within 12 months of the balance sheet date.

Dividends on available-for-sale equity instruments are recognized in the income statement as part of financial income when the Company’s right to receive payments is established.

Changes in the fair value of monetary securities denominated in a foreign currency and classified as available-for-sale are analyzed between translation differences resulting from changes in the amortized cost of the security and other changes in the carrying amount of the security. Translation differences on monetary securities are recognized in profit or loss; translation differences on non-monetary securities are recognized in OCI. Changes in the fair value of monetary and non-monetary securities classified as available-for-sale are recognized in OCI. When securities classified as available-for-sale are sold or impaired, the accumulated fair value adjustments previously recognized in OCI are included in the income statement.

Impairment

At each balance sheet date, the Company assesses whether there is objective evidence that a financial asset or a group of financial assets is impaired. In the case of equity securities classified as available-for-sale, a significant or prolonged decline in the fair value of the security below its cost is considered as evidence that the security is impaired. If any such evidence exists for available-for-sale financial assets, the cumulative loss – measured as the difference between the acquisition cost and the current fair value, less any impairment loss on that financial asset previously recognized in profit or loss – is removed from OCI and recognized in the income statement. Impairment losses recognized in the income statement on equity instruments are not reversed through the income statement.

An assessment of impairment of receivables is performed when there is objective evidence that the Company will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the original terms of the receivable. Significant financial difficulties of the debtor, probability that the debtor will enter bankruptcy or financial reorganization, and default or delinquency in payments are considered indicators that the trade receivable is impaired. The amount of the allowance is the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the present value of estimated future cash flows, discounted at the original effective interest rate. The carrying amount of the asset is reduced through the use of

 

52


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

an allowance account, and the amount of the loss is recognized in the income statement within selling expenses. When a trade receivable is finally established as uncollectible, it is written off against the allowance account for trade receivables. Subsequent recoveries of amounts previously written off are credited to selling expenses in the income statement.

Financial liabilities

Financial liabilities are recognized when the Company becomes bound to the contractual obligations of the instrument.

Financial liabilities are derecognized when they are extinguished, i.e. when the obligation specified in the contract is discharged, cancelled or expires.

Borrowings

Borrowings are initially recognized at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred. Borrowings are subsequently stated at amortized cost; any difference between the proceeds (net of transaction costs) and the redemption value is recognized in the income statement over the period of the borrowings using the effective interest method.

Borrowings are classified as current liabilities unless the Company has an unconditional right to defer settlement of the liability for at least 12 months after the balance sheet date.

Trade payables

Trade payables are recognized initially at fair value and subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method.

Hedge accounting

When applying hedge accounting, derivatives are initially recognized at fair value at trade date and subsequently re-measured at fair value. The method of recognizing the resulting gain or loss depends on whether the derivative is designated as a hedging instrument, and, if so, the nature of the item being hedged. The Company designates certain derivatives as either:

 

  a) Fair value hedges: a hedge of the fair value of recognized liabilities;

 

  b) Cash flow hedges: a hedge of a particular risk associated with a highly probable forecast transaction; or

 

  c) Net investment hedges: a hedge of a net investment in a foreign operation.

At the inception of the hedge, the Company documents the relationship between hedging instruments and hedged items, as well as its risk management objectives and strategy for undertaking various hedging transactions. The Company also documents its assessment, both at hedge inception and on an ongoing basis, of whether the derivatives that are used in hedging transactions are highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of the hedged items.

The fair values of various derivative instruments used for hedging purposes are disclosed in Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments.” Movements in the hedging reserve in OCI are shown in Note C16, “Equity and other comprehensive income.”

The fair value of a hedging derivative is classified as a non-current asset or liability when the remaining maturity of the hedged item is more than 12 months, and as a current asset or liability when the remaining maturity of the hedged item is less than 12 months. Trading derivatives are classified as current assets or liabilities.

As disclosed under Introduction in this note, the Company has decided to discontinue hedge accounting for certain derivatives, as for new transactions dated January 1st, 2013 or later.

Fair value hedges

Changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as fair value hedges are recorded in the income statement, together with any changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that are attributable to the hedged risk, when hedge accounting is applied. The Company only applies fair value hedge accounting for hedging fixed interest risk on borrowings. Both gains and losses relating to the interest rate swaps hedging fixed rate borrowings and the changes in the fair value of the hedged fixed rate borrowings attributable to interest rate risk are recognized in the income statement within Financial expenses. If the hedge no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting, the adjustment to the carrying amount of a hedged item for which the effective interest method is used is amortized to the income statement over the remaining period to maturity.

Cash flow hedges

When applying hedge accounting, the effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as cash flow hedges is recognized in OCI. The gain or loss relating to an ineffective portion is recognized immediately in the income statement within Financial income or expense.

Amounts deferred in OCI are recycled in the income statement in the periods when the hedged item affects profit or loss (for example, when the forecast sale that is hedged takes place), either in Net sales or Cost of sales. When the forecast transaction that is hedged results in the recognition of a non-financial asset (for example, inventory or fixed assets), the gains and losses previously deferred in OCI are transferred from OCI and included in the initial measurement of the cost of the asset. The deferred amounts are ultimately recognized in Cost of sales in case of inventory or in Depreciation in case of fixed assets. When a hedging instrument expires or is sold, or when a hedge no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting, any cumulative gain or loss which at that time remains in OCI is recognized in the income statement when the forecast transaction is ultimately recognized. When a forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur, the cumulative gain or loss that was reported in OCI is immediately transferred to the income statement within financial income or expense.

Net investment hedges

Hedges of net investments in foreign operations are accounted for similarly to cash flow hedges. Any gain or loss on the hedging instrument relating to the effective portion of the hedge is recognized in the cumulative translation adjustment (CTA). A gain or loss relating to an ineffective portion is recognized immediately in the income statement within Financial income or expense. Gains and losses deferred in CTA are included in the income statement when the foreign operation is partially disposed of or sold.

Financial guarantees

Financial guarantee contracts are initially recognized at fair value (i.e. usually the fee received). Subsequently, these contracts are measured at the higher of:

 

   

The amount determined as the best estimate of the net expenditure required to settle the obligation according to the guarantee contract.

 

   

The recognized contractual fee less cumulative amortization when amortized over the guarantee period, using the straight-line-method.

 

   

The best estimate of the net expenditure comprising future fees and cash flows from subrogation rights.

Inventories

Inventories are measured at the lower of cost or net realizable value on a first-in, first-out (FIFO) basis.

Risks of obsolescence have been measured by estimating market value based on future customer demand and changes in technology and customer acceptance of new products.

A significant part of Inventories is Contract work in progress (CWIP). Recognition and derecognition of CWIP relates to the Company’s revenue recognition principles meaning that costs incurred under

 

53


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

a customer contract are recognized as CWIP. When revenue is recognized, CWIP is derecognized and is instead recognized as Cost of sales.

In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Intangible assets

Intangible assets other than goodwill

Intangible assets other than goodwill comprise acquired intangible assets, such as patents, customer relations, trademarks and software, as well as capitalized development expenses and separately acquired intangible assets, mainly consisting of software. At initial recognition, acquired intangible assets related to business combinations are stated at fair value and capitalized development expenses and software are stated at cost. Subsequent to initial recognition, separately acquired intangible assets, mainly software and capitalized development expenses, are stated at initially recognized amounts less accumulated amortization and any impairment. Amortization and any impairment losses are included in Research and development expenses, which mainly consists of capitalized development expenses and patents; in Selling and administrative expenses, which mainly consists of expenses relating to customer relations and brands; and in Cost of sales.

Costs incurred for development of products to be sold, leased or otherwise marketed or intended for internal use are capitalized as from when technological and economic feasibility has been established until the product is available for sale or use. Research and development expenses directly related to orders from customers are accounted for as a part of Cost of sales. Other research and development expenses are charged to income as incurred. Amortization of acquired intangible assets, such as patents, customer relations, trademarks and software, is made according to the straight-line method over their estimated useful lives, not exceeding ten years. However, if the economic benefit related to an item of intangible assets is front-end loaded the amortization method reflects this. Thus, the amortization for such an item is amortized on a digressive curve basis and the asset value decreases by higher amounts in the beginning of its useful life compared to the end.

The Company has not recognized any intangible assets with indefinite useful life other than goodwill.

Impairment tests are performed whenever there is an indication of possible impairment. However, intangible assets not yet available for use are tested annually. An impairment loss is recognized if the carrying amount of an asset or its cash-generating unit exceeds its recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of the value in use and the fair value less costs to sell. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows after tax are discounted to their present value using an after-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset. Application of after tax amounts in calculation, both in relation to cash flows and discount rate is applied due to that available models for calculating discount rate include a tax component. The after tax discount rate applied by the Company is not materially different from a discounting based on before-tax future cash flows and before-tax discount rates, as required by IFRS.

Corporate assets have been allocated to cash-generating units in relation to each unit’s proportion of total net sales. The amount related to corporate assets is not significant. Impairment losses recognized in prior periods are assessed at each reporting date for any indications that the loss has decreased or no longer exists. An impairment loss is reversed if there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the recoverable amounts and if the recoverable amount is higher than the carrying value. An impairment loss is reversed only to the extent that the asset’s carrying amount after reversal does not exceed the carrying amount, net of amortization, which would have been reported if no impairment loss had been recognized.

In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Goodwill

As from the acquisition date, goodwill acquired in a business combination is allocated to each cash-generating unit (CGU) of the Company expected to benefit from the synergies of the combination. The Company’s four operating segments have been identified as CGUs. Goodwill is assigned to three of them: Networks, Global Services and Support Solutions.

An annual impairment test for the CGUs to which goodwill has been allocated is performed in the fourth quarter, or when there is an indication of impairment. Impairment testing as well as recognition of impairment of goodwill is performed in the same manner as for intangible assets other than goodwill: see description under “Intangible assets other than goodwill” above. An impairment loss in respect of goodwill is not reversed.

Additional disclosure is required in relation to goodwill impairment testing: see Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments” below and Note C10, “Intangible assets.”

Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment consist of real estate, machinery and other technical assets, other equipment, tools and installation and construction in process and advance payment. They are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and any impairment losses.

Depreciation is charged to income, generally on a straight-line basis, over the estimated useful life of each component of an item of property, plant and equipment, including buildings. Estimated useful lives are, in general, 25–50 years for real estate and 3–10 years for machinery and equipment. Depreciation and any impairment charges are included in Cost of sales, Research and development or Selling and administrative expenses.

The Company recognizes in the carrying amount of an item of property, plant and equipment the cost of replacing a component and derecognizes the residual value of the replaced component.

Impairment testing as well as recognition or reversal of impairment of property, plant and equipment is performed in the same manner as for intangible assets other than goodwill: see description under “Intangible assets other than goodwill” above.

Gains and losses on disposals are determined by comparing the proceeds less cost to sell with the carrying amount and are recognized within Other operating income and expenses in the income statement.

Leasing

Leasing when the Company is the lessee

Leases on terms in which the Company assumes substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership are classified as finance leases. Upon initial recognition, the leased asset is measured at an amount equal to the lower of its fair value and the present value of the minimum lease payments. Subsequent to initial recognition, the asset is accounted for in accordance with the accounting policy applicable to that type of asset, although the depreciation period must not exceed the lease term.

Other leases are operating leases, and the leased assets under such contracts are not recognized on the balance sheet. Costs under operating leases are recognized in the income statement on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease. Lease incentives received are recognized as an integral part of the total lease expense, over the term of the lease.

 

54


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Leasing when the Company is the lessor

Leasing contracts with the Company as lessor are classified as finance leases when the majority of risks and rewards are transferred to the lessee, and otherwise as operating leases. Under a finance lease, a receivable is recognized at an amount equal to the net investment in the lease and revenue is recognized in accordance with the revenue recognition principles.

Under operating leases the equipment is recorded as property, plant and equipment and revenue as well as depreciation is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

Income taxes

Income taxes in the consolidated financial statements include both current and deferred taxes. Income taxes are reported in the income statement unless the underlying item is reported directly in equity or OCI. For those items, the related income tax is also reported directly in equity or OCI. A current tax liability or asset is recognized for the estimated taxes payable or refundable for the current year or prior years.

Deferred tax is recognized for temporary differences between the book values of assets and liabilities and their tax values and for tax loss carry-forwards. A deferred tax asset is recognized only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits will be available against which the deductible temporary differences and tax loss carry-forwards can be utilized. In the recognition of income taxes, the Company offsets current tax receivables against current tax liabilities and deferred tax assets against deferred tax liabilities in the balance sheet, when the Company has a legal right to offset these items and the intention to do so. Deferred tax is not recognized for the following temporary differences: goodwill not deductible for tax purposes, for the initial recognition of assets or liabilities that affect neither accounting nor taxable profit, and for differences related to investments in subsidiaries when it is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future.

Deferred tax is measured at the tax rate that is expected to be applied to the temporary differences when they reverse, based on the tax laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the reporting date. An adjustment of deferred tax asset/liability balances due to a change in the tax rate is recognized in the income statement, unless it relates to a temporary difference earlier recognized directly in equity or OCI, in which case the adjustment is also recognized in equity or OCI.

The measurement of deferred tax assets involves judgment regarding the deductibility of costs not yet subject to taxation and estimates regarding sufficient future taxable income to enable utilization of unused tax losses in different tax jurisdictions. All deferred tax assets are subject to annual review of probable utilization. The largest amounts of tax loss carry-forwards relate to Sweden, which have an indefinite period of utilization.

In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Provisions and contingent liabilities

Provisions are made when there are legal or constructive obligations as a result of past events and when it is probable that an outflow of resources will be required to settle the obligations and the amounts can be reliably estimated. When the effect of the time value of money is material, discounting is made of estimated outflows. However, the actual outflows as a result of the obligations may differ from such estimates.

The provisions are mainly related to warranty commitments, restructuring, customer projects and other obligations, such as unresolved income tax and value added tax issues, claims or obligations as a result of patent infringement and other litigations, supplier claims and customer finance guarantees.

Product warranty commitments consider probabilities of all material quality issues based on historical performance for established products and expected performance for new products, estimates of repair cost per unit, and volumes sold still under warranty up to the reporting date.

A restructuring obligation is considered to have arisen when the Company has a detailed formal plan for the restructuring (approved by management), which has been communicated in such a way that a valid expectation has been raised among those affected.

Project-related provisions include estimated losses on onerous contracts, contractual penalties and undertakings. For losses on customer contracts, a provision equal to the total estimated loss is recorded when a loss from a contract is anticipated and possible to estimate reliably. These contract loss estimates include any probable penalties to a customer under a loss contract.

Other provisions include provisions for unresolved tax issues, litigations, supplier claims, customer finance and other provisions. The Company provides for estimated future settlements related to patent infringements based on the probable outcome of each infringement. The actual outcome or actual cost of settling an individual infringement may vary from the Company’s estimate.

The Company estimates the outcome of any potential patent infringement made known to the Company through assertion and through the Company’s own monitoring of patent-related cases in the relevant legal systems. To the extent that the Company makes the judgment that an identified potential infringement will more likely than not result in an outflow of resources, the Company records a provision based on the Company’s best estimate of the expenditure required to settle with the counterpart.

In the ordinary course of business, the Company is subject to proceedings, lawsuits and other unresolved claims, including proceedings under laws and government regulations and other matters. These matters are often resolved over a long period of time. The Company regularly assesses the likelihood of any adverse judgments in or outcomes of these matters, as well as potential ranges of possible losses. Provisions are recognized when it is probable that an obligation has arisen and the amount can be reasonably estimated based on a detailed analysis of each individual issue.

Certain present obligations are not recognized as provisions as it is not probable that an economic outflow will be required to settle the obligation or the amount of the obligation cannot be measured with sufficient reliability. Such obligations are reported as contingent liabilities. For further detailed information, see Note C24, “Contingent liabilities.” In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Post-employment benefits

Pensions and other post-employment benefits are classified as either defined contribution plans or defined benefit plans. Under a defined contribution plan, the Company’s only obligation is to pay a fixed amount to a separate entity (a pension trust fund) with no obligation to pay further contributions if the fund does not hold sufficient assets to pay all employee benefits. The related actuarial and investment risks fall on the employee. The expenditures for defined contribution plans are recognized as expenses during the period when the employee provides service.

Under a defined benefit plan, it is the Company’s obligation to provide agreed benefits to current and former employees. The related actuarial and investment risks fall on the Company.

As from January 1, 2013, the present value of the defined benefit obligations for current and former employees is calculated using the Projected Unit Credit Method. The discount rate for each country is determined by reference to market yields on high-quality corporate

 

55


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

bonds that have maturity dates approximating the terms of the Company’s obligations. In countries where there is no deep market in such bonds, the market yields on government bonds are used. The calculations are based upon actuarial assumptions, assessed on a quarterly basis, and are as a minimum prepared annually. Actuarial assumptions are the Company’s best estimate of the variables that determine the cost of providing the benefits. When using actuarial assumptions, it is possible that the actual results will differ from the estimated results or that the actuarial assumptions will change from one period to another. These differences are reported as actuarial gains and losses. They are, for example, caused by unexpectedly high or low rates of employee turnover, changed life expectancy, salary changes and changes in the discount rate. Actuarial gains and losses are recognized in OCI in the period in which they occur. The Company’s net liability for each defined benefit plan consists of the present value of pension commitments less the fair value of plan assets and is recognized net on the balance sheet. When the result is a net benefit to the Company, the recognized asset is limited to the present value of any future refunds from the plan or reductions in future contributions to the plan.

Interest cost on the defined benefit obligation and interest income on plan assets is calculated as a net interest amount by applying the discount rate to the net defined benefit liability. All past service costs are recognized immediately. Swedish special payroll tax is accounted for as a part of the pension cost and the pension liability respectively.

Payroll taxes related to actuarial gains and losses are included in determining actuarial gains and losses, reported under OCI.

Prior to 2013, the present value of the defined benefit obligations for current and former employees was calculated using the Projected Unit Credit Method. The discount rate for each country was determined by reference to market yields on high-quality corporate bonds that have maturity dates approximating the terms of the Company’s obligations. In countries where there is no deep market in such bonds, the market yields on government bonds were used. The calculations were based upon actuarial assumptions, assessed on a quarterly basis, and were as a minimum prepared annually. Actuarial assumptions were the Company’s best estimate of the variables that determine the cost of providing the benefits. When using actuarial assumptions, it was possible that the actual results differed from the estimated results or that the actuarial assumptions changed from one period to another. These differences were reported as actuarial gains and losses. They were, for example, caused by unexpectedly high or low rates of employee turnover, changed life expectancy, salary changes, changes in the discount rate and differences between actual and expected return on plan assets. Actuarial gains and losses were recognized in OCI in the period in which they occurred. The Company’s net liability for each defined benefit plan consists of the present value of pension commitments less the fair value of plan assets and was recognized net on the balance sheet. When the result was a net benefit to the Company, the recognized asset was limited to the total of any cumulative past service cost and the present value of any future refunds from the plan or reductions in future contributions to the plan.

In Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to key sources of estimation uncertainty.

Share-based compensation to employees and the Board of Directors

Share-based compensation is related to remuneration to all employees, including key management personnel and the Board of Directors.

Under IFRS, a company shall recognize compensation costs for share-based compensation programs based on a measure of the value to the company of services received under the plans.

This value is based on the fair value of, for example, free shares at grant date, measured as stock price as of each investment date. The value at grant date is charged to the income statement as any other remuneration over the service period. For example, value at grant date is 90. Given the normal service period of three years within Ericsson, 30 would be charged per year during the service period.

The amount charged to the income statement is reversed in equity each time of the income statement charge.

The reason for this IFRS accounting principle is that compensation cost is a cost with no direct cash flow impact. The purpose of share-based accounting according to IFRS (IFRS 2) is to present the impact of share-based programs, being part of the total remuneration, in the income statement.

Compensation to employees

Stock purchase plans

        For stock purchase plans, compensation costs are recognized during the vesting period, based on the fair value of the Ericsson share at the employee’s investment date. The fair value is based upon the share price at investment date, adjusted for the fact that no dividends will be received on matching shares prior to matching and other features that are non-vesting conditions. The employee pays a price equal to the share price at investment date for the investment shares. The investment date is considered as the grant date. In the balance sheet, the corresponding amounts are accounted for as equity. Vesting conditions are non-market-based and affect the number of shares that Ericsson will match. Other features of a share-based payment are non-vesting conditions. These features would need to be included in the grant date fair value for transactions with employees and others providing similar services. Non-vesting conditions would not impact the number of awards expected to vest or valuation thereof subsequent to grant date. When calculating the compensation costs for shares under performance-based matching programs, the Company at each reporting date assesses the probability that the performance targets will be met. Compensation expenses are based on estimates of the number of shares that will match at the end of the vesting period. When shares are matched, social security charges are to be paid in certain countries on the value of the employee benefit. The employee benefit is generally based on the market value of the shares at the matching date. During the vesting period, estimated amounts for such social security charges are expensed and accrued.

Compensation to the Board of Directors

During 2008, the Parent Company introduced a share-based compensation program as a part of the remuneration to the Board of Directors. The program gives non-employee Directors elected by the General Meeting of Shareholders a right to receive part of their remuneration as a future payment of an amount which corresponds to the market value of a share of class B in the Parent Company at the time of payment, as further disclosed in Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees.” The cost for cash settlements is measured and recognized based on the estimated costs for the program on a pro rata basis during the service period, being one year. The estimated costs are remeasured during and at the end of the service period.

Segment reporting

An operating segment is a component of a company whose operating results are regularly reviewed by the Company’s chief operating decision maker, (CODM), to make decisions about resources to be allocated to the segment and assess its performance. Within the Company, the Group Management Team is defined as the CODM function.

The segment presentation is based on the Company’s accounting policies as disclosed in this note. The arm’s length principle is applied in transactions between the segments.

 

56


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

The Company’s segment disclosure about geographical areas is based on the country in which transfer of risks and rewards occur.

New standards and interpretations not yet adopted

A number of issued new standards, amendments to standards and interpretations are not yet effective for the year ended December 31, 2013 and have not been applied in preparing these consolidated financial statements.

Below is a list of standards/interpretations, applicable for the Company, that have been issued and are effective for the periods starting from January 1, 2014 if not otherwise stated. These amendments effective as from January 1, 2014 are not expected to have a significant impact on the Company’s financial result or position.

 

   

Amendment to IAS 32, “Financial instruments: Presentation,” on asset and liability offsetting. This amendment i related to the application of guidance in IAS 32, ‘Financial instruments: Presentation,’ and clarifies some of the requirements for offsetting financial assets and financial liabilities on the balance sheet. This amendment is effective as from 1 January, 2014.

 

   

IFRIC 21, “Levies.” This sets out the accounting for an obligation to pay a levy that is not income tax. The interpretation addresses what the obligating event is that gives rise to the need to pay a levy and when a liability should be recognized.

 

   

IFRS 9, “Financial instruments.” IFRS 9 is the first standard issued as part of a wider project to replace IAS 39. IFRS 9 retains but simplifies the mixed measurement model and establishes two primary measurement categories for financial assets: amortized cost and fair value. This amendment is expected to be effective as from 1 January, 2015 or later. The EU has not yet endorsed IFRS 9, ‘Financial instruments.’

C2    CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND JUDGMENTS

The preparation of financial statements and application of accounting standards often involve management’s judgment and the use of estimates and assumptions deemed to be reasonable at the time they are made. However, other results may be derived with different judgments or using different assumptions or estimates, and events may occur that could require a material adjustment to the carrying amount of the asset or liability affected. Following are the most important accounting policies subject to such judgments and the key sources of estimation uncertainty that the Company believes could have the most significant impact on the reported results and financial position.

The information in this note is grouped as per:

 

   

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

 

   

Judgments management has made in the process of applying the Company’s accounting policies.

Revenue recognition

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Examples of estimates of total contract revenue and cost that are necessary are the assessing of customer possibility to reach conditional purchase volumes triggering contractual discounts to be given to the customer, the impact on the Company revenue in relation to performance criteria and whether any loss provisions shall be made.

Judgments made in relation to accounting policies applied

Parts of the Company’s sales are generated from large and complex customer contracts. Managerial judgment is applied regarding, among other aspects, conformance with acceptance criteria and if transfer of risks and rewards to the buyer has taken place to determine if revenue and costs should be recognized in the current period, degree of completion and the customer credit standing to assess whether payment is likely or not to justify revenue recognition.

Trade and customer finance receivables

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

The Company monitors the financial stability of its customers and the environment in which they operate to make estimates regarding the likelihood that the individual receivables will be paid. Total allowances for estimated losses as of December 31, 2013, were SEK 1.2 (1.1) billion or 1.6% (1.5%) of gross trade and customer finance receivables.

Credit risks for outstanding customer finance credits are regularly assessed as well, and allowances are recorded for estimated losses.

Inventory valuation

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Inventories are valued at the lower of cost and net realizable value. Estimates are required in relation to forecasted sales volumes and inventory balances. In situations where excess inventory balances are identified, estimates of net realizable values for the excess volumes are made. Inventory allowances for estimated losses as of December 31, 2013, amounted to SEK 2.5 (3.5) billion or 10% (11%) of gross inventory.

Deferred taxes

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Deferred tax assets and liabilities, are recognized for temporary differences and for tax loss carry-forwards. Deferred tax is recognized net of valuation allowances. The valuation of temporary differences and tax loss carry-forwards, is based on management’s estimates of future taxable profits in different tax jurisdictions against which the temporary differences and loss carry-forwards may be utilized.

 

57


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

The largest amounts of tax loss carry-forwards are reported in Sweden, with an indefinite period of utilization (i.e. with no expiry date). For further detailed information, please refer to Note C8, “Taxes”.

At December 31, 2013, the value of deferred tax assets amounted to SEK 9.1 (12.3) billion. The deferred tax assets related to loss carry-forwards are reported as non-current assets.

Accounting for income tax, value added tax, and other taxes

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Accounting for these items is based upon evaluation of income-, value added- and other tax rules in all jurisdictions where we perform activities. The total complexity of rules related to taxes and the accounting for these require management’s involvement in judgments regarding classification of transactions and in estimates of probable outcomes of claimed deductions and/or disputes.

Acquired intellectual property rights and other intangible assets, including goodwill

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

At initial recognition, future cash flows are estimated, to ensure that the initial carrying values do not exceed the expected discounted cash flows for the items of this type of assets. After initial recognition, impairment testing is performed whenever there is an indication of impairment, except in the case of goodwill for which impairment testing is performed at least once per year. Negative deviations in actual cash flows compared to estimated cash flows as well as new estimates that indicate lower future cash flows might result in recognition of impairment charges.

For further discussion on goodwill, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies” and Note C10, “Intangible assets.” Estimates related to acquired intangible assets are based on similar assumptions and risks as for goodwill.

At December 31, 2013, the amount of acquired intellectual property rights and other intangible assets amounted to SEK 44.4 (45.6) billion, including goodwill of SEK 31.5 (30.4) billion.

Judgments made in relation to accounting policies applied

At initial recognition and subsequent remeasurement, management judgments are made, both for key assumptions and regarding impairment indicators. In the purchase price allocation made for each acquisition, the purchase price shall be assigned to the identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities based on fair values for these assets. Any remaining excess value is reported as goodwill. This allocation requires management judgment as well as the definition of cash-generating units for impairment testing purposes. Other judgments might result in significantly different results and financial position in the future.

Provisions

Warranty provisions

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Provisions for product warranties are based on current volumes of products sold still under warranty and on historic quality rates for mature products as well as estimates and assumptions regarding future quality rates for new products and estimates of costs to remedy the various qualitative issues that might occur. Total provisions for product warranties as of December 31, 2013, amounted to SEK 0.9 (1.6) billion.

Provisions other than warranty provisions

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Provisions, other than warranty provisions, mainly comprise amounts related to contractual obligations and penalties to customers and estimated losses on customer contracts, restructuring, risks associated with patent and other litigations, supplier or subcontractor claims and/ or disputes, as well as provisions for unresolved income tax and value added tax issues. The estimates related to the amounts of provisions for penalties, claims or losses receive special attention from the management. At December 31, 2013, provisions other than warranty commitments amounted to SEK 4.5 (7.0) billion. For further detailed information, see Note C18, “Provisions.”

Judgments made in relation to accounting policies applied

Whether a present obligation is probable or not requires judgment. The nature and type of risks for these provisions differ and management’s judgment is applied regarding the nature and extent of obligations in deciding if an outflow of resources is probable or not.

Contingent liabilities

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

As disclosed under ‘Provisions other than warranty provisions’ there are uncertainties in the estimated amounts. The same type of uncertainty exists for contingent liabilities.

Judgments made in relation to accounting policies

As disclosed under Note C1, “Significant accounting policies” a potential obligation that is not likely to result in an economic outflow is classified as a contingent liability, with no impact on the Company’s financial statements. However, should an obligation in a later period be deemed to be probable, then a provision shall be recognized, impacting the financial statements.

Pension and other post-employment benefits

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Accounting for the costs of defined benefit pension plans and other applicable post-employment benefits is based on actuarial valuations, relying on key estimates for discount rates, future salary increases, employee turnover rates and mortality tables. The discount rate assumptions are based on rates for high-quality fixed-income investments with durations as close as possible to the Company’s pension plans. At December 31, 2013, defined benefit obligations for pensions and other post-employment benefits amounted to SEK 52.9 (52.0) billion and fair value of plan assets to SEK 46.6 (44.6) billion. For more information on estimates and assumptions, see Note C17, “Post-employment benefits.”

Foreign exchange risks

Key sources of estimation uncertainty

Foreign exchange risk impacts the financial results of the Company: see further disclosure in Note C20, “Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments,” under Foreign Exchange Risk.

 

58


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C3    SEGMENT INFORMATION

Operating segments

When determining Ericsson’s operating segments, consideration has been given to which markets and what type of customers the products and services aim to attract, as well as the distribution channels they are sold through. Commonality regarding technology, research and development has also been taken into account. To best reflect the business focus and to facilitate comparability with peers, four operating segments are reported:

 

   

Networks

 

   

Global Services

 

   

Support Solutions

 

   

Modems

Networks delivers products and solutions for mobile access, IP and transport networks and core networks. The offering includes:

 

   

Radio access solutions that interconnect with devices such as mobile phones, tablets and PCs. The RBS 6000 supports all major standardized mobile technologies

 

   

IP and transport solutions based on the SSR 8000 family of products as well as transmission/backhaul including microwave (MINI-LINK) and optical transmission solutions for mobile and fixed networks

 

   

Switching and IMS solutions, based on the Ericsson Blade Server platform, for core networks

 

   

Operations Support Systems (OSS), supporting operators’ management of existing networks and introduction of new technologies and services.

Global Services delivers managed services, product-related services, consulting and systems integration services as well as broadcast services. The offering includes:

 

   

Managed Services: Services for designing, building, operating and managing the day-to-day operations of the customer’s network or solution; maintenance; network sharing solutions; plus shared solutions such as hosting of platforms and applications. Ericsson also offers managed services of IT environments.

 

   

Product-related services: Services to expand, upgrade, restructure or migrate networks; network-rollout services; customer support; and network optimization services.

 

   

Consulting and Systems Integration: Technology and operational consulting; integration of multi-vendor equipment; design and integration of new solutions and transforming programs. Industry-specific solutions for vertical industries are also included.

 

   

Broadcast Services: Services include responsibility for technical platforms and operational services related to TV content management, playout and service provisioning of a TV broadcaster’s business. Services cover live and pre-recorded, commercial and public service television.

Support Solutions provides enablers and applications for operators. The offering includes:

 

   

Operations Support Systems: plan, build and optimize, service fulfillment and service assurance.

 

   

Business Support Systems: revenue management (prepaid, post-paid, convergent charging and billing), mediation and customer care solutions.

 

   

TV solutions: a suite of open, standards-based solutions and products for the creation, management and delivery of evolved TV experiences on any device over any network. Includes a multi- screen TV platform with consumer experience creation, video content management, on-demand video delivery, advanced video compression and video-optimized delivery network infrastructure.

 

   

M-Commerce solutions for money transfer: payment transactions and services between mobile subscribers and operators or other service providers.

Modems performs design, development and sales of the LTE multimode thin modem solutions, including 2G, 3G and 4G interoperability.

Modems was consolidated into Ericsson as of October 1, 2013.

Former segments

ST-Ericsson was formed in 2009 as a joint venture between Ericsson and STMicroelectronics. Early 2013 the parents agreed to split up and close the joint venture. The company ST-Ericsson is winding down and all business has been transferred to parents or divested during 2013. The acquired business is now consolidated into Ericsson in the new segment Modems. As of January 1, 2013, ST-Ericsson is no longer reported as a separate segment.

As of December 31, 2012 there were no remaining investments related to ST-Ericsson on the Company’s balance sheet. For more information, see Note C12, “Financial assets.”

Sony Ericsson was, up until 2012, a joint venture delivering mobile phones and accessories. In February 2012, Ericsson completed the divestment of its 50% stake in Sony Ericsson to Sony. The sale resulted in a gain of SEK 7.7 billion. Sony Ericsson was not consolidated by the Company during 2012.

Unallocated

Some revenues, costs, assets and liabilities are not identified as part of any operating segment and are therefore not allocated. Examples of such items are costs for corporate staff, IT costs and general marketing costs.

Regions

The Regions are the Company’s primary sales channel. The Company operates worldwide and reports its operations divided into eleven regions:

 

   

North America

 

   

Latin America

 

   

Northern Europe & Central Asia

 

   

Western and Central Europe

 

   

Mediterranean

 

   

Middle East

 

   

Sub-Saharan Africa

 

   

India

 

   

North East Asia

 

   

South East Asia & Oceania

 

   

Other.

Region “Other” includes licensing revenues, broadcast services, power modules and other businesses.

Major customers

The Company does not have any customer for which revenues from transactions have exceeded 10% of the Company’s total revenues for the years 2013, 2012 or 2011.

We derive most of our sales from large, multi-year agreements with a limited number of significant customers. Out of a customer base of more than 400, mainly consisting of network operators, the 10 largest customers account for 44% (46%) of net sales. The largest customer accounted for approximately 8% (7%) of sales in 2013.

For more information, see Risk Factors, “Market, Technology and Business Risks.”

 

59


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Marketing channels

Marketing in a business-to-business environment is expanding, from being primarily conducted through personal meetings, to on-line forums, expert blogs and social media. Ericsson performs marketing through:

 

   

Customer engagement with a consultative approach

 

   

Selective focus on events and experience centers for customer experience and interaction

 

   

Continuous dialogue with customers and target audiences through social and other digital media (including virtual events)

 

   

Activation of the open social and digital media landscape to strengthen message reach and impact

 

   

Execution of solutions-driven programs, aligned globally and regionally.

Operating segments

 

2013

   Networks     Global
Services
    Support
Solutions
    Modems      Total
Segments
    Unallocated      Group  

Segment sales

     117,699        97,443        12,234        —           227,376        —           227,376   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net sales

     117,699        97,443        12,234        —           227,376        —           227,376   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating income

     11,318        6,185        1,455        –543         18,415        –570         17,845   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating margin (%)

     10     6     12     —           8     —           8

Financial income

                   1,346   

Financial expenses

                   –2,093   
                

 

 

 

Income after financial items

                   17,098   
                

 

 

 

Taxes

                   –4,924   
                

 

 

 

Net income

                   12,174   
                

 

 

 

Other segment items

                

Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies

     –155        60        –58        —           –153        23         –130   

Amortization

     –4,237        –925        –722        –44         –5,928        —           –5,928   

Depreciation

     –3,243        –788        –135        –61         –4,227        —           –4,227   

Impairment losses

     –5        –2        0        —           –7        —           –7   

Reversals of impairment losses

     19        5        1        —           25        —           25   

Restructuring expenses

     –2,182        –1,997        –186        —           –4,365        –88         –4,453   

Gains/losses from divestments

     –621        –166        –105        —           –892        51         –841   

 

Revenue from the acquired Telcordia business operation is reported 50/50 between segments Global Services and Support Solutions.

Operating segments

 

2012

  Networks     Global
Services
    Support
Solutions
    Sony
Ericsson
    ST-
Ericsson
    Total
Segments
    Unallocated     Eliminations1)     Group  

Segment sales

    117,185        97,009        13,445        —          8,457        236,096        —          –8,457        227,639   

Inter-segment sales

    100        34        6        —          634        774        —          –634        140   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net sales

    117,285        97,043        13,451        —          9,091        236,870        —          –9,091        227,779   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income

    7,057        6,226        1,150        8,026 2)      –15,447 3)      7,012        –267        3,713        10,458   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating margin (%)

    6     6     9     —          –170     3     —          —          5

Financial income

                    1,708   

Financial expenses

                    –1,984   
                 

 

 

 

Income after financial items

                    10,182   
                 

 

 

 

Taxes

                    –4,244   
                 

 

 

 

Net income

                    5,938   
                 

 

 

 

Other segment items

                 

Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies

    –59        45        –20        —          –11,734 3)      –11,768        37        —          –11,731   

Amortization

    –3,832        –853        –809        —          –322        –5,816        —          322        –5,494   

Depreciation

    –3,035        –727        –290        —          –741        –4,793        —          741        –4,052   

Impairment losses

    –385        –9        –1        —          —   4)      –395        —          —          –395   

Reversals of impairment losses

    39        9        4        —          —          52        —          —          52   

Write-down of investment

    —          —          —          —          –4,684        –4,684        —          —          –4,684   

Restructuring expenses

    –1,253        –1,930        –246        —          –624        –4,053        –18        624        –3,447   

Gains/losses from divestments

    –59        1        216        8,026 2)      —          8,184        152        —          8,336   

 

Revenue from the acquired Telcordia business operation is reported 50/50 between segments Global Services and Support Solutions.

1) All segment sales are presented, but as ST-Ericsson sales are accounted for in accordance with the equity method, their sales are eliminated in the Eliminations column.
2) Includes a gain from the divestment of Sony Ericsson of SEK 7.7 billion.
3) Includes a write-down of SEK –4.7 billion of the ST-Ericsson investment, a provision of SEK –3.3 billion and the Company’s share in ST-Ericsson’s operating loss of SEK –3.7 billion.
4) Impairment losses included in Write-down of investment.

 

60


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Operating segments

 

2011

  Networks     Global
Services
    Support
Solutions
    Sony
Ericsson
    ST-
Ericsson
    Total
Segments
    Unallocated     Eliminations1)     Group  

Segment sales

    131,596        83,854        10,629        46,866        9,232        282,177        —          –56,098        226,079   

Inter-segment sales

    799        30        13        126        1,461        2,429        —          –1,587        842   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net sales

    132,395        83,884        10,642        46,992        10,693        284,606        —          –57,685        226,921   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income

    17,295        5,544        –504        –1,854        –5,461        15,020        –501        3,381        17,900   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating margin (%)

    13     7     –5     –4     –51     5     —          —          8

Financial income

                    2,882   

Financial expenses

                    –2,661   
                 

 

 

 

Income after financial items

                    18,121   
                 

 

 

 

Taxes

                    –5,552   
                 

 

 

 

Net income

                    12,569   
                 

 

 

 

Other segment items

                 

Share in earnings of joint ventures and associated companies

    87        28        4        –1,199        –2,730        –3,810        32        —          –3,778   

Amortization

    –4,192        –481        –792        –1        –867        –6,333        —          868        –5,465   

Depreciation

    –2,783        –532        –184        –647        –823        –4,969        —          1,470        –3,499   

Impairment losses

    –50        –23        –12        —          –283        –368        —          283        –85   

Reversals of impairment losses

    12        —          1        —          —          13        —          —          13   

Restructuring expenses

    –1,600        –1,363        –143        –838        –280        –4,224        –78        1,118        –3,184   

Gains/losses from divestments

    –6        —          —          —          —          –6        164        —          158   

 

1) All segment sales are presented, but as Sony Ericsson and ST-Ericsson sales are accounted for in accordance with the equity method, their sales are eliminated in the Eliminations column.

Regions

 

     Net sales      Non-current assets5)  
     2013      2012      2011      2013      2012      2011  

North America3)

     59,339         56,749         48,785         13,290         15,058         6,296   

Latin America

     21,982         22,006         21,982         1,742         2,084         2,268   

Northern Europe & Central Asia1)2)

     11,618         11,345         15,225         38,522         38,335         41,008   

Western & Central Europe2)

     18,485         17,478         19,030         3,539         2,922         5,097   

Mediterranean2)

     24,156         23,299         23,807         1,089         1,099         1,395   

Middle East

     17,438         15,556         15,461         46         32         42   

Sub-Saharan Africa

     10,049         11,349         10,163         32         119         79   

India

     6,138         6,460         9,762         439         460         355   

North East Asia4)

     27,398         36,196         38,209         2,667         3,371         3,939   

South East Asia & Oceania

     15,787         15,068         13,870         342         301         318   

Other1)2)3)4)

     14,986         12,273         10,627         —           —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     227,376         227,779         226,921         61,708         63,781         60,797   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

1) Of which in Sweden

     4,427         5,033         3,882         38,049         37,718         40,415   

2) Of which in EU

     43,544         44,230         43,960         42,239         41,546         44,786   

3) Of which in the United States

     59,085         56,698         46,519         11,173         13,003         6,020   

4) Of which in China

     11,799         12,637         17,546         1,344         1,399         1,496   

 

5) Total non-current assets excluding financial instruments, deferred tax assets, and post-employment benefit assets.

For employee information, see Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees.”

 

61


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C4    NET SALES

Net sales

 

      2013      2012      2011  

Sales of products and network rollout services

     150,429         154,068         161,882   

Of which:

        

Delivery-type contracts

     150,429         154,068         161,882   

Professional Services sales

     66,395         67,092         58,834   

License revenues1)

     10,552         6,619         6,205   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net sales

     227,376         227,779         226,921   

Export sales from Sweden

     108,944         106,997         116,507   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Impact of Samsung IPR agreement: On January 27, 2014, Ericsson and Samsung signed an agreement on global patent licenses between the two companies. The terms of the agreement were substantially agreed between the two parties in December 2013 so Ericsson concluded that it was appropriate to record an amount of SEK 4.2 billion in Net Sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 which related to the license fee for 2013 and prior years.

C5    EXPENSES BY NATURE

Expenses by nature

 

     2013      2012      2011  

Goods and services

     129,453         137,769         142,221   

Employee remuneration

     65,064         64,100         58,905   

Amortization and depreciation

     10,155         9,546         8,964   

Impairments and obsolescence allowances, net of reversals

     537         1,999         1,363   

Financial expenses

     2,093         1,984         2,661   

Taxes

     4,924         4,244         5,552   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expenses incurred

     212,226         219,642         219,666   

Inventory changes1)

     –5,220         –2,782         3,417   

Additions to capitalized development

     915         1,641         1,515   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expenses charged to the income statement

     216,531         220,783         214,734   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) The inventory changes are based on changes of gross inventory values prior to obsolescence allowances.

Total restructuring charges in 2013 were SEK 4.5 (3.4) billion.

Restructuring charges are included in the expenses presented above.

Restructuring charges by function

 

     2013      2012      2011  

Cost of sales

     2,657         2,225         1,231   

R&D expenses

     872         852         561   

Selling and administrative expenses

     924         370         1,392   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total restructuring charges

     4,453         3,447         3,184   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

C6    OTHER OPERATING INCOME AND EXPENSES

Other operating income and expenses

 

     2013     2012     2011  

Gains on sales of intangible assets and PP&E

     172        12        65   

Losses on sales of intangible assets and PP&E

     –307        –261        –64   

Gains on sales of investments and operations

     69        8,462 1)      210   

Losses on sales of investments and operations

     –910        –126        –52   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Capital gains/losses, net

     –976        8,087        159   

Other operating revenues

     1,089 2)      878        1,119   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other operating income and expenses

     113        8,965        1,278   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Includes a gain from the divestment of Sony Ericsson of SEK 7.7 billion.
2) Includes revaluation of cash flow hedges of SEK 0.5 billion. For more information, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies.”

 

62


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C7    FINANCIAL INCOME AND EXPENSES

Financial income and expenses

 

     2013      2012      2011  
     Financial
income
     Financial
expenses
     Financial
income
     Financial
expenses
     Financial
income
     Financial
expenses
 

Contractual interest on financial assets

     971         —           1,685         —           1,940         —     

Of which on financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

     597         —           1,308         —           1,381         —     

Contractual interest on financial liabilities

     —           –1,412         —           –1,734         —           –1,706   

Net gains/losses on:

                 

Instruments at fair value through profit or loss1)

     447         –601         142         54         1,062         –591   

Of which included in fair value hedge relationships

     —           –196         —           –129         —           –175   

Loans and receivables

     –75         —           –127         —           –132         —     

Liabilities at amortized cost

     —           196         —           –133         —           –105   

Other financial income and expenses

     3         –276         8         –171         12         –259   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,346         –2,093         1,708         –1,984         2,882         –2,661   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Excluding net gain from operating assets and liabilities, SEK 49 million (net gain of SEK 1,299 million in 2012, SEK 51 million in 2011), reported as Cost of sales.

C8    TAXES

The Company’s tax expense for 2013 was SEK –4,924 (–4,244) million or 28.8% (41.7%) of income after financial items. The tax rate may vary between years depending on business and geographical mix.

Income taxes recognized in the income statement

 

     2013      2012      2011  

Current income taxes for the year

     –3,985         –5,795         –4,642   

Current income taxes related to prior years

     –26         –241         283   

Deferred tax income/expense (+/–)

     –913         1,697         –1,433   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal

     –4,924         –4,339         –5,792   

Share of taxes in joint ventures and associated companies

     0         95         240   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Tax expense

     –4,924         –4,244         –5,552   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

A reconciliation between reported tax expense for the year and the theoretical tax expense that would arise when applying statutory tax rate in Sweden, 22.0%, on the consolidated income before taxes, is shown in the table below.

Reconciliation of Swedish income tax rate with effective tax rate

 

     2013     2012     2011  

Expected tax expense at Swedish tax rate 22.0%

     –3,762        –2,678        –4,767   

Effect of foreign tax rates

     –935        –581        –1,126   

Of which joint ventures and associated companies

     —          –778        –754   

Current income taxes related to prior years

     –26        –241        283   

Remeasurement of tax loss carry-forwards

     165        134        224   

Remeasurement of deductible temporary differences

     86        468        81   

Tax effect of non-deductible expenses

     –620        –3,430        –768   

Tax effect of non-taxable income

     199        2,573        521   

Tax effect of changes in tax rates

     –31        –489        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tax expense

     –4,924        –4,244        –5,552   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effective tax rate

     28.8     41.7     30.6

Deferred tax balances

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are derived from the balance sheet items as shown in the table below.

Tax effects of temporary differences and tax loss carry-forwards

 

     Deferred
tax assets
     Deferred
tax liabilities
     Net balance  

2013

        

Intangible assets and property, plant and equipment

     300         3,143      

Current assets

     1,958         164      

Post-employment benefits

     2,008         1,033      

Provisions

     997         293      

Other

     2,416         171      

Loss carry-forwards

     3,578         —        
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets/liabilities

     11,257         4,804         6,453   

Netting of assets/liabilities

     –2,154         –2,154      
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax balances, net

     9,103         2,650         6,453   

2012

        

Intangible assets and property, plant and equipment

     941         4,579      

Current assets

     2,388         293      

Post-employment benefits

     2,600         614      

Provisions

     1,512         48      

Other

     3,487         432      

Loss carry-forwards

     4,239         —        
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets/liabilities

     15,167         5,966         9,201   

Netting of assets/liabilities

     –2,846         –2,846      
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax balances, net

     12,321         3,120         9,201   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

63


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Changes in deferred taxes, net

 

     2013      2012  

Opening balance, net

     9,201         10,770   

Recognized in Net income

     –913         1,697   

Recognized in Other comprehensive income

     –1,056         –422   

Acquisitions/disposals of subsidiaries

     –663         –2,309   

Currency translation differences

     –116         –535   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance, net

     6,453         9,201   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Tax effects reported directly in Other comprehensive income amount to SEK –1,056 (–422) million, of which actuarial gains and losses related to pensions constituted SEK –1,231 (–57) million, cash flow hedges SEK 179 (–363) million and deferred tax on gains/losses on hedges on investments in foreign entities SEK –4 (–2) million.

Deferred tax assets are only recognized in countries where the Company expects to be able to generate corresponding taxable income in the future to benefit from tax reductions.

Significant tax loss carry-forwards are related to countries with long or indefinite periods of utilization, mainly Sweden and Germany. Of the total SEK 3,578 (4,239) million recognized deferred tax assets related to tax loss carry-forwards, SEK 2,177 (2,840) million relates to Sweden with indefinite periods of utilization. Due to the Company’s strong current financial position and taxable income during 2013, the Company has been able to utilize part of its tax loss carry-forwards during the year. The assessment is that the Company will be able to generate sufficient income in the coming years to also utilize the remaining part of the recognized amounts.

Tax loss carry-forwards

Deferred tax assets regarding tax loss carry-forwards are reported to the extent that realization of the related tax benefit through future taxable profits is probable also when considering the period during which these can be utilized, as described below.

As of December 31, 2013, the recognized tax loss carry-forwards amounted to SEK 14,093 (17,081) million. The tax value of these tax loss carry-forwards is reported as an asset.

The final years in which the recognized loss carry-forwards can be utilized are shown in the following table.

Tax loss carry-forwards: year of expiration

 

Year of expiration

   Tax loss
carry-forwards
     Tax
value
 

2014

     62         23   

2015

     —           —     

2016

     10         3   

2017

     5         1   

2018

     131         27   

2019 or later

     13,885         3,524   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     14,093         3,578   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

In addition to the table above there are loss carry-forwards of SEK 3,518 (4,737) million at a tax value of SEK 1,019 (1,432) million that have not been recognized due to judgments of the possibility they will be used against future taxable profits in the respective jurisdictions. The majority of these loss carry-forwards have an expiration date in excess of five years.

C9    EARNINGS PER SHARE

Earnings per share 2011–2013

 

     2013      2012      2011  

Basic

        

Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company (SEK million)

     12,005         5,775         12,194   

Average number of shares outstanding, basic (millions)

     3,226         3,216         3,206   

Earnings per share, basic (SEK)

     3.72         1.80         3.80   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Diluted

        

Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company (SEK million)

     12,005         5,775         12,194   

Average number of shares outstanding, basic (millions)

     3,226         3,216         3,206   

Dilutive effect for stock purchase plans

     31         31         27   

Average number of shares outstanding, diluted (millions)

     3,257         3,247         3,233   

Earnings per share, diluted (SEK)

     3.69         1.78         3.77   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

64


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C10     INTANGIBLE ASSETS

Intangible assets 2013

 

    Capitalized development expenses     Goodwill         Intellectual property rights (IPR),    
trademarks and other
intangible assets
 
    To be
marketed
    For internal use     Total     Total     Trademarks,
customer
relationships
and similar
rights
    Patents
and
acquired
R&D
    Total  
      Acquired
costs
    Internal
costs
           

Cost

               

Opening balance

    9,766        2,213        1,478        13,457        30,422        18,595        27,416        46,011   

Acquisitions/capitalization

    915        —          —          915        —          587        60        647   

Balances regarding acquired/divested businesses1)

    —          —          —          —          1,646        200        1,351        1,551   

Sales/disposals

    —          —          —          —          –302        –113        —          –113   

Reclassification

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Translation difference

    —          —          —          —          –204        20        –50        –30   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

    10,681        2,213        1,478        14,372        31,562        19,289        28,777        48,066   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated amortization

               

Opening balance

    –4,027        –2,106        –1,405        –7,538        —          –7,277        –18,201        –25,478   

Amortization

    –1,322        –51        –34        –1,407        —          –2,322        –2,199        –4,521   

Sales/disposals

    —          —          —          —          —          92        —          92   

Translation difference

    —          —          —          —          —          –36        23        –13   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

    –5,349        –2,157        –1,439        –8,945        —          –9,543        –20,377        –29,920   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated impairment losses

               

Opening balance

    –1,987        –55        –37        –2,079        –18        —          –5,331        –5,331   

Impairment losses

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

    –1,987        –55        –37        –2,079        –18        —          –5,331        –5,331   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net carrying value

    3,345        1        2        3,348        31,544        9,746        3,069        12,815   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) For more information on acquired/divested businesses, see Note C26, “Business combinations”.

Intangible assets 2012

 

    Capitalized development expenses     Goodwill         Intellectual property rights (IPR),    
trademarks and other intangible
assets
 
    To be
marketed
    For internal use     Total     Total     Trademarks,
customer
relationships
and similar
rights
    Patents
and
acquired
R&D
    Total  
      Acquired
costs
    Internal
costs
           

Cost

               

Opening balance

    8,125        2,213        1,478        11,816        27,455        14,188        25,689        39,877   

Acquisitions/capitalization

    1,641        —          —          1,641        —          538        103        641   

Balances regarding acquired businesses1)

    —          —          —          —          4,293        4,517        2,155        6,672   

Sales/disposals

    —          —          —          —          –20        –158        –137        –295   

Reclassification

    —          —          —          —          94        —          –94        –94   

Translation difference

    —          —          —          —          –1,400        –490        –300        –790   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

    9,766        2,213        1,478        13,457        30,422        18,595        27,416        46,011   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated amortization

               

Opening balance

    –3,187        –1,975        –1,318        –6,480        1        –5,502        –16,078        –21,580   

Amortization

    –840        –131        –87        –1,058        —          –2,023        –2,413        –4,436   

Sales/disposals

    —          —          —          —          –1        46        124        170   

Translation difference

    —          —          —          —          —          202        166        368   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

    –4,027        –2,106        –1,405        –7,538        —          –7,277        –18,201        –25,478   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated impairment losses

               

Opening balance

    –1,721        –55        –37        –1,813        –18        —          –5,214        –5,214   

Impairment losses

    –266        —          —          –266        —          —          –117        –117   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

    –1,987        –55        –37        –2,079        –18        —          –5,331        –5,331   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net carrying value

    3,752        52        36        3,840        30,404        11,318        3,884        15,202   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) For more information on acquired businesses, see Note C26, “Business combinations.”

 

65


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Goodwill is allocated to the operating segments Networks, at the sum of SEK 16.7 (16.2) billion, Global Services, at the sum of SEK 4.5 (4.2) billion and Support Solutions, at the sum of SEK 10.3 (10.0) billion.

The recoverable amounts for cash-generating units are established as the present value of expected future cash flows. Estimation of future cash flows includes assumptions mainly for the following key financial parameters:

 

   

Sales growth

 

   

Development of operating income (based on operating margin or cost of goods sold and operating expenses relative to sales)

 

   

Development of working capital and capital expenditure requirements.

The assumptions regarding industry-specific market drivers and market growth are approved by Group management and each operating segment’s management. These assumptions are based on industry sources as input to the projections made within the Company for the development 2013–2018 for key industry parameters:

 

   

The number of global mobile subscriptions is estimated to grow from around 6.8 billion by the end of 2013 to around 9 billion by the end of 2018. Of these, around 7 billion will be mobile broadband subscriptions. Around 850 million of these mobile broadband subscriptions will use mobile PC/tablets/mobile routers, but the vast majority will still use mobile phones to access the internet.

 

   

Fixed broadband subscriptions are estimated to grow from around 650 million by the end of 2013 to around 800 million in 2018. Fixed broadband includes Fiber, Cable and xDSL.

 

   

Mobile data traffic volume is estimated to increase by around seven times in the period 2013–2018, while fixed internet traffic is estimated to increase around four times over the same timeframe, but from a much larger base.

The growth in network equipment is mainly driven by a shift in investments from voice to data. The end user requirements for “app-coverage” drives deployment of heterogeneous networks and small cells.

The demand for support solutions is driven by the opportunities for new types of service offerings enabled by IP technology and high-speed broadband. There is strong IPTV subscriber growth, plus rapid growth in digital viewing and on-demand services. As a consequence, service providers and network owners need solutions to make networks efficient for video delivery.

The development and build out of mobile broadband networks and increasing number of mobile broadband subscriptions drives growth in service introduction and traffic. This puts high demand on plan to provision, implementation and systems integration services as well as real time payment systems. The Business Support Systems’ growth is driven by the introduction of new services, new business models and price plans.

The demand for professional services is also driven by an increasing business and technology complexity. Therefore, operators review their business models and look for vendor partners that can take on a broader responsibility, including the outsourcing of network operations.

The assumptions are also based upon information gathered in the Company’s long-term strategy process, including assessments of new technology, the Company’s competitive position and new types of business and customers, driven by the continued integration of telecom, data and media industries.

The impairment testing is based on specific estimates for the first five years and with a reduction of nominal annual growth rate to an average GDP growth of 3% (3%) per year thereafter. The impairment tests for goodwill did not result in any impairment.

An after-tax discount rate of 9,5% (8%) has been applied for all cash-generating units for the discounting of projected after-tax cash flows. In addition, when a higher discount rate has been applied in the impairment tests it has not resulted in any impairment. The assumptions for 2012 are disclosed in Note C10, “Intangible assets” in the Annual Report of 2012.

The Company’s discounting is based on after-tax future cash flows and after-tax discount rates. This discounting is not materially different from a discounting based on before-tax future cash flows and before-tax discount rates, as required by IFRS.

In Note C1, “Significant accounting policies,” and Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments,” further disclosures are given regarding goodwill impairment testing.

 

66


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C11    PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT

Property, plant and equipment 2013

 

      Real
estate
     Machinery and
other  technical
assets
     Other equipment,
tools and
installations
     Construction in
progress and
advance payments
     Total  

Cost

              

Opening balance

     4,985         4,746         23,033         1,451         34,215   

Additions

     975         175         2,113         1,240         4,503   

Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses

     –29         –564         315         –19         –297   

Sales/disposals

     –185         –341         –1,677         –598         –2,801   

Reclassifications

     404         165         627         –1,196         —     

Translation difference

     –30         51         –351         –13         –343   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     6,120         4,232         24,060         865         35,277   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Accumulated depreciation

              

Opening balance

     –2,355         –3,489         –16,623         —           –22,467   

Depreciation

     –479         –558         –3,190         —           –4,227   

Balances regarding divested businesses

     —           450         147         —           597   

Sales/disposals

     399         386         1,493         —           2,278   

Reclassifications

     –75         80         –5         —           —     

Translation difference

     18         –51         233         —           200   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –2,492         –3,182         –17,945         —           –23,619   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Accumulated impairment losses

              

Opening balance

     –45         –124         –86         —           –255   

Impairment losses

     —           –7         —           —           –7   

Reversals of impairment losses

     —           2         23         —           25   

Sales/disposals

     4         6         —           —           10   

Reclassifications

     —           1         –1         —           —     

Translation difference

     1         –1         2         —           2   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –40         –123         –62         —           –225   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     3,588         927         6,053         865         11,433   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Contractual commitments for the acquisition of property, plant and equipment as of December 31, 2013, amounted to SEK 203 (184) million.

Property, plant and equipment 2012

 

    Real estate     Machinery and
other technical
assets
    Other equipment,
tools and
installations
    Construction in
progress and

advance payments
    Total  

Cost

         

Opening balance

    4,641        5,235        20,663        1,302        31,841   

Additions

    640        370        2,521        1,898        5,429   

Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses

    2        46        432        —          480   

Sales/disposals

    –476        –373        –1,296        –242        –2,387   

Reclassifications

    381        –380        1,458        –1,459        —     

Translation difference

    –203        –152        –745        –48        –1,148   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

    4,985        4,746        23,033        1,451        34,215   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated depreciation

         

Opening balance

    –2,165        –3,485        –15,094        —          –20,744   

Depreciation

    –354        –428        –3,270        —          –4,052   

Balances regarding divested businesses

    —          —          3        —          3   

Sales/disposals

    68        347        1,228        —          1,643   

Reclassifications

    7        –13        6        —          —     

Translation difference

    89        90        504        —          683   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

    –2,355        –3,489        –16,623        —          –22,467   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated impairment losses

         

Opening balance

    –43        –148        –118        —          –309   

Impairment losses

    –4        –8        —          —          –12   

Reversals of impairment losses

    —          22        30        —          52   

Sales/disposals

    —          6        —          —          6   

Translation difference

    2        4        2        —          8   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Closing balance

    –45        –124        –86        —          –255   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net carrying value

    2,585        1,133        6,324        1,451        11,493   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

67


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C12    FINANCIAL ASSETS, NON-CURRENT

Equity in joint ventures and associated companies

 

     Joint ventures     Associated companies     Total      Total  
     2013      2012         2013             2012         2013      2012  

Opening balance

     —           4,663        2,842        1,302        2,842         5,965   

Share in earnings

     —           –8,399 1)      –130        3        –130         –8,396   

Contributions to joint ventures and associated companies

     —           5,029        –2        —          –2         5,029   

Taxes

     —           106        0        –11        0         95   

OCI

     —           –46        –14        42        –14         –4   

Dividends

     —           —          –128        –133        –128         –133   

Divestments

     —           –1,353        —          —          —           –1,353   

Reclassification

     —           —          —          1,639 3)      —           1,639   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     —           —          2,568 2)      2,842 2)      2,568         2,842   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Includes a write-down of ST-Ericsson investment and the Company’s share in ST-Ericsson’s operating loss.
2) Goodwill, net, amounts to SEK 10.6 (12.2) million.
3) Reclassification from Other investments in shares and participation.

All companies apply IFRS in the reporting to the Company as issued by IASB.

Ericsson’s share of assets, liabilities and income in joint venture ST-Ericsson

 

     2013     2012     2011  

Percentage in ownership interest

     50     50     50

Non-current assets

     6        2,194        13,710   

Current assets

     1,435        2,012        3,028   

Non-current liabilities

     104        740        794   

Current liabilities

     1,204        2,678        9,390   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets (100%)

     133        788        6,554   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Company’s share of net assets (50%)

     67        394        3,277   

Net sales

     3,127        9,090        10,692   

Income after financial items

     –726        –5,006        –5,460   

Income taxes

     –64        –800        312   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income and total comprehensive income (100%)

     –790        –5,806        –5,148   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Company’s share of net income and other comprehensive income (50%)

     –395 1)      –2,903        –2,574   

Assets pledged as collateral

     —          —          3   

Contingent liabilities

     —          —          —     

 

1) Reported losses has not been recognized in the result for the Company, due to IFRS principles disclosed in Note C1, “Significant accounting policies.”

The table above consists of amounts considered by the Company when applying the equity method in relation to ST-Ericsson.

The joint venture ST-Ericsson, equally owned by the Company and STMicroelectronics, is winding down and all business has been transferred to parents or divested during 2013. Since December 2012, there are no remaining investments related to ST-Ericsson recognized in the Company’s balance sheet. The result in ST-Ericsson has therefore not been recognized due to losses in 2013 and previous periods, as per IFRS principles disclosed in C1 “Significant accounting policies.” For more information, see Note C3, “Segment information.”

Ericsson’s share of assets, liabilities and income in associated company Rockstar Consortium

 

     2013     2012  

Percentage in ownership interest

     21.26     21.26

Total assets

     6,429        7,342   

Total liabilities

     53        28   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets (100%)

     6,376        7,314   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Company’s share of net assets (21.26%)

     1,356        1,555   

Net sales

     —          —     

Income after financial items

     –897        –376   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income and total comprehensive income (100%)

     –897        –376   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Company’s share of net income and other comprehensive income (21,26%)

     –191        –80   

Rockstar is a patent licensing business based in North America that owns and manages a portfolio of more than 4,000 patents developed by technology pioneer Nortel Networks. This portfolio consists of patents covering a wide range of consumer and enterprise communications technologies currently in use or in development in markets worldwide.

Ericsson’s share of assets, liabilities and income in joint venture Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications AB

 

     2013      2012      2011  

Percentage in ownership interest

     —           —           50

Non-current assets

     —           —           10,080   

Current assets

     —           —           17,490   

Non-current liabilities

     —           —           570   

Current liabilities

     —           —           24,344   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net assets (100%)

     —           —           2,656   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Company’s share of net assets (50%)

     —           —           1,328   

Net sales

     —           —           46,992   

Income after financial items

     —           —           –2,190   

Income taxes

     —           —           170   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income and total comprehensive income (100%)

     —           —           –2,020   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Company’s share of net income and other comprehensive income (50%)

     —           —           –1,010   

Assets pledged as collateral

     —           —           1   

Contingent liabilities

     —           —           37   

 

68


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Other financial assets, non-current

 

     Other investments
in shares and
participations
    Customer finance,
non-current
     Derivatives,
non-current
     Other
financial assets,

non-current4)
 
     2013      2012     2013      2012      2013      2012      2013      2012  

Cost

                      

Opening balance

     1,758         3,576        1,538         1,661         825         816         4,414         4,633   

Additions

     85         45        3,070         5,249         —           —           1,215         313   

Disposals/repayments/deductions

     –20         –63        –3,070         –5,331         –30         —           –130         –136   

Change in value in funded pension plans 1)

     —           —          —           —           —           —           951         776   

Reclassifications

     —           –1,639 2)      —           —           —           —           —           –1,018 3) 

Revaluation

     71         —          —           —           –182         9         —           —     

Translation difference

     11         –161        –54         –41         —           —           –63         –154   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     1,905         1,758        1,484         1,538         613         825         6,387         4,414   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Accumulated impairment losses/allowances

                      

Opening balance

     –1,372         –1,377        –248         –261         —           —           –1,275         –1,332   

Impairment losses/allowance

     —           –51        9         –26         —           —           —           –14   

Disposals/repayments/deductions

     –14         —          47         35         —           —           –12         —     

Reclassifications

     —           —          —           —           —           —           —           26 3) 

Translation difference

     –14         56        2         4         —           —           –29         45   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     –1,400         –1,372        –190         –248         —           —           –1,316         –1,275   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     505         386        1,294         1,290         613         825         5,071         3,139   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) This amount includes asset ceiling. For further information, see Note C17, “Post-employment benefits.”
2) Reclassification to Equity in associated companies.
3) Reclassification to Short-term investments.
4) Includes pension plans with net surplus of SEK 3,473 (2,215) million, see Note C17, “Post-employment benefits”.

C13    INVENTORIES

Inventories

 

     2013      2012  

Raw materials, components, consumables and manufacturing work in progress

     5,747         7,351   

Finished products and goods for resale

     7,743         10,981   

Contract work in progress

     9,269         10,470   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Inventories, net

     22,759         28,802   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Contract work in progress includes amounts related to delivery-type contracts and service contracts with ongoing work in progress.

Reported amounts are net of obsolescence allowances of SEK 2,496 (3,473) million.

Movements in obsolescence allowances

 

     2013      2012      2011  

Opening balance

     3,473         3,343         3,090   

Additions, net

     308         1,403         918   

Utilization

     –1,308         –1,140         –683   

Translation difference

     12         –133         18   

Balances regarding acquired/divested businesses

     11         —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     2,496         3,473         3,343   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The amount of inventories recognized as expense and included in Cost of sales was SEK 56,781 (56,842) million.

 

69


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C14    TRADE RECEIVABLES AND CUSTOMER FINANCE

Trade receivables and customer finance

 

     2013      2012  

Trade receivables excluding associated companies and joint ventures

     71,850         64,015   

Allowances for impairment

     –880         –655   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trade receivables, net

     70,970         63,360   

Trade receivables related to associated companies and joint ventures

     43         300   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trade receivables, total

     71,013         63,660   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Customer finance credits

     3,693         5,731   

Allowances for impairment

     –305         –422   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Customer finance credits, net

     3,388         5,309   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Of which current

     2,094         4,019   

Credit commitments for customer finance

     6,402         5,933   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Days sales outstanding (DSO) were 97 (86) in December 2013.

Movements in allowances for impairment

 

     Trade receivables      Customer finance  
     2013      2012      2013      2012  

Opening balance

     655         567         422         426   

Additions

     417         229         38         101   

Utilized

     –127         –116         –13         –9   

Reversal of excess amounts

     –72         –30         –136         –112   

Reclassification

     42         21         —           —     

Translation difference

     –35         –16         –6         16   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     880         655         305         422   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Aging analysis as of December 31

 

    Total     Of which
neither impaired
nor past due
    Of which
impaired,
not past due
    Of which past
due in
the following time
intervals:
    Of which past due and
impaired in the following
time intervals:
 
          less than
90 days
    90 days
or more
        less than    
90 days
        90 days or    
more
 

2013

             

Trade receivables, excluding associated companies and joint ventures

    71,850        66,414        25        3,134        1,400        23        854   

Allowances for impairment

    –880        —          –11        —          —          –19        –850   

Customer finance credits

    3,693        2,851        98        60        459        149        76   

Allowances for impairment

    –305        —          –82        —          —          –139        –84   

2012

             

Trade receivables, excluding associated companies and joint ventures

    64,015        57,526        25        2,459        1,431        779        1,795   

Allowances for impairment

    –655        —          –15        —          —          –70        –570   

Customer finance credits

    5,731        4,549        845        21        15        70        231   

Allowances for impairment

    –422        —          –146        —          —          –45        –231   

Credit risk

Credit risk is divided into three categories: credit risk in trade receivables, customer finance risk and financial credit risk: see Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments.”

Credit risk in trade receivables

Credit risk in trade receivables is governed by a policy applicable to all legal entities in the Company. The purpose of the policy is to:

 

   

Avoid credit losses through establishing internal standard credit approval routines in all the Company’s legal entities

 

   

Ensure monitoring and risk mitigation of defaulting accounts, i.e. events of non-payment and/or delayed payments from customers

 

   

Ensure efficient credit management within the Company and thereby improve Days sales outstanding and Cash flow

 

   

Ensure payment terms are commercially justifiable

 

   

Define escalation path and approval process for payment terms and customer credit limits.

The credit worthiness of all customers is regularly assessed and a credit limit is set. Through credit management system functionality, credit checks are performed every time a sales order or an invoice is generated in the source system. These are based on the credit risk set on the customer. Credit blocks appear if the credit limit set on customer is exceeded or if past due receivables are higher than permitted levels. Release of a credit block requires authorization.

Letters of credits are used as a method for securing payments from customers operating in emerging markets, in particular in markets with unstable political and/or economic environments. By having banks confirming the letters of credit, the political and commercial credit risk exposures to the Company are mitigated.

 

70


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Trade receivables amounted to SEK 71,850 (64,015) million as of December 31, 2013. Provisions for expected losses are regularly assessed and amounted to SEK 880 (655) million as of December 31, 2013. The Company’s nominal credit losses have, however, historically been low. The amounts of trade receivables closely follow the distribution of the Company’s sales and do not include any major concentrations of credit risk by customer or by geography. The five largest customers represented 25% (27%) of the total trade receivables in 2013.

Customer finance credit risk

All major commitments to finance customers are made only after approval by the Finance Committee of the Board of Directors, according to the established credit approval process.

Prior to the approval of new facilities reported as customer finance, an internal credit risk assessment is conducted in order to assess the credit rating of each transaction (for political and commercial risk). The credit risk analysis is made by using an assessment tool, where the political risk rating is identical to the rating used by all Export credit agencies within the OECD. The commercial risk is assessed by analyzing a large number of parameters, which may affect the level of the future commercial credit risk exposure. The output from the assessment tool for the credit rating also includes an internal pricing of the risk. This is expressed as a risk margin per annum over funding cost. The reference pricing for political and commercial risk, on which the tool is based, is reviewed using information from Export credit agencies and prevailing pricing in the bank loan market for structured financed deals. The objective is that the internally set risk margin shall reflect the assessed risk and that the pricing is as close as possible to the current market pricing. A reassessment of the credit rating for each customer finance facility is made on a regular basis.

Risk provisions related to customer finance risk exposures are only made upon events which occur after the financing arrangement has become effective and which are expected to have a significant adverse impact on the borrower’s ability and/or willingness to service the outstanding debt. These events can be political (normally outside the control of the borrower) or commercial, e.g. a borrower’s deteriorated creditworthiness.

As of December 31, 2013, the Company’s total outstanding exposure related to customer finance was SEK 3,693, (5,731) million. As of December 31, 2013, the Company also had unutilized customer finance commitments of SEK 6,402 (5,933) million. Customer finance is arranged for infrastructure projects in different geographic markets and for a large number of customers. As of December 31, 2013, there were a total of 73 (78) customer finance arrangements originated by or guaranteed by the Company. The five largest facilities represented 52% (57%) of the total credit exposure in 2013.

Total outstanding customer finance exposure per region as of December 31

 

Percent

   2013      2012  

North America

     10         26   

Latin America

     3         4   

Northern Europe & Central Asia

     9         8   

Western & Central Europe

     1         1   

Mediterranean

     11         9   

Middle East

     22         17   

Sub-Saharan Africa

     26         19   

India

     5         9   

North East Asia

     9         7   

South East Asia and Oceania

     4         —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     100         100   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The effect of risk provisions and reversals for customer finance affecting the income statement amounted to a net negative impact of SEK 55 million in 2013 compared to a negative impact of SEK 33 million in 2012. Credit losses amounted to SEK 13 (16) million in 2013.

Security arrangements for customer finance facilities normally include pledges of equipment, pledges of certain assets belonging to the borrower and pledges of shares in the operating company. If available, third-party risk coverage is, as a rule, arranged. “Third-party risk coverage” means that a financial payment guarantee covering the credit risk has been issued by a bank, an export credit agency or other financial institution. A credit risk transfer under a sub-participation arrangement with a bank can also be arranged. In this case the entire credit risk and the funding is taken care of by the bank for the part that they cover. A credit risk cover from a third party may also be issued by an insurance company. During 2013, the Company did not take possession of any collateral it holds as security or call on any other credit enhancement.

Information about guarantees related to customer finance is included in Note C24, “Contingent liabilities,” and information about leasing is included in Note C27, “Leasing.”

The table below summarizes the Company’s outstanding customer finance as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

Outstanding customer finance

 

     2013      2012  

Total customer finance

     3,693         5,731   

Accrued interest

     155         96   

Less third-party risk coverage

     –222         –187   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ericsson’s risk exposure

     3,626         5,640   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Transfers of financial assets

Transfers where the Company has not derecognized the assets in their entirety

As of December 31, 2013, there existed certain customer financing assets that the Company had transferred to third parties where the Company did not derecognize the assets in their entirety. The total carrying amount of the original assets transferred was SEK 899 (471) million; the amount of the assets that the Company continues to recognize was SEK 210 (28) million; and the carrying amount of the associated liabilities was SEK 0 (0) million.

Transfers where the Company has continuing involvement

During 2012, the Company derecognized financial assets where it had continuing involvement. A repurchase of these assets would amount to SEK 0 (225) million. No assets or liabilities were recognized in relation to the continuing involvement.

 

71


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C15    OTHER CURRENT RECEIVABLES

Other current receivables

 

      2013      2012  

Prepaid expenses

     2,766         2,623   

Accrued revenues

     2,846         2,305   

Advance payments to suppliers

     877         1,060   

Derivatives with a positive value1)

     1,532         3,068   

Taxes

     7,950         7,727   

Other

     1,970         3,282   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     17,941         20,065   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) See also Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments”.

C16    EQUITY AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

Capital stock 2013

Capital stock at December 31, 2013, consisted of the following:

Capital stock

 

Parent Company

   Number of shares      Capital stock
(SEK  million)
 

Class A shares

     261,755,983         1,309   

Class B shares

     3,043,295,752         15,217   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     3,305,051,735         16,526   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The capital stock of the Parent Company is divided into two classes: Class A shares (quota value SEK 5.00) and Class B shares (quota value SEK 5.00). Both classes have the same rights of participation in the net assets and earnings. Class A shares, however, are entitled to one vote per share while Class B shares are entitled to one tenth of one vote per share.

At December 31, 2013, the total number of treasury shares was 73,968,178 (84,798,095 in 2012 and 62,846,503 in 2011) Class B shares. Ericsson did not repurchase shares in 2013 in relation to the Stock Purchase Plan.

Reconciliation of number of shares

 

      Number of shares      Capital stock
(SEK  million)
 

Number of shares Jan 1, 2013

     3,305,051,735         16,526   

Number of shares Dec 31, 2013

     3,305,051,735         16,526   

For further information about the number of shares, see the chapter Share Information.

Dividend proposal

The Board of Directors will propose to the Annual General Meeting 2014 a dividend of SEK 3.00 per share (SEK 2.75 in 2013 and SEK 2.50 in 2012).

Additional paid in capital

This relates to payments made by owners and includes share premiums paid.

Retained earnings

Retained earnings, including net income for the year, comprise the earned profits of the Parent Company and its share of net income in subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated companies. Retained earnings also include:

Remeasurements related to post-employment benefits

Actuarial gains and losses resulting from experience-based events and changes in actuarial assumptions, fluctuations in the effect of the asset ceiling, and adjustments related to the Swedish special payroll taxes.

Revaluation of other investments in shares and participations

The fair value reserve comprises the cumulative net change in the fair value of available-for-sale financial assets.

Cash flow hedges

The cash flow hedge reserve comprises the effective portion of the cumulative net change in the fair value of cash-flow-hedging instruments related to hedged transactions that have not yet occurred.

Cumulative translation adjustments

The cumulative translation adjustments comprise all foreign currency differences arising from the translation of the financial statements of foreign operations and changes regarding revaluation of excess value in local currency as well as from the translation of liabilities that hedge the Company’s net investment in foreign subsidiaries.

 

72


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C17    POST-EMPLOYMENT BENEFITS

Ericsson sponsors a number of post-employment benefit plans throughout the Company, which are in line with market practice in each country. The year 2013 was characterized by the overall increase in discount rates and a positive development of plan assets. Consequently, the Company experienced a decrease in the net pension liability. During the year, the Swedish payroll tax was reclassified from Other liabilities to Pension liability, which contributed to an increased pension liability.

The comparison amounts for 2012 and 2011 have not been recalculated.

Swedish plans

Sweden has both defined benefit and defined contribution plans based on collective agreement between the parties in the Swedish labor market:

 

   

A defined benefit plan, known as ITP 2 (occupational pension for salaried employees in manufacturing industries and trade), complemented by a defined contribution plan, known as ITPK (supplementary retirement benefits). This is a final salary-based plan.

 

   

A defined contribution plan, known as ITP 1, for employees born in 1979 or later.

 

   

A defined contribution plan ITP 1 or alternative ITP, for employees earning more than 10 income base amount and who have opted out of the defined benefit plan ITP 2, where rules are set by the Company and approved by each employee selected to participate.

The Company has by far most of its Swedish pension liabilities under defined benefit plans which are funded to 73% (72%) through Ericsson Pensionsstiftelse (a Swedish Pension Foundation). The Pensionsstiftelse covers the liability up to the value of the defined benefit obligation based on Swedish GAAP calculations. There are no funding requirements for the Swedish plans. The disability- and survivors’ pension part of the ITP-plan is secured through an insurance solution with the company Alecta, see section about Multi-employer plans.

The benefit payments are done from the Company since the liability is growing and the necessary surplus therefore is not yet reached. For the unfunded plans the Company meets the payment obligation when it falls due. The responsibility for governance of the plans and the plan assets lies with the Company and the Pensionsstiftelse. The Swedish Pensionsstiftelse is managed on the basis of a capital preservation strategy and the risk profile is set accordingly. Traditional asset-liability matching (ALM) studies are undertaken on a regular basis to allocate within different asset classes.

The plans are exposed to different risks, i.e. a sudden decrease in the bond yields, which would lead to an increase in the plan liability. A sudden instability in the financial market might also lead to a decrease in fair value of plan assets held by the Pensionsstiftelse, as the holdings of plan assets partly are exposed to equity markets; however, this may be partly offset by higher values in fixed income holdings. Swedish plans are linked to inflation and higher inflation will lead to a higher liability. For the time being, inflation is a low risk factor to the Swedish plans as actual rate of inflation has not reached the ceiling target set by the Central Bank of Sweden.

Multi-employer plans

As before, the Company has secured the disability and survivors’ pension part of the ITP Plan through an insurance solution with the insurance company Alecta. Although this part of the plan is classified as a multi-employer defined benefit plan, it is not possible to get sufficient information to apply defined benefit accounting, as for most of the accrued pension benefits in Alecta, information is missing on the allocation of earnings process between employers. Full vesting is instead registered on the last employer. Alecta is not able to calculate a breakdown of assets and provisions for each respective employer, and therefore, the disability and survivors’ pension portion of the ITP Plan has been accounted for as a defined contribution plan.

Alecta has a collective funding ratio which acts as a buffer for its insurance commitments to protect against fluctuations in investment return and insurance risks. Alecta’s target ratio is 140% and reflects the fair value of Alecta’s plan assets as a percentage of plan commitments, then measured in accordance with Alecta’s actuarial assumptions, which are different from those in IAS 19R. Alecta’s collective funding ratio was 148% (129%) as of December 31, 2013. The Company’s share of Alecta’s saving premiums is 0.6%; the total share of active members in Alecta are 2.3%. The expected contribution to the plan is SEK 163 million for 2014.

Contingent liabilities / Assets pledged as collateral

Contingent liabilities include the Company’s mutual responsibility as a credit insured company of PRI Pensionsgaranti in Sweden. This mutual responsibility can only be imposed in the instance that PRI Pensionsgaranti has consumed all of its assets, and it amounts to a maximum of 2% of the Company’s pension liability in Sweden. During 2013 the Company has pledged a business mortgage of SEK 2 billion to PRI Pensionsgaranti.

US plans

The Company operates defined benefit pension plans in the US, which are a combination of final salary pension plans and contribution-based arrangements. The final salary pension plans provide benefits to members in the form of a guaranteed level of pension payable for life. The level of benefits provided depends on members’ length of service and their salary in the final years leading up to retirement. Retirees generally do not receive inflationary increases once in payment.

The other type of plan is a contribution-based pension plan, which provides a benefit determined using a “cash balance” approach. The balance is credited monthly with interest credits and contribution credits, based on a combination of current year salary and length of service.

The majority of benefit payments are from trustee-administered funds; however, there are also a number of unfunded plans where the Company meets the benefit payment obligation as it falls due. In the US, the Company’s policy is at least to meet or exceed the funding requirements of federal regulations. The funded level in the US Pension Plan is above the point at which minimum funding would be required for fiscal year 2013.

Plan assets held in trusts are governed by local regulations and practice, as is the nature of the relationship between the Company and the trustees (or equivalent) and their composition. Responsibility for governance of the plans – including investment decisions and contribution schedules – lies with the Plan Administrative Committee (PAC). The PAC is composed of representatives from the Company. The Company’s plans are exposed to various risks associated with pension plans, i.e. a sudden decrease in bond yields would lead to an increase in the present value of the defined benefit obligation. A sudden instability in the financial markets might also lead to a decrease in the fair value of plan assets held by the trust. Pension benefits in the US are not linked to inflation; however, higher inflation poses the risk of increased final salaries being used to determine benefits for active employees. There is also a risk that the duration of payments to retirees will exceed the life expectancy in mortality tables.

Other plans

The Company also sponsors plans in other countries. The main plans are in Brazil, Ireland and the United Kingdom. The plan in Brazil is a

 

73


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

pension plan wholly funded with a net surplus of assets. The plans in Ireland and the UK are final salary pension plans and are partly or wholly funded. The plans are managed by corporate trustees with directors appointed partly by the local company and partly by the plan members. The trustees are independent from the local company and subject to the specific country’s pension laws.

Amount recognized in the Consolidated balance sheet

Amount recognized in the Consolidated balance sheet

 

     Sweden      US      Other      Total  

2013

           

Defined benefit obligation (DBO)

     23,088         14,387         15,444         52,919   

Fair value of plan assets

     16,818         16,174         13,575         46,567   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deficit/surplus (+/–)

     6,270         –1,787         1,869         6,352   

Plans with net surplus, excluding asset ceiling1)

     —           2,307         1,166         3,473   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provision for post-employment benefits2)

     6,270         520         3,035         9,825   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2012

           

Defined benefit obligation (DBO)

     21,432         16,472         14,054         51,958   

Fair value of plan assets

     15,375         16,263         13,004         44,642   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deficit/surplus (+/–)

     6,057         209         1,050         7,316   

Unrecognized past service cost

     —           —           –28         –28   

Plans with net surplus, excluding asset ceiling1)

     —           738         1,477         2,215   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provision for post-employment benefits2)

     6,057         947         2,499         9,503   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Plans with a net surplus, i.e. where plan assets exceed DBO, are reported as Other financial assets, non-current: see Note C12, “Financial assets.” The asset ceiling increased during the year by SEK 308 million from SEK 217 million in 2012 to SEK 525 million in 2013.
2) Plans with net liabilities are reported in the balance sheet as Post-employment benefits, non-current.

Total pension cost recognized in the Consolidated income statement

The costs for post-employment benefits within the Company are distributed between defined contribution plans and defined benefit plans, with a trend toward defined contribution plans.

Pension costs for defined contribution plans and defined benefit plans

 

         Sweden              US              Other              Total      

2013

           

Pension cost for defined contribution plans

     1,088         502         778         2,368   

Pension cost for defined benefit plans

     1,581         85         392         2,058   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,669         587         1,170         4,426   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total pension cost expressed as a percentage of wages and salaries

              9.1
           

 

 

 

2012

           

Pension cost for defined contribution plans

     977         404         701         2,082   

Pension cost for defined benefit plans

     936         –454         198         680   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,913         –50         899         2,762   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total pension cost expressed as a percentage of wages and salaries

              5.7
           

 

 

 

2011

           

Pension cost for defined contribution plans

     2,039         360         643         3,042   

Pension cost for defined benefit plans

     621         42         184         847   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,660         402         827         3,889   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total pension cost expressed as a percentage of wages and salaries

              8.9
           

 

 

 

 

74


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Change in the net defined benefit obligation

Change in the net defined benefit obligation

 

     Present
value of
obligation
20133)
     Fair value
of plan
assets
2013
     Total
2013
     Present
value of
obligation
2012
     Fair value
of plan
assets
2012
     Total
2012
 

Opening balance

     51,958         –44,642         7,316         36,375         –28,019         8,356   

Reclassification1)

     1,799         —           1,799         —           —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Included in the income statement:

                 

Current service cost

     1,351         —           1,351         1,280         —           1,280   

Past service cost and gains and losses on settlements

     363         —           363         –353         —           –353   

Interest cost/income (+/–)

     2,046         –1,846         200         2,120         –2,357         –237   

Taxes and administrative expenses

     129         16         145         —           —           —     

Other

     –4         3         –1         –72         42         –30   
     3,885         –1,827         2,058         2,975         –2,315         660   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Remeasurements:

                 

Return on plan assets excluding amounts in interest expense/income

     —           –550         –550         —           –1,634         –1,634   

Actuarial gains/losses (–/+) arising from changes in demographic assumptions

     46         —           46         —           —           —     

Actuarial gains/losses (–/+) arising from changes in financial assumptions

     –3,629         —           –3,629         2,104         —           2,104   

Experience-based gains/losses (–/+)

     611         —           611         363         —           363   
     –2,972         –550         –3,522         2,467         –1,634         833   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Translation difference

     –115         190         75         –1,353         1,361         8   

Contributions and payments from employer:

                 

Employers2)

     –554         –971         –1,525         —           –1,751         –1,751   

Plan participants

     55         –44         11         22         –22         0   

Payments from plans:

                 

Benefit payments

     –1,181         1,181         0         –1,478         1,311         –167   

Settlements

     –116         96         –20         372         –156         216   

Business combinations and divestments4)

     160         —           160         12,578         –13,417         –839   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     52,919         –46,567         6,352         51,958         –44,642         7,316   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) The provision for the Swedish special payroll taxes which was previously included in Other current liabilities, has been re-classified as a pension liability in line with the implementation of the revised IAS 19R on January 1, 2013.
2) The expected contribution to the plan is SEK 550 million during 2014.
3) The weighted average duration of DBO is 17.9 years.
4) Business combinations in 2013 are related to the acquisition of Modems. In 2012 business combinations are related to the acquisition of Telcordia.

Present value of the defined benefit obligation

 

     Sweden      US      Other      Total  

2013

           

DBO, closing balance

     23,088         14,387         15,444         52,919   

Of which partially or fully funded

     22,598         13,867         13,396         49,861   

Of which unfunded

     490         520         2,048         3,058   

2012

           

DBO, closing balance

     21,432         16,472         14,054         51,958   

Of which partially or fully funded

     20,916         15,895         12,064         48,875   

Of which unfunded

     516         577         1,990         3,083   

Asset allocation by geography

 

     Sweden      US      Other      Total      Of which
unquoted
 

2013

              

Cash and cash equivalents

     592         218         261         1,071         35

Equity securities

     2,112         2,081         4,459         8,652         31

Debt securities

     3,601         6,934         6,982         17,517         61

Real estate

     1,649         —           76         1,725         100

Investment funds

     8,864         6,512         414         15,790         60

Assets held by insurance company

     —           —           633         633         100

Other

     —           429         750         1,179         65
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total

     16,818         16,174         13,575         46,567      
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Of which real estate occupied by the Company

     —           —           —           —        

Of which securities issued by the Company

     25         —           —           25      

 

75


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Asset allocation by geography

 

     Sweden      US      Other      Total      Of which
unquoted
 

2012

              

Cash and cash equivalents

     2,159         683         197         3,039         25

Equity securities

     1,371         5,107         2,865         9,343         15

Debt securities

     4,139         10,040         7,929         22,108         60

Real estate

     574         433         110         1,117         100

Investment funds

     7,132         —           849         7,981         55

Assets held by insurance company

     —           —           305         305         100

Other

     —           —           749         749         100
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total

     15,375         16,263         13,004         44,642      
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Of which real estate occupied by the Company

     —           —           —           —        

Of which securities issued by the Company

     25         —           —           25      

Actuarial assumptions

Financial and demographic actuarial assumptions

     Group1)  

2013

  

Financial assumptions

  

Discount rate

     4.5

Demographic assumptions

  

Life expectancy after age 65 in years, weighted average

     22   

2012

  

Financial assumptions

  

Discount rate

     4.1

Demographic assumptions

  

Life expectancy after age 65 in years, weighted average

     22   

 

1) Weighted average for disclosure purposes only. Country-specific assumptions were used for each actuarial calculation.

Actuarial assumptions are assessed on a quarterly basis.

See also Notes C1 and C2.

Sweden

The defined benefit obligation has been calculated using a discount rate based on yields of covered bonds, which is higher than a discount rate based on yields of government bonds. The Swedish covered bonds are considered high-quality bonds, mainly AAA-rated, as they are secured with assets, and the market for covered bonds is considered deep and liquid, thereby meeting the revised IAS 19 requirements.

US

The defined benefit obligation has been calculated using a discount rate based on yields of high-quality corporate bonds, where “high-quality” has been defined as a rating of AA and above.

Actuarial gains and losses reported directly in Other comprehensive income

 

     2013      2012  

Cumulative gain/loss (–/+) at beginning of year

     8,696         7,911   

Recognized gain/loss (–/+) during the year

     –3,522         833   

Translation difference

     45         –48   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cumulative gain/loss (–/+) at end of year

     5,219         8,696   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total remeasurements in Other comprehensive income related to post-employment benefits

 

     2013      2012  

Actuarial gains and losses (+/–)

     3,128         –833   

The effect of asset ceiling

     –308         266   

Swedish special payroll taxes1)

     394         116   

Total

     3,214         –451   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Actuarial gains and losses for joint ventures and associated companies

     —           50   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Swedish payroll taxes are included in recognized gain/loss during the year in OCI.

Sensitivity analysis of significant actuarial assumptions

 

     Group  

Impact on DBO, SEK billion

  

2013

  

Discount rate +0.5%

     –5   

Discount rate –0.5%

     +5   

 

76


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C18    PROVISIONS

Provisions

 

     Warranty      Restructuring      Other      Total  

2013

           

Opening balance

     1,595         1,218         5,825         8,638   

Additions

     924         2,439         1,336         4,699   

Reversal of excess amounts

     –588         –237         –736         –1,561   

Negative effect on Income Statement

              3,138   

Cash out/utilization

     –948         –2,089         –2,984         –6,021   

Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses

     –2         0         –10         –12   

Reclassification

     1         –3         –184         –186   

Translation differences

     –73         17         –139         –195   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     909         1,345         3,108         5,362   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2012

           

Opening balance

     1,888         1,327         3,050         6,265   

Additions

     1,088         1,234         4,689         7,011   

Reversal of excess amounts

     –157         –150         –766         –1,073   

Negative effect on Income Statement

              5,938   

Cash out/utilization

     –1,188         –1,170         –1,117         –3,475   

Balances regarding divested/acquired businesses

     48         —           92         140   

Reclassification

     1         11         –34         –22   

Translation differences

     –85         –34         –89         –208   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Closing balance

     1,595         1,218         5,825         8,638   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provisions will fluctuate over time depending on business mix, market mix and technology shifts. Risk assessment in the ongoing business is performed monthly to identify the need for new additions and reversals. Management uses its best judgment to estimate provisions based on this assessment. In certain circumstances, provisions are no longer required due to outcomes being more favorable than anticipated, which affect the provisions balance as a reversal. In other cases the outcome can be negative, and if so, a charge is recorded in the income statement.

For 2013, new or additional provisions amounting to SEK 4.7 billion were made, and SEK 1.6 billion of provisions was reversed. The actual cash outlays for 2013 were SEK 6.0 billion compared with the estimated SEK 7 billion. The main part of the total cash out for 2013 was made up of other provisions of SEK 3.0 billion and restructuring provisions of SEK 2.1 billion. The expected total cash outlays in 2014 are approximately SEK 4.2 billion.

Of the total provisions, SEK 222 (211) million is classified as non-current. For more information, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies” and Note C2, “Critical accounting estimates and judgments.”

Warranty provisions

Warranty provisions are based on historic quality rates for established products as well as estimates regarding quality rates for new products and costs to remedy the various types of faults predicted. Provisions amounting to SEK 0.9 billion were made and due to more favorable outcomes in certain cases reversals of SEK 0.6 billion were made. The actual cash outlays for 2013 were SEK 0.9 billion, in line with the expected SEK 1 billion. The cash outlays of warranty provisions during year 2014 are estimated to total approximately SEK 0.7 billion.

Restructuring provisions

In 2013 SEK 2.4 billion in provisions were made and SEK 0.2 billion were reversed due to a more favorable outcome than expected. The cash outlays were SEK 2.1 billion for the full year. Due to the fact that the major part of the cash outlays was related to additional provisions during 2013, it deviated from the estimated SEK 1 billion. The cash outlays for 2014 are estimated to total approximately SEK 1.1 billion.

Other provisions

Other provisions include provisions for probable contractual penalties, tax issues, litigations, supplier claims, and other. During 2013, new provisions amounting to SEK 1.3 billion were made and SEK 0.7 billion were reversed due to a more favorable outcome. The cash outlays were SEK 3.0 billion in 2013 compared to the estimate of SEK 5.4 billion. The majority of this stemmed from the utilization of the 2012 ST-Ericsson provision. For 2014, the cash outlays are estimated to total approximately SEK 2.4 billion.

 

77


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C19    INTEREST-BEARING LIABILITIES

As of December 31, 2013, the Company’s outstanding interest-bearing liabilities stood at SEK 29.5 (28.7) billion.

Interest-bearing liabilities

 

     2013      2012  

Borrowings, current

     

Current part of non-current borrowings1)

     6,037         3,018   

Other current borrowings

     1,351         1,751   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current borrowings

     7,388         4,769   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Borrowings, non-current

     

Notes and bond loans

     14,522         16,519   

Other borrowings, non-current

     7,545         7,379   

Total non-current interest-bearing liabilities

     22,067         23,898   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing liabilities

     29,455         28,667   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Including notes and bond loans of SEK 1,966 (2,671) million.

All outstanding notes and bond loans are issued by the Parent Company under its Euro Medium-Term Note (EMTN) program or under its SEC-registered program. Bonds issued at a fixed interest rate are normally swapped to a floating interest rate using interest rate swaps leaving a maximum of 50% of outstanding loans at fixed interest rates. This arrangement resulted in a weighted average interest rate of 4.44% (4.69%). These bonds are revalued based on changes in benchmark interest rates according to the fair value hedge methodology stipulated in IAS 39.

In June 2013, the Company repaid the EUR 313 million bond.

In June the Company signed a new USD 2 billion multi-currency revolving credit facility and refinanced its credit facility signed in 2007. The new facility has a tenor of five years, with two extension options of one year each, and the facility serves for general corporate purposes.

In November 2013, the Company made a full drawdown of USD 684 million under the European Investment Bank (EIB) loan facility signed in October 2012. The loan supports the company’s R&D activities to further develop the next generation radio and IP technology that supports mobile broadband build-out globally. The loan will mature in November 2020.

In January 2014, the Company repaid the SEK 4 billion EIB loan with original maturity July 2015.

Notes, bonds and bilateral loans

 

Issued–maturing

   Nominal
amount
     Coupon     Currency      Book value
(SEK m.)
    Maturity date     Unrealized hedge
gain/loss (included in
book value)
 

Notes and bond loans

              

2007-2014

     220         0.594     EUR         1,966        June 27, 2014 1)   

2007-2017

     500         5.375     EUR         5,056 2)      June 27, 2017        –616   

2009-20163)

     300           USD         1,939        June 23, 2016     

2010-20204)

     170           USD         1,112        December 23, 2020     

2012-2022

     1,000         4.125     USD         6,415        May 15, 2022     
          

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total notes and bond loans

             16,488          –616   
          

 

 

     

 

 

 

Bilateral loans

              

2008-20155)

     4,000           SEK         4,000        July 15, 2015     

2012-20196)

     98           USD         632        September 30, 2019     

2012-20216)

     98           USD         634        September 30, 2021     

2013-20207)

     684           USD         4,420        November 6, 2020     
          

 

 

     

Total bilateral loans

             9,686       
          

 

 

     

 

1) Next contractual repricing date March 27, 2014 (quarterly).
2) Interest rate swaps are designated as fair value hedges.
3) Private Placement, Swedish Export Credits Guarantee Board (EKN) / Swedish Export Credit Corporation (SEK).
4) Private Placement, Swedish Export Credit Corporation (SEK).
5) European Investment Bank (EIB), R&D project financing. Full prepayment January 15, 2014.
6) Nordic Investment Bank (NIB), R&D project financing.
7) European Investment Bank (EIB), R&D project financing.

 

78


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C20    FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT AND FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

The Company’s financial risk management is governed by a policy approved by the Board of Directors. The Finance Committee of the Board of Directors is responsible for overseeing the capital structure and financial management of the Company and approving certain matters (such as investments, customer finance commitments, guarantees and borrowing) and continuously monitors the exposure to financial risks.

The Company defines its managed capital as the total Company equity. For the Company, a robust financial position with a strong equity ratio, investment grade rating, low leverage and ample liquidity is deemed important. This provides financial flexibility and independence to operate and manage variations in working capital needs as well as to capitalize on business opportunities.

The Company’s overall capital structure should support the financial targets: to grow faster than the market, deliver best-in-class margins and generate a healthy cash flow. The capital structure is managed by balancing equity, debt financing and liquidity in such a way that the Company can secure funding of operations at a reasonable cost of capital. Regular borrowings are complemented with committed credit facilities to give additional flexibility to manage unforeseen funding needs. The Company strives to finance growth, normal capital expenditures and dividends to shareholders by generating sufficient positive cash flows from operating activities.

The Company’s capital objectives are:

 

   

To maintain an equity ratio above 40%

 

   

A cash conversion rate above 70%

 

   

To maintain a positive net cash position

 

   

To maintain a solid investment grade rating by Moody’s and Standard & Poor’s.

Capital objectives-related information, SEK billion

 

     2013     2012  

Capital

     142        138   

Equity ratio

     53     50

Cash conversion

     79     116

Positive net cash

     37.8        38.5   

The Company has a treasury function with the principal role to ensure that appropriate financing is in place through loans and committed credit facilities, actively managing the Company’s liquidity as well as financial assets and liabilities, and managing and controling financial risk exposures in a manner consistent with underlying business risks and financial policies. Hedging activities, cash management and insurance management are largely centralized to the treasury function in Stockholm.

The Company also has a customer finance function with the main objective to find suitable third-party financing solutions for customers and to minimize recourse to the Company. To the extent that customer loans are not provided directly by banks, the Parent Company provides or guarantees vendor credits. The customer finance function monitors the exposure from outstanding vendor credits and credit commitments. The Company classifies financial risks as:

 

   

Foreign exchange risk

 

   

Interest rate risk

 

   

Credit risk

 

   

Liquidity and refinancing risk

 

   

Market price risk in own and other equity instruments.

The Board of Directors has established risk limits for defined exposures to foreign exchange and interest rate risks as well as to political risks in certain countries.

For further information about accounting policies, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies”.

Foreign exchange risk

The Company is a global company with sales mainly outside Sweden. Sales and incurred costs are to a large extent denominated in currencies other than SEK and therefore the financial results of the Company are impacted by currency fluctuations.

The Company reports the financial statements in SEK. Movements in exchange rates between currencies that affect these statements are impacting the comparability between periods.

Line items, primarily sales, are impacted by translation exposure incurred when converting foreign entities’ financial statements into SEK. Line items and profitability, such as operating income, are impacted by transaction exposure incurred when financial assets and liabilities, primarily trade receivables and trade payables, are initially recognized and subsequently remeasured due to change in foreign exchange rates.

In the table below we present the net exposure for the four largest currencies impact on sales and also net transaction exposure of these currencies on profitability.

Currency exposure, SEK billion

 

Exposure currency

   Sales
translation
exposure
     Sales
transaction
exposure
     Sales net
exposure
     Incurred
cost
transaction
exposure1)
     Net
transaction
exposure
 

USD

     58.2         37.8         96.0         –15.4         22.4   

EUR

     30.4         11.3         41.7         –6.9         4.4   

JPY

     11.8         0.0         11.8         5.7         5.7   

CNY

     11.8         –0.2         11.6         –7.2         –7.4   

 

1) Transactions in foreign currency - internal sales, internal purchases, external purchases.

Translation exposure

Translation exposure relates to sales and cost incurred in foreign entities when converted into SEK upon consolidation. These exposures cannot be addressed by hedging, but as the income statement is translated using average rate (average rate gives a good approximation), the impact of volatility in foreign currency rates is reduced.

Transaction exposure

Transaction exposure relates to sales and cost incurred in non-reporting currencies in individual group companies. Foreign exchange risk is as far as possible concentrated in Swedish group companies, primarily Ericsson AB. Sales to foreign subsidiaries are normally denominated in the functional currency of the customers, and so tend to be denominated in USD or another foreign currency. In order to limit the exposure toward exchange rate fluctuations on future revenues and costs, committed and forecasted future sales and purchases in major currencies are hedged with 7% of 12-month forecast monthly. This corresponds to approximately 5–6 months of an average forecast.

As disclosed under note C1 Significant Accounting Policies, the Company has as of January 1, 2013, discontinued hedge accounting for new derivatives hedging forecasted sales and costs incurred as from this date. This means that outstanding derivatives contracts, with transaction date January 1, 2013 or later that are hedging future sales and costs incurred are revalued against “Other operating income and expense”. The sensitivity in “Other operating income and expense” in relation to this revaluation is dependent on changes in foreign exchange rates, forecasts, seasonality and hedging policy. USD is our largest exposure and at year-end a 5% change in FX-rates would

 

79


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

impact profit and loss with approximately SEK 0.6 billion. Revaluation results of derivatives contracts, with transaction date January 1, 2013 or later amounted to SEK 0.5 billion in 2013. When hedge accounting was applied revaluation was recognized in OCI until the underlying transaction occurred and then a recycling was made to the related items of the income statements, as disclosed in Note C1.

According to Company policy, transaction exposure in subsidiaries’ balance sheets (i.e. trade receivables and payables and customer finance receivables) should be fully hedged, except for non-tradable currencies.

Foreign exchange exposures in balance sheet items are hedged through offsetting balances or derivatives.

Translation exposure in net assets

The Company has many subsidiaries operating outside Sweden with functional currencies other than SEK. The results and net assets of such companies are exposed to exchange rate fluctuations, which affect the consolidated income statement and balance sheet when translated to SEK. Translation risk related to forecasted results from foreign operations cannot be hedged, but net assets can be addressed by hedging.

Translation exposure in foreign subsidiaries is hedged according to the following policy established by the Board of Directors:

Translation risk related to net assets in foreign subsidiaries is hedged up to 20% in selected companies. The translation differences reported in Other comprehensive income during 2013 were negative, SEK –1.7 (–3.9) billion, including hedging gain/loss of SEK 0.0 (0.0) billion.

Interest rate risk

The Company is exposed to interest rate risk through market value fluctuations in certain balance sheet items and through changes in interest revenues and expenses. The net cash position was SEK 37.8 (38.5) billion at the end of 2013, consisting of cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments of SEK 77.1 (76.7) billion and interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits of SEK 39.3 (38.2) billion.

The Company manages the interest rate risk by i) matching fixed and floating interest rates in interest-bearing balance sheet items and ii) avoiding significant fixed interest rate exposure in the Company’s net cash position. The policy is that interest-bearing assets shall have an average interest duration of between 10 and 14 months, taking derivative instruments into consideration. Interest-bearing liabilities do not have a firm target for the duration, nor a firm target for fixed/ floating interest rate, as duration and interest mix are decided based on market conditions when the liabilities are issued. Group Treasury has a mandate to deviate from the asset management benchmark given by the Board and take foreign exchange positions up to an aggregated VaR of SEK 45 million given a confidence level of 99% and a 1-day horizon.

Interest duration, SEK billion

 

     < 3M      3-12M      1-3Y      3-5Y      >5Y      Total  

Interest-bearing trading

     –8.7         10.9         0.5         –2.4         –0.3         0.0   

Interest-bearing assets

     65.1         –0.3         7.8         2.1         2.4         77.1   

Interest-bearing liabilities

     –10.5         –6.8         0.0         –4.4         –7.8         –29.5   

When managing the interest rate exposure, the Company uses derivative instruments, such as interest rate swaps. Derivative instruments used for converting fixed rate debt into floating rate debt are designated as fair value hedges.

Fair value hedges

The purpose of fair value hedges is to hedge the variability in the fair value of fixed-rate debt (issued bonds) from changes in the relevant benchmark yield curve for its entire term by converting fixed interest payments to a floating rate (e.g. STIBOR or LIBOR) by using interest rate swaps (IRS). The credit risk/spread is not hedged.

The fixed leg of the IRS is matched against the cash flows of the hedged bond. Hereby the fixed-rate bond/debt is converted into a floating-rate debt in accordance with the policy.

Outstanding derivatives 1)

 

     2013      2012  

Fair value

   Asset     Liability      Asset     Liability  

Currency derivatives

         

Maturity within 3 months

     512        158         976        60   

Maturity between 3 and 12 months

     293        9         611        10   

Maturity between 1 and 3 years

     8        0         4        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     813        167         1,591        70   

Of which designated in cashflow hedge relations

     —          —           816        6   

Of which designated in net investment hedge relations

     —          —           —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest rate derivatives

         

Maturity within 3 months

     —          —           —          —     

Maturity between 3 and 12 months

     186        269         487        285   

Maturity between 1 and 3 years

     382        688         565        681   

Maturity between 3 and 5 years

     663        163         1,212        739   

Maturity of more than 5 years

     101        36         38        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     1,332 2)      1,156         2,302 2)      1,705   

Of which designated in fair value hedge relations

     724        —           969        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Some of the derivatives hedging non-current liabilities are recognized in the balance sheet as non-current derivatives due to hedge accounting.
2) Of which SEK 613 (825) million is reported as non-current assets.

Sensitivity analysis

The Company uses the VaR methodology to measure foreign exchange and interest rate risks in portfolios managed by the Treasury. This statistical method expresses the maximum potential loss that can arise with a certain degree of probability during a certain period of time. For the VaR measurement, the Company has chosen a probability level of 99% and a 1-day time horizon. The daily VaR measurement uses market volatilities and correlations based on historical daily data (one year).

The average VaR calculated for 2013 was SEK 16.3 (9.8) million for the combined mandates. No VaR-limits were exceeded during 2013.

Financial credit risk

Financial instruments carry an element of risk in that counterparts may be unable to fulfill their payment obligations. This exposure arises in the investments in cash, cash equivalents, short-term investments and from derivative positions with positive unrealized results against banks and other counterparties.

The Company mitigates these risks by investing cash primarily in well-rated securities such as treasury bills, government bonds, commercial papers, and mortgage-covered bonds with short-term ratings of at least A-2/P-2 or equivalents, and long-term ratings of AAA. Separate credit limits are assigned to each counterpart in order to minimize risk concentration. All derivative transactions are covered by ISDA netting agreements to reduce the credit risk. No credit losses were incurred during 2013, SEK 0.0 (0.0) billion, neither on external investments nor on derivative positions.

 

80


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

At December 31, 2013, the credit risk in financial cash instruments was equal to the instruments’ carrying value. Credit exposure in derivative instruments was SEK 2.1 (3.9) billion.

Liquidity risk

The Company minimizes the liquidity risk by maintaining a sufficient net cash position, centralized cash management, investments in highly liquid interest-bearing securities, and by having sufficient committed credit lines in place to meet potential funding needs. For information about contractual obligations, please see Note C31, “Contractual obligations.” The current cash position is deemed to satisfy all short-term liquidity requirements as well as non-current borrowings.

Cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments

 

     Remaining time to maturity  

SEK billion

   < 3
months
     3-12
months
     1–5
years
     >5
years
     Total  

Banks

     37.6         0.3         —           —           37.9   

Type of issuer/counterpart

              

Governments

     0.5         4.1         14.6         3.7         22.9   

Corporates

     4.4         —           —           —           4.4   

Mortgage institutes

     —           —           11.9         —           11.9   

2013

     42.5         4.4         26.5         3.7         77.1   

2012

     47.1         4.8         24.0         0.8         76.7   

The instruments are either classified as held for trading or as assets available-for-sale with maturity less than one year and are therefore short-term investments. Cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments are mainly held in SEK unless offset by EUR-funding.

Refinancing risk

Refinancing risk is the risk that the Company is unable to refinance outstanding debt under reasonable terms and conditions, or at all, at a given point in time.

Repayment schedule of non-current borrowings1)

 

Nominal amount (SEK billion)

   Current
maturities
of long-
term debt
     Notes and
bonds
(non-current)
     Liabilities
to financial
institutions

(non-current)
     Total  

2014

     6.0         —           —           6.0   

2015

     —           —           0.8         0.8   

2016

     —           2.0         0.0         2.0   

2017

     —           4.4         0.0         4.4   

2018

     —           —           —           —     

2019

     —           —           0.6         0.6   

2020

     —           1.1         4.4         5.5   

2021

     —           —           0.6         0.6   

2022

     —           6.4         —           6.4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     6.0         13.9         6.4         26.3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Excluding finance leases reported in Note C27, “Leasing.”

Debt financing is mainly carried out through borrowing in the Swedish and international debt capital markets.

Bank financing is used for certain subsidiary funding and to obtain committed credit facilities.

Funding programs1)

 

     Amount      Utilized     Unutilized  

Euro Medium-Term Note program (USD million)

     5,000         1,462        3,538   

SEC Registered program (USD million)

     —           1,000 2)      —     

Long-term Committed Credit facility (USD million)

     2,000         —          2,000   

Indian Commercial Paper program (INR million)

     5,000         —          5,000   

 

1) There are no financial covenants related to these programs.
2) Program amount indeterminate.

Fair valuation of the Company’s financial instruments

The Company’s financial instruments generally meet the requirements of level 1 valuation due to the fact that they are based on quoted prices in active markets for identical assets.

Exceptions to this relates to:

 

   

OTC derivatives with an amount of gross SEK 5.2 billion in relation to assets and gross SEK 4.4 billion in relation to liabilities were valued based on references to other market data as currency or interest rates. These valuations fall under level 2 valuation as defined by IFRS.

 

   

Ownership in other companies where the Company neither has control nor significant influence. The amount recognized in these cases was SEK 0.5 (0.4) billion. These assets, classified as level 3 assets for valuation purposes, have been valued based on value in use technique.

Financial instruments carried at other than fair value

The fair value of the Company’s financial instruments, recognized at fair value, is determined based on quoted market prices or rates. In the following tables, carrying amounts and fair values of financial instruments that are carried in the financial statements at sums other than fair values are presented. Assets valued at fair value through profit or loss showed a net gain of SEK 1.2 billion. For further information about valuation principles, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies.”

Financial instruments carried at other than fair value1)

 

     Book value      Fair value  

SEK billion

   2013      2012      2013      2012  

Current part of non-current borrowings

     6.0         3.0         6.0         3.0   

Notes and bond loans

     14.5         16.5         14.7         17.0   

Other borrowings non-current

     7.5         7.4         7.6         7.6   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     28.0         26.9         28.3         27.6   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Excluding finance leases reported in Note C27, “Leasing.”

Financial instruments excluded from the tables, such as trade receivables and payables, are carried at amortized cost which is deemed to be equal to fair value. When a market price is not readily available and there is insignificant interest rate exposure affecting the value, the carrying value is considered to represent a reasonable estimate of fair value.

Market price risk in own shares and other listed equity investments

Risk related to our own share price

The Company is exposed to fluctuations in its own share price through stock purchase plans for employees and synthetic share-based compensations to the Board of Directors.

 

81


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Stock purchase plans for employees

The obligation to deliver shares under the stock purchase plan is covered by holding Ericsson Class B shares as treasury stock. A change in the share price will result in a change in social security charges, which represents a risk to the income statement. The cash flow exposure is fully hedged through the holding of Ericsson Class B shares as treasury stock to be sold to generate funds, which also cover social security payments.

Synthetic share-based compensations to the Board of Directors

In the case of these plans, the Company is exposed to risks in relation to own share price, both with regards to compensation expenses and social security charges. The obligation to pay compensation amounts under the synthetic share-based compensations to the Board of Directors is covered by a liability in the balance sheet.

For further information about the stock purchase plan and synthetic share-based compensations to the Board of Directors, see note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees.”

Offsetting financial assets and liabilities

As required by IFRS, the Company has off set financial instruments under ISDA agreements. The related assets amounted to SEK 5.2 billion, prior to offsetting of SEK 3.1 billion, with a net amount of SEK 2.1 billion recognized in the balance sheet. The related liabilities amounted to SEK 4.4 billion, prior to offsetting of SEK 3.1 billion, with a net amount of SEK 1.3 billion recognized in the balance sheet.

Financial instruments, book value

 

SEK billion

   Customer
finance
     Trade
receivables
     Short-
term
invest-
ments
     Cash
equiva-
lents
     Borrowings      Trade
payables
     Other
financial
assets
     Other
current
receiv-
ables
     Other
current
liabilities
     2013      2012  

Note

     C14         C14               C19         C22         C12         C15         C21         

Assets at fair value through profit or loss

     —           —           35.0         11.1         —           —           0.6         1.5         –1.3         46.9         46.3   

Loans and receivables

     3.4         71.0         —           2.4         —           —           5.1         —           —           81.9         74.3   

Financial liabilities at amortized cost

     —           —           —           —           –29.5         –20.5         —           —           —           –50.0         –51.8   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     3.4         71.0         35.0         13.5         –29.5         –20.5         5.7         1.5         –1.3         78.8         68.8   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

C21    OTHER CURRENT LIABILITIES

Other current liabilities

 

     2013      2012  

Income tax liabilities

     2,805         3,878   

Advances from customers

     5,471         4,754   

Liabilities to associated companies and joint ventures

     —           —     

Accrued interest

     208         259   

Accrued expenses, of which

     32,810         32,353   

Employee-related

     11,532         11,166   

Supplier-related

     11,478         11,440   

Other1)

     9,800         9,747   

Deferred revenues

     9,887         11,658   

Derivatives with a negative value2)

     1,323         1,775   

Other3)

     5,810         6,431   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     58,314         61,108   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Major balance relates to accrued expenses for customer projects.
2) See Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments.”
3) Includes items such as VAT and withholding tax payables and other payroll deductions, and liabilities for goods received where the related invoice has not yet been received.

C22    TRADE PAYABLES

Trade payables

 

         2013              2012      

Payables to associated companies and joint ventures

     333         81   

Other

     20,169         23,019   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     20,502         23,100   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

C23    ASSETS PLEDGED AS COLLATERAL

Assets pledged as collateral

 

         2013              2012      

Chattel mortgages1)

     2,177         185   

Bank deposits

     379         335   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,556         520   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) See also Note C17, “Post-Employment benefits”.

 

82


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C24    CONTINGENT LIABILITIES

Contingent liabilities

 

         2013              2012      

Contingent liabilities

     657         613   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     657         613   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Contingent liabilities assumed by Ericsson include guarantees of loans to other companies of SEK 23 (24) million. Ericsson has SEK 37 (59) million issued to guarantee the performance of a third party.

All ongoing legal and tax proceedings have been evaluated, their potential economic outflows and probability estimated and necessary provisions made. In Note C2, “Critical Accounting Estimates and Judgments,” further disclosure is presented in relation to (i) key sources of estimation uncertainty and (ii) the decision made in relation to accounting policies applied.

Financial guarantees for third parties amounted to SEK 116 (286) million as of December 31, 2013. The maturity date for the majority of the issued guarantees occurs in 2014 at the latest.

C25    STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS

Interest paid in 2013 was SEK 1,233 million (SEK 1,650 million in 2012 and SEK 1,422 million in 2011) and interest received in 2013 was SEK 1,266 million (SEK 1,883 million in 2012 and SEK 2,632 million in 2011). Taxes paid, including withholding tax, were SEK 6,537 million in 2013 (SEK 5,750 million in 2012 and SEK 4,393 million in 2011).

Cash and cash equivalents includes cash of SEK 28,618 (30,358) million and temporary investments of SEK 13,477 (14,324) million. For more information regarding the disposition of cash and cash equivalents and unutilized credit commitments, see Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments.”

Cash and cash equivalents as of December 31, 2013, include SEK 4.9 billion (3.8) in countries where there exist significant cross-border conversion restrictions due to hard currency shortage or strict government controls. This amount is therefore not considered available for general use by the Parent Company. These restrictions have not had, and are not expected to have, significant impact on the Company’s ability to meet its cash obligations.

Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash

 

     2013      2012      2011  

Property, plant and equipment

        

Depreciation

     4,227         4,052         3,499   

Impairment losses/reversals of impairments

     –18         –40         47   

Total

     4,209         4,012         3,546   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Intangible assets

        

Amortization

        

Capitalized development expenses

     1,407         1,058         995   

Intellectual Property Rights, brands and other intangible assets

     4,521         4,436         4,470   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total amortization

     5,928         5,494         5,465   

Impairments

        

Capitalized development expenses

     —           266         7   

Intellectual Property Rights, brands and other intangible assets

     —           117         18   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     5,928         5,877         5,490   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total depreciation, amortization and impairment losses on property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

     10,137         9,889         9,036   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Taxes

     –1,323         –1,140         1,994   

Dividends from joint ventures/associated companies1)

     128         133         177   

Undistributed earnings in joint ventures/associated companies1)

     130         11,636         3,533   

Gains/losses on sales of investments and operations, intangible assets and PP&E, net2)

     976         –8,087         –159   

Other non-cash items3)

     –220         646         –1,968   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total adjustments to reconcile net income to cash

     9,828         13,077         12,613   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) See Note C12, “Financial assets, non-current.”
2) See Note C26, “Business combinations.”
3) Refers mainly to unrealized foreign exchange, gains/losses on financial instruments.

Acquisitions/divestments of subsidiaries and other operations

 

     Acquisitions      Divestments  

2013

     

Cash flow from business combinations1)

     –3,054         448   

Acquisitions/divestments of other investments

     –93         17   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     –3,147         465   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

2012

     

Cash flow from business combinations1)

     –11,575         9,502   

Acquisitions/divestments of other investments

     46         –50   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     –11,529         9,452   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

2011

     

Cash flow from business combinations1)

     –1,232         –28   

Acquisitions/divestments of other investments

     –1,949         81   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     –3,181         53   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Also see Note C26, “Business combinations.”

 

83


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C26    BUSINESS COMBINATIONS

Acquisitions and divestments

Acquisitions

Acquisitions 2011–2013

 

     2013      2012     2011  

Total consideration, including cash

     3,176         12,564 1)      1,162   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Acquisition-related costs2)

     101         150        77   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net assets acquired

       

Cash and cash equivalents

     223         1,139        7   

Property, plant and equipment

     597         480        259   

Intangible assets

     1,551         6,672        382   

Investments in joint ventures and associated companies

     —           —          120   

Other assets

     850         2,105        140   

Provisions, including post-employment benefits

     –463         714        –23   

Other liabilities

     –1,705         –3,214        –37   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total identifiable net assets

     1,053         7,896        848   

Operating expenses

     410         —          —     

Non-controlling interest

     67         375        54   

Goodwill

     1,646         4,293        260   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     3,176         12,564        1,162   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) The cash transaction includes payment of external loan of SEK 6.2 billion and investment in subsidiary of SEK 2.5 billion.
2) Acquisition-related costs are included in Selling and administrative expenses in the consolidated income statement.

In 2013, Ericsson made acquisitions with a negative cash flow effect amounting to SEK 3,054 (11,575) million. These acquisitions consist primarily of:

 

   

Airvana: On September 5, 2013, the Company acquired 100% of the shares in Airvana Network Solutions Inc. Airvana Network Solutions is a Massachusetts-based company and supplier of EVDO software to Ericsson. EVDO software enables data transmission in a CDMA wireless network and is an important part of the CDMA ecosystem. A one-time charge related to the acquisition impacted the operating expenses negatively by SEK –0.4 billion. Balances to facilitate the Purchase price allocation are preliminary.

 

   

Devoteam: On April 30, 2013, the Company acquired Devoteam’s Telecom & Media operations in France. The transaction was structured as a stock purchase, where 100% of the shares in a company holding Devoteam’s Telecom & Media operations were acquired. Acquiring the activities of Devoteam adds unique expertise in complex, strategic and technical consulting engagements that will enable us to immediately enhance the value that we bring to our customers. Balances to facilitate the Purchase price allocation are final.

 

   

Mediaroom: On September 5, 2013, the Company acquired the TV solution Mediaroom business from Microsoft in an asset deal. Mediaroom is the leading platform for video distribution deployed with the world’s largest IPTV operators. This strategic acquisition positions Ericsson as an industry leader thanks to the skills and experiences of the talented people of Mediaroom combined with Ericsson’s end-to-end service capabilities. Balances to facilitate the Purchase price allocation are preliminary.

 

   

Modems: On August 5, 2013 Ericsson and STMicroelectronics announced the closing of the transaction for the split up of ST-Ericsson. This follows the announcement the companies made on March 18, 2013 on the chosen strategic option for the future of the joint venture. Effective August 2, 2013 Ericsson has taken on the design, development and sales of the LTE multimode thin modem solutions, including 2G, 3G and 4G interoperability. In total, approximately 1,800 employees and contractors have joined Ericsson. Balances to facilitate the Purchase price allocation are preliminary.

 

   

Telcocell: On September 2, 2013, the Company acquired assets from Telcocell, a Canadian consulting and systems integration company specializing in Business Support Systems (BSS). The acquisition complements Ericsson’s consulting and systems integration offering to telecom and cable customers in North America, Western Europe and Latin America. Balances to facilitate the Purchase price allocation are preliminary.

In order to finalize a Purchase price allocation all relevant information needs to be gathered. Examples of such information include final consideration and final opening balances. Balances may remain preliminary for up to a year due to, for example, working capital adjustments, tax items or decisions from local authorities.

Divestments

Divestments 2011–2013

 

     2013      2012      2011  

Proceeds

     655         9,502         –39   

Net assets disposed of

        

Property, plant and equipment

     297         —           1   

Investments in joint ventures and associated companies

     —           1,353         10   

Other assets

     1,326         296         38   

Other liabilities

     –127         –483         –224   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,496         1,166         –175   

Net gains/losses from divestments

     –841         8,336         158   

Less Cash and cash equivalents

     –207         —           –11   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flow effect

     448         9,502         –28   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

In 2013, the Company made divestments with a cash flow effect amounting to SEK 448 (9,502) million.

 

   

Power cables operation: On May 3, 2013, Ericsson announced an agreement with the Danish company NKT Cables to divest its power cables operation. As a result of the agreement approximately 320 employees and consultants were transferred to NKT Cables. The transaction was closed on July 1, 2013 and resulted in a loss of SEK –0.1 billion.

 

   

Applied Communication Sciences (ACS): On May 15, 2013, Ericsson completed the sale of ACS, the former research and engineering arm of Telcordia Technologies. It resulted in a loss of SEK –0.3 billion.

 

   

Ericsson’s telecom cable business in Hudiksvall: On December 1, 2013, Ericsson finalized the divestment of its telecom cable business in Hudiksvall, Sweden, to Hexatronic. The transaction resulted in a loss of SEK –0.5 billion. The divestment was made as a business transfer and the new company within the Hexatronic Group will be named Hexatronic Cables & Interconnect Systems AB. 85 former Ericsson employees were transferred to Hexatronic.

 

84


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Acquisitions 2011–2013

 

Company

  

Description

  

Transaction
date

Airvana

   A Massachusetts-based company and supplier of EVDO software to Ericsson.   

Sep, 2013

Mediaroom

   The leading platform for video distribution deployed with the world’s largest IPTV operators.   

Sep, 2013

Telcocell

   A consulting and systems integration company specializing in Business Support Systems (BSS).   

Sep, 2013

Modems

   Ericsson has taken on the design, development and sales of the LTE multimode thin modem solutions, including 2G, 3G and 4G interoperability.   

Aug, 2013

Devoteam

   A leader in Information and Communications Technology consulting with 5,000 employees in Europe, the Middle East and Africa.   

Apr, 2013

ConceptWave

   A Canadian OSS/BSS company. The purchase price was CAD 55 million.   

Sep, 2012

Technicolor

   A technology company in the media and entertainment sector. The purchase price was EUR 20 million.   

Jul, 2012

BelAir

   A telecom-grade Wi-Fi company based in Canada. The purchase price was USD 250 million.   

Apr, 2012

Ericsson-LG

   Increase of ownership from 50% plus one share, to 75%.   

Mar, 2012

Telcordia

   A US company developing software and services for OSS/BSS. The purchase price was USD 1.15 billion.   

Jan, 2012

GDNT

   An asset purchase agreement of certain assets. Enhances the Company’s existing R&D, manufacturing and services capabilities in the China region. The purchase price was RMB 357 million.   

May, 2011

Nortel Multiservice Switch business (MSS)

   An asset purchase agreement to acquire certain assets of Nortel’s MSS. The purchase price was USD 53 million.    Mar, 2011

Divestments 2011–2013

 

Company

  

Description

  

Transaction
date

Telecom cable business    Divestment of the telecom cable business in Hudiksvall, Sweden, to Hexatronic. It resulted in a loss of SEK –0.5 billion.    Dec, 2013
Power cables operation    Divestment of the power cables operation to NKT Cables. The transaction resulted in a loss of SEK –0.1 billion.    Jul, 2013

Applied Communication Sciences

   Sale of Applied Communication Sciences (ACS), the former research and engineering arm of Telcordia Technologies. This resulted in a loss of SEK –0.3 billion.    May, 2013
IPX    Sale of IPX to Gemalto, with a positive cash flow effect of SEK 260 million.    Sep, 2012
EDA 1500 GPON    Capital asset sale of EDA 1500 GPON portfolio with a positive cash flow effect of SEK 80 million.    Aug, 2012
Sony Ericsson    Sale of the Company’s share in Sony Ericsson (50%) to Sony, with a positive cash flow effect of SEK 9.1 billion.    Feb, 2012

 

85


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C27    LEASING

Leasing with the Company as lessee

Assets under finance leases, recorded as property, plant and equipment, consist of:

Finance leases

 

     2013      2012  

Cost

     

Real estate

     1,774         1,538   

Machinery

     3         3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     1,777         1,541   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Accumulated depreciation

     

Real estate

     –610         –601   

Machinery

     –3         –3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     –613         –604   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Accumulated impairment losses

     

Real estate

     –25         –35   
     –25         –35   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     1,139         902   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2013, future minimum lease payment obligations were distributed as follows:

Future minimum lease payment obligations

 

     Finance
leases
     Operating
leases
 

2014

     109         2,089   

2015

     109         1,766   

2016

     109         1,425   

2017

     108         881   

2018

     101         626   

2019 and later

     720         2,406   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,256         9,193   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Future finance charges1)

     –291         n/a   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Present value of finance lease liabilities

     965         9,193   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Average effective interest rate on lease payables is 5.25%.

Expenses in 2013 for leasing of assets were SEK 2,517 (3,172) million, of which variable expenses comprised SEK 18 (20) million. The leasing contracts vary in length from 1 to 17 years.

The Company’s lease agreements normally do not include any contingent rents. In the few cases they occur, they relate to charges for heating linked to the oil price index. Most of the leases of real estate contain terms of renewal, giving the Company the right to prolong the agreement in question for a predefined period of time. All of the finance leases of facilities contain purchase options. Only a very limited number of the Company’s lease agreements contain restrictions on stockholders’ equity or other means of finance. The major agreement contains a restriction stating that the Parent Company must maintain a stockholders’ equity of at least SEK 25 billion.

Leases with the Company as lessor

Leasing income relates to subleasing of real estate as well as equipment provided to customers under leasing arrangements. These leasing contracts vary in length from 1 to 11 years.

At December 31, 2013, future minimum payment receivables were distributed as follows:

Future minimum payment receivables

 

     Finance
leases
     Operating
leases
 

2014

     27         112   

2015

     24         90   

2016

     2         23   

2017

     2         6   

2018

     —           4   

2019 and later

     —           1   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     55         236   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unearned financial income

     n/a         n/a   

Uncollectible lease payments

     n/a         n/a   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net investments in financial leases

     n/a         n/a   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Leasing income in 2013 was SEK 165 (236) million.

 

86


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

C28    INFORMATION REGARDING MEMBERS OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS, THE GROUP MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES

Remuneration to the Board of Directors

Remuneration to members of the Board of Directors

 

SEK

  Board fees     Number
of synthetic
shares/
portion of
Board fee
    Value at
grant date of
synthetic

shares
allocated in 2013
A
    Number of
previously
allocated
synthetic
shares
outstanding
    Net change
in value

of synthetic
shares1)
B
    Committee
fees
    Total fees
paid in
cash2)
C
    Total
remuneration
2013
(A+B+C)
 

Board member

               

Leif Johansson

    3,850,000        0/0     —          —          —          400,000        4,250,000 3)      4,250,000   

Sverker Martin-Löf

    900,000        0/0     —          —          —          175,000        1,075,000 4)      1,075,000   

Jacob Wallenberg

    900,000        2,804/25     224,945        9,246        150,147        175,000        850,000        1,225,092   

Roxanne S. Austin

    900,000        2,804/25     224,945        28,492        716,010        175,000        850,000        1,790,955   

Sir Peter L. Bonfield

    900,000        0/0     —          10,660        259,051        250,000        1,150,000        1,409,051   

Nora Denzel

    900,000        0/0     —          —          —          —          900,000        900,000   

Börje Ekholm

    900,000        8,414/75     674,996        31,984        762,740        175,000        400,000        1,837,736   

Alexander Izosimov

    900,000        2,804/25     224,945        3,492        51,565        —          675,000 5)      951,510   

Ulf J. Johansson

    900,000        0/0     —          14,720        481,454        350,000        1,250,000 6)      1,731,454   

Kristin Skogen Lund

    900,000        2,804/25     224,945        —          –4,831        —          675,000        895,114   

Hans Vestberg

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

Pär Östberg

    900,000        0/0     —          —          —          250,000        1,150,000        1,150,000   

Employee Representatives

               

Pehr Claesson

    13,500        —          —          —          —          —          13,500        13,500   

Kristina Davidsson

    13,500        —          —          —          —          —          13,500        13,500   

Karin Åberg

    12,000        —          —          —          —          —          12,000        12,000   

Rickard Fredriksson

    13,500        —          —          —          —          —          13,500        13,500   

Karin Lennartsson

    13,500        —          —          —          —          —          13,500        13,500   

Roger Svensson

    13,500        —          —          —          —          —          13,500        13,500   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    12,929,500        19,630        1,574,776        98,594        2,416,136        1,950,000        13,304,500        17,295,412 7) 
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    12,929,500        19,630        1,574,776        117,312 8)      3,071,949 8)9)      1,950,000        13,304,500        17,951,225 7) 
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) The difference in value as of the time for payment, compared to December 31, 2012, for synthetic shares allocated in 2008 (for which payment was made in 2013).

The difference in value as of December 31, 2013, compared to December 31, 2012, for synthetic shares allocated in 2009, 2010, 2011 and 2012.

The difference in value as of December 31, 2013, compared to grant date for synthetic shares allocated in 2013.

The value of synthetic shares allocated in 2009, 2010, 2011 and 2012 includes respectively SEK 2.00, SEK 2.25, SEK 2.50 and SEK 2.75 per share in compensation for dividends resolved by the Annual General Meetings 2010, 2011, 2012 and 2013 and the value of the synthetic shares allocated in 2008 includes dividend compensation for dividends resolved in 2009, 2010, 2011 and 2012.

2) Committee fee and cash portion of the Board fee.
3) In addition, an amount corresponding to statutory social charges in respect of the part of the fee that has been invoiced through a company was paid, amounting to SEK 1,335,350.
4) In addition, an amount corresponding to statutory social charges in respect of the part of the fee that has been invoiced through a company was paid, amounting to SEK 109,758.
5) In addition, an amount corresponding to statutory social charges in respect of the part of the fee that has been invoiced through a company was paid, amounting to SEK 212,085.
6) In addition, an amount corresponding to statutory social charges in respect of the part of the fee that has been invoiced through a company was paid, amounting to SEK 127,625.
7) Excluding social security charges to the amount of SEK 4,746,168.
8) Including synthetic shares previously allocated to the former Directors Nancy McKinstry and Michelangelo Volpi.
9) Including synthetic shares previously allocated to the former Director Carl-Henric Svanberg, where the difference in value is the difference as of the time for payment, compared to December 31, 2012.

Comments to the table

 

   

The Chairman of the Board was entitled to a Board fee of SEK 3,850,000 and a fee of SEK 200,000 for each Board Committee on which he served as Chairman.

 

   

The other Directors elected by the Annual General Meeting were entitled to a fee of SEK 900,000 each. In addition, the Chairman of the Audit Committee was entitled to a fee of SEK 350,000 and the other non-employee members of the Audit Committee were entitled to a fee of SEK 250,000 each. The Chairmen of the Finance and Remuneration Committees were entitled to a fee of SEK 200,000 each and the other non-employee members of the Finance and the Remuneration Committees were entitled to a fee of SEK 175,000 each.

 

   

Members of the Board, who are not employees of the Company, have not received any remuneration other than the fees and synthetic shares as above. None of the Directors have entered into a service contract with the Parent Company or any of its subsidiaries, providing for termination benefits.

 

   

Members and deputy members of the Board who are Ericsson employees received no remuneration or benefits other than their entitlements as employees and a fee to the employee representatives and their deputies of SEK 1,500 per attended Board meeting.

 

   

Board members invoicing for the amount of the Board and Committee fee through a company may add to the invoice an amount corresponding to social charges. The social charges thus included in the invoiced amount are not higher than the general payroll tax that would otherwise have been paid by the Company. The entire amount, i.e. the cash portion of the Board fee and the Committee fee, including social charges, constitutes the invoiced Board fee.

 

   

The Annual General Meeting 2013 resolved that non-employee Directors may choose to receive the Board fee (i.e. exclusive of

 

87


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Committee fee) as follows: i) 25% of the Board fee in cash and 75% in the form of synthetic shares, with a value corresponding to 75% of the Board fee at the time of allocation, ii) 50% in cash and 50% in the form of synthetic shares, or iii) 75% in cash and 25% in the form of synthetic shares. Directors may also choose not to participate in the synthetic share program and receive 100% of the Board fee in cash. Committee fees are always paid in cash.

The number of synthetic shares allocated is based on a volume-weighed average of the market price of Ericsson Class B shares on the NASDAQ OMX Stockholm exchange during the five trading days immediately following the publication of Ericsson’s interim report for the first quarter 2013: SEK 80.223. The number of synthetic shares is rounded down to the nearest whole number of shares.

The synthetic shares are vested during the Directors’ term of office and the right to receive payment with regard to the allocated synthetic shares occurs after the publication of the Company’s year-end financial statement during the fifth year following the Annual General Meeting which resolved on the synthetic share program, i.e. in 2018. The amount payable shall be determined based on the volume-weighed average price for shares of Class B during the five trading days immediately following the publication of the year-end financial statement.

Synthetic shares were allocated to members of the Board for the first time in 2008 and have been allocated annually since then on equal terms and conditions. Payment based on synthetic shares, under the main rule, occurred for the first time in 2013 with respect to the synthetic shares allocated in 2008. In 2013, advance payment was also made to the former Director Carl-Henric Svanberg with respect to his synthetic shares, all in accordance with the terms and conditions for the synthetic shares. The amounts paid in 2013 under the synthetic share programs were determined based on the volume-weighed average price for shares of Class B during the five trading days immediately following the publication of the year-end financial statements for 2012: SEK 77.05 and totalled SEK 3,562,958, excluding social security charges. The payments made do not constitute a cost for the Company in 2013. The Company’s costs for the synthetic shares have been disclosed each year and the net change in value of the synthetic shares for which payment was made in 2013, is disclosed in the table “Remuneration to members of the Board of Directors” on page 87.

The value of all outstanding synthetic shares fluctuates in line with the market value of Ericsson’s Class B share and may differ from year to year compared to the original value on their respective grant dates. The change in value of the outstanding synthetic shares is established each year and affects the total recognized costs that year. As of December 31, 2013, the total outstanding number of synthetic shares under the programs is 136,942 and the total accounted debt is SEK 11,494,790 (including synthetic shares previously allocated to the former Directors Nancy McKinstry and Michelangelo Volpi). In accordance with the terms and conditions for the synthetic shares, the time for payment to the former Director Michelangelo Volpi has, on his request, been advanced, to occur after the publication of the year-end financial statements for 2013.

Remuneration to the Group management

The Company’s costs for remuneration to the Group management are the costs recognized in the Income statement during the fiscal year. These costs are disclosed under “Remuneration costs” below.

Costs recognized during a fiscal year in the Income statement are not fully paid by the Company at the end of the fiscal year. The unpaid amounts that the Company has in relation to the Group management are disclosed under “Outstanding balances.”

Remuneration costs

The total remuneration to the President and CEO and to other members of the Group management, consisting of the Executive Leadership Team (ELT), includes fixed salary, short-term and long-term variable compensation, pension and other benefits. These remuneration elements are based on the guidelines for remuneration to Group management as approved by the Annual General Meeting held in 2013: see the approved guidelines in section “Guidelines for remuneration to Group management 2013.”

Remuneration costs for the President and CEO and other members of Executive Leadership Team (ELT)

 

SEK

  The President
and CEO 2013
    The President
and CEO 2012
    Other members
of ELT 2013
    Other members
of ELT 2012
    Total 2013     Total 2012  

Salary

    13,177,080        12,573,233        90,320,536        76,973,215        103,497,616        89,546,448   

Costs for annual variable remuneration earned in 2013 to be paid in 2014

    3,256,151        3,972,247        22,880,144        21,877,700        26,136,295        25,849,947   

Long-term variable compensation provision

    8,184,603        6,439,873        9,066,127        6,472,215        17,250,731        12,912,088   

Pension costs

    6,847,596        6,491,713        22,971,876        22,865,674        29,819,473        29,357,387   

Other benefits

    68,704        123,612        5,370,876        4,431,160        5,439,579        4,554,772   

Social charges and taxes

    9,368,485        9,114,641        26,838,704        22,877,888        36,207,190        31,992,529   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    40,902,620        38,715,319        177,448,263        155,497,852        218,350,883        194,213,171   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comments to the table

 

   

During 2013 there were three Executive Vice Presidents, who have been appointed by the Board of Directors. None of them has acted as deputy to the President and CEO during the year. The Executive Vice Presidents are included in the group “Other members of ELT.”

 

   

The group “Other members of ELT” comprises the following persons: Per Borgklint, Bina Chaurasia, Ulf Ewaldsson, Jan Frykhammar, Douglas L. Gilstrap, Nina Macpherson, Magnus Mandersson, Helena Norrman, Mats H. Olsson, Rima Qureshi, Angel Ruiz, Anders Thulin (from October 1), Johan Wibergh and Jan Wäreby.

 

   

The salary stated in the table for the President and CEO and other members of the ELT includes vacation pay paid during 2013 as well as other contracted compensation expensed in 2013.

 

   

“Long-term variable compensation provision” refers to the compensation costs during 2013 for all outstanding share- based plans.

 

   

For a description of compensation cost, including accounting treatment, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies,” section Share-based compensation to employees and the Board of Directors.

 

   

For the President and CEO and other members of the ELT employed in Sweden before 2011, a supplementary plan is applied in addition to the occupational pension plan for salaried staff on the Swedish labor market (ITP) with pension payable from the age of 60 years. These pension plans are not conditional upon future employment at Ericsson.

 

88


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Outstanding balances

The Company has recognized the following liabilities relating to unpaid remunerations in the Balance sheet:

 

   

Ericsson’s commitments for defined benefit based pensions as of December 31, 2013 under IAS 19 amounted to SEK 5,232,263 for the President and CEO which includes ITP plan and temporary disability and survivor’s pension. For other members of the ELT the Company’s commitments amounted to SEK 26,593,686 of which SEK 19,250,106 refers to the ITP plan and the remaining SEK 7,343,579 to temporary disability and survivor’s pensions.

 

   

For previous Presidents and CEOs, the Company has made provisions for defined benefit pension plans in connection with their active service periods within the Company.

 

   

Deferred salary, earned in 2013 or earlier, to be paid 12 months after period end or later, amounts to SEK 17,476,898.

Maximum outstanding matching rights

 

As of December 31, 2013

Number of Class B shares

   The President
and CEO
     Other members
of the ELT
 

Stock Purchase Plans 2010, 2011, 2012 and 2013 and Executive Performance Stock Plans 2010, 2011, 2012 and 2013

     482,927         566,509   

Comments to the table

 

   

For the definition of matching rights, see the description in section “Long-term variable compensation”.

 

   

Matching result of 100% is included for the 2010 plan.

 

   

Cash conversion target for 2012 and 2013 was reached, but not reached in 2011.

 

   

During 2013, the President and CEO received 88,002 matching shares and other members of the ELT 149,646 matching shares.

Guidelines for remuneration to Group management 2013

For Group Management consisting of the Executive Leadership Team, including the President and CEO, total remuneration consists of fixed salary, short- and long-term variable compensation, pension and other benefits.

The following guidelines apply for the remuneration to the Executive Leadership Team:

 

   

Variable remuneration is through cash and stock-based programs awarded against specific business targets derived from the long-term business plan approved by the Board of Directors. Targets may include financial targets at either Group or unit level, operational targets, employee engagement targets and customer satisfaction targets.

 

   

All benefits, including pension benefits, follow the competitive practice in the home country taking total compensation into account. The retirement age is normally 60 to 65 years of age.

 

   

By way of exception, additional arrangements can be made when deemed necessary. An additional arrangement can be renewed but each such arrangement shall be limited in time and shall not exceed a period of 36 months and twice the remuneration that the individual would have received had no additional arrangement been made.

 

   

The mutual notice period may be no more than six months. Upon termination of employment by the Company, severance pay amounting to a maximum of 18 months’ fixed salary is paid. Notice of termination given by the employee due to significant structural changes, or other events that in a determining manner affect the content of work or the conditions for the position, is equated with notice of termination served by the Company.

Long-Term Variable compensation

The Stock Purchase Plan

The Stock Purchase Plan is designed to offer an incentive for all employees to participate in the Company where practicable, which is consistent with industry practice and with our ways of working. For the 2013 plan, employees are able to save up to 7.5% of their gross fixed salary (President and CEO can save up to 10% of their gross fixed salary and short-term variable remuneration) for purchase of Class B contribution shares at market price on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm or American Depositary Shares (ADSs) on NASDAQ New York (contribution shares) during a 12-month period (contribution period). If the contribution shares are retained by the employee for three years after the investment and their employment with the Ericsson Group continues during that time, the employee’s shares will be matched with a corresponding number of Class B shares or ADSs free of consideration. Employees in 100 countries participate in the plans.

The table below shows the contribution periods and participation details for ongoing plans as of December 31, 2013.

Stock purchase plans

 

Plan

   Contribution period      Number of
participants
at launch
     Take-up
rate–percent of
eligible  employees
 

Stock Purchase plan 2010

     August 2010–July 2011         22,000         27

Stock Purchase plan 2011

     August 2011–July 2012         24,000         30

Stock Purchase plan 2012

     August 2012–July 2013         27,000         28

Stock Purchase plan 2013

     August 2013–July 2014         29,000         29

Participants save each month, beginning with the August payroll, towards quarterly investments. These investments (in November, February, May and August) are matched on the third anniversary of each such investment, subject to continued employment, and hence the matching spans over two financial years and two tax years.

The Key Contributor Retention Plan

The Key Contributor Retention Plan is part of Ericsson’s talent management strategy and is designed to give recognition for performance, critical skills and potential as well as to encourage retention of key employees. Under the program, up to 10% of employees (2013 plan: up to 9,300 employees) are selected through a nomination process that identifies individuals according to performance, critical skills and potential. Participants selected obtain one extra matching share in addition to the ordinary one matching share for each contribution share purchased under the Stock Purchase Plan during a 12-month period.

 

89


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Executive Performance Stock Plans

 

     Executive Performance Stock Plan  
     20131)     2012     2011     2010  

Base year EPS2)

           1.14   

Target average annual EPS growth range3)

           5% to 15%   

Matching share vesting range4)

     0.67 to 4        0.67 to 4        0.67 to 4        0.67 to 4   
     1 to 6        1 to 6        1 to 6        1 to 6   
     1.5 to 9        1.5 to 9        1.5 to 9        1.5 to 9   

Maximum opportunity as percentage of fixed salary5)

     30     30     30     30
     45     45     45     45
     162     162     162     162

 

1) Targets for Executive Performance Stock Plans 2011 to 2013 are described in the next table.
2) For 2010 plan the sum of four quarters up to December 31, 2010.
3) EPS range determined by average EPS of the 12 quarters to the end of the performance period and corresponding growth targets.
4) Corresponding to EPS range (no Performance Share Plan matching below this range). Matching shares per contribution share invested in addition to Stock Purchase Plan matching according to program of up to 4, 6 or 9 matching shares.
5) At full investment, full vesting and constant share price. Excludes Stock Purchase Plan matching.

Executive Performance Stock Plan targets

 

    Base year
value

SEK  billion
     Year 1     Year 2     Year 3  
2013         

Growth (Net sales growth)

    227.8        
 
Compound annual
growth rate of 2–8%
  
  

Margin (Operating income growth)1)

    18.5        
 
Compound annual
growth of 5–15%
  
  

Cash Flow (Cash conversion)

    —         ³ 70   ³ 70   ³ 70
2012         

Growth (Net sales growth)

    226.9        
 
Compound annual
growth rate of 2–8%
  
  

Margin (Operating income growth)

    17.9        
 
Compound annual
growth of 5–15%
  
  

Cash Flow (Cash conversion)

    —         ³ 70   ³ 70   ³ 70

 

1) Base year 2012 excludes a non-cash charge for ST-Ericsson

Executive Performance Stock Plan targets

 

     Base year
value

SEK  billion
     Year 1     Year 2     Year 3  
2011          

Growth (Net sales growth)

     203.3        
 
Compound annual
growth rate of 4–10%
  
  

Margin (Operating income growth)2)

     23.7        
 
Compound annual
growth of 5–15%
  
  

Cash Flow (Cash conversion)

     —         ³ 70   ³ 70   ³ 70

 

2) Base year 2010 excludes restructuring charges

The Executive Performance Stock Plan

The Executive Performance Stock Plan is designed to focus management on driving earnings and provide competitive remuneration. Senior managers, including ELT, are selected to obtain up to four or six extra shares (performance matching shares) in addition to the ordinary one matching share for each contribution share purchased under the Stock Purchase Plan. Up to 0.5% of employees (2013 plan: up to 400 executives) are offered participation in the plan. The President and CEO can save up to 10% of gross fixed salary and short-term variable compensation, and may obtain up to nine performance-matching shares in addition to the Stock Purchase Plan matching share for each contribution share.

The performance matching for the 2010 plan is subject to the fulfillment of a performance target of average annual Earnings per Share (EPS) growth. The performance targets changed from EPS targets to targets linked to the business strategy as from 2011.

The tables above show all Executive Performance Stock Plans as of December 31, 2013.

Shares for all plans

 

            Stock Purchase Plan, Key Contributor
Retention Plan and Executive
Performance Stock Plans
       

Plan (million shares)

          2013     2012     2011     2010     2009     Total  

Originally designated

     A         26.6        26.2        19.4        19.4        22.4        114.0   

Outstanding beginning of 2013

     B         0.0        4.4        13.5        9.2        6.0        33.1   

Awarded during 2013

     C         3.2        9.0        0.0        0.0        0.0        12.2   

Exercised/matched during 2013

     D         0.0        0.4        0.5        2.8        5.9        9.6   

Forfeited/expired during 2013

     E         0.0        0.5        0.6        0.4        0.1        1.6   

Outstanding end of 20131)

     F=B+C–D–E         3.2        12.5        12.4        6.0        0.0        34.1   

Compensation costs charged during 2013 (SEK million)

     G         6 2)      108 2)      124 2)      124 2)      26 2)      388 3) 

 

1) Shares under the Executive Performance Stock Plans were based on the fact that the 2009 plan lapsed and that the 2010 plan was fully vested. For the other ongoing plans, full vesting is estimated.
2) Fair value is calculated as the share price on the investment date, reduced by the net present value of the dividend expectations during the three-year vesting period. Net present value calculations are based on data from external party. Fair value is also adjusted for participants failing to keep hold of their contribution shares during the vesting period. For shares under the Executive Performance Stock Plans, the company makes a forecast for the fulfillment of the financial targets for all ongoing plans except for 2009 and 2010 plans as disclosed under 1) when calculating the compensation cost. Fair value of the Class B share at each investment date during 2013 was: February 15 SEK 70.50, May 15 SEK 74.42, August 15 SEK 70.99 and November 15 SEK 73.93.
3) Total compensation costs charged during 2012: SEK 405 million, 2011: SEK 413 million.

Shares for all plans

All plans are funded with treasury stock and are equity settled. Treasury stock for all plans has been issued in directed cash issues of Class C shares at the quotient value and purchased under a public offering at the subscription price plus a premium corresponding to the subscribers’ financing costs, and then converted to Class B shares.

For all plans, additional shares have been allocated for financing of social security expenses. Treasury stock is sold on the NASDAQ OMX Stockholm to cover social security payments when arising due to matching of shares. During 2013, 1,121,900 shares were sold at an average price of SEK 80.19. Sales of shares are recognized directly in equity.

If, as of December 31, 2013, all shares allocated for future matching under the Stock Purchase Plan were transferred, and shares

 

90


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

designated to cover social security payments were disposed of as a result of the exercise and the matching, approximately 64 million Class B shares would be transferred, corresponding to 2.0% of the total number of shares outstanding, or 3,231 million not including treasury stock. As of December 31, 2013, 74 million Class B shares were held as treasury stock.

The table on page 90 shows how shares (representing matching rights but excluding shares for social security expenses) are being used for all outstanding plans. From up to down the table includes (A) the number of shares originally approved by the Annual General Meeting; (B) the number of originally designated shares that were outstanding at the beginning of 2013; (C) the number of shares awards that were granted during 2013; (D) the number of shares matched during 2013; (E) the number of shares forfeited by participants or expired under the plan rules during 2013; and (F) the balance left as outstanding at the end of 2013, having added new awards to the shares outstanding at the beginning of the year and deducted the shares related to awards matched, forfeited and expired. The final row (G) shows the compensation costs charged to the accounts during 2013 for each plan, calculated as fair value in SEK.

For a description of compensation cost, including accounting treatment, see Note C1, “Significant accounting policies,” section Share-based compensation to employees and the Board of Directors.

Employee numbers, wages and salaries

Employee numbers

Average number of employees

 

      2013      2012  
     Women      Men      Total      Women      Men      Total  

North America

     3,234         12,060         15,294         3,479         12,607         16,086   

Latin America

     2,216         9,562         11,778         2,137         9,230         11,367   

Northern Europe & Central Asia1)2)

     5,523         15,519         21,042         5,746         15,351         21,097   

Western & Central Europe2)

     3,802         8,263         12,065         1,790         9,463         11,253   

Mediterranean2)

     2,865         9,793         12,658         2,966         10,064         13,030   

Middle East

     566         4,820         5,386         617         4,603         5,220   

Sub-Saharan Africa

     364         1,704         2,068         548         1,672         2,220   

India

     2,586         15,042         17,628         2,137         11,924         14,061   

North East Asia

     4,308         10,108         14,416         4,191         9,584         13,775   

South East Asia & Oceania

     1,061         3,234         4,295         1,175         3,474         4,649   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     26,525         90,105         116,630         24,786         87,972         112,758   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1)       Of which in Sweden

     4,118         12,972         17,090         4,232         13,337         17,569   

2)        Of which in EU

     11,703         31,729         43,432         9,911         33,581         43,492   

Number of employees by region at year-end

 

      2013      2012  

North America

     14,931         15,501   

Latin America

     11,445         11,219   

Northern Europe & Central Asia1)2)

     21,892         21,211   

Western & Central Europe2)

     11,530         11,257   

Mediterranean2)

     12,314         12,205   

Middle East

     3,752         3,992   

Sub-Saharan Africa

     2,084         2,014   

India

     17,622         14,303   

North East Asia

     14,503         14,157   

South East Asia & Oceania

     4,267         4,396   

Total

     114,340         110,255   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Of which in Sweden

     17,858         17,712   

2) Of which in EU

     43,421         42,872   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Number of employees by gender and age at year-end 2013

 

     Women     Men     Percent
of total
 

Under 25 years old

     1,737        3,285        5

25–35 years old

     9,634        34,966        39

36–45 years old

     7,781        29,895        33

46–55 years old

     4,133        16,830        18

Over 55 years old

     1,298        4,781        5

Percent of total

     21     79     100

Employee movements

 

           2013      2012  

Head count at year-end

        114,340         110,255   

Employees who have left the Company

        13,025         12,280   

Employees who have joined the Company

        17,110         18,010   

Temporary employees

        493         766   

Employee wages and salaries

Wages and salaries and social security expenses

 

(SEK million)

   2013      2012  

Wages and salaries

     48,533         48,428   

Social security expenses

     16,531         15,672   

Of which pension costs

     4,426         2,762   

Amounts related to the President and CEO and the Executive Leadership Team are included.

Remuneration to Board members and Presidents in subsidiaries

 

(SEK million)

   2013      2012  

Salary and other remuneration

     294         243   

Of which annual variable remuneration

     40         33   

Pension costs

     23         27   

 

91


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Board members, Presidents and Group management by gender at year end

 

      2013     2012  
     Women     Men     Women     Men  

Parent Company

        

Board members and President

     25     75     27     73

Group Management

     29     71     29     71

Subsidiaries

        

Board members and Presidents

     27     73     12     88

C29    RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

During 2013, various related party transactions were executed pursuant to contracts based on terms customary in the industry and negotiated on an arm’s length basis. For information regarding equity and Ericsson’s share of assets, liabilities and income in joint ventures and associated companies, see Note C12, “Financial assets, non-current.” For information regarding transactions with senior management, see Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees.”

ST-Ericsson

ST-Ericsson was formed in 2009 as a joint venture equally owned by Ericsson and STMicroelectronics. In early 2013, the parents agreed to split up and close the joint venture. The company ST-Ericsson is winding down and all business has been transferred to parents or divested during 2013. Ericsson has taken over assets and liabilities in the design, development and sales of the thin LTE multi-mode modem solution with a net value of SEK 1.1 billion. The Purchase price allocation related to this acquisition is preliminary. The acquired business is now consolidated into Ericsson in the new segment Modems. For further information, see Note C3, “Segment information” and Note C26 “Business combinations.”

During 2013, Ericsson had no sales to, and purchases from, ST-Ericsson in the course of ordinary business, only transactions related to the winding down described above. Therefore, the descriptions below refers to the years 2011 and 2012. The major transactions in 2011 and 2012 were as follows:

 

   

Sales: Ericsson provides ST-Ericsson with services in the areas of R&D, HR, IT and facilities.

 

   

Purchases: A major part of Ericsson’s purchases from ST-Ericsson consists of chipsets and R&D services.

ST-Ericsson

 

     20131)      2012      2011  

Related party transactions

        

Sales

     —           138         182   

Purchases

     —           634         781   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Related party balances

        

Receivables

     —           127         51   

Liabilities

     —           —           24   

 

1) See text above for further information.

Ericsson does not have any contingent liabilities, assets pledged as collateral or guarantees towards ST-Ericsson.

C30    FEES TO AUDITORS

Fees to auditors

 

     PwC      Others      Total  

2013

        

Audit fees

     75         7         82   

Audit-related fees

     12         —           12   

Tax services fees

     12         3         15   

Other fees

     15         1         16   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     114         11         125   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2012

        

Audit fees

     82         5         87   

Audit-related fees

     15         —           15   

Tax services fees

     16         3         19   

Other fees

     10         10         20   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     123         18         141   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2011

        

Audit fees

     77         9         86   

Audit-related fees

     10         —           10   

Tax services fees

     20         3         23   

Other fees

     16         —           16   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     123         12         135   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

During the period 2011–2013, in addition to audit services, PwC provided certain audit-related services, tax and other services to the Company. The audit-related services include quarterly reviews, ISO audits, SSAE 16 reviews and services in connection with the issuing of certificates and opinions and consultation on financial accounting. The tax services include general expatriate services and corporate tax compliance work. Other services include, work related to acquisitions, operational effectiveness and assessments of internal control.

Audit fees to other auditors largely consist of local statutory audits.

C31    CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS

Contractual obligations 2013

 

     Payment due by period         

SEK billion

   <1
year
     1–3
years
     3–5
years
     >5
years
     Total  

Long-term debt1)2)

     6.5         3.1         5.6         13.5         28.7   

Finance lease obligations3)

     0.1         0.2         0.3         0.7         1.3   

Operating leases3)

     2.1         3.2         1.5         2.4         9.2   

Other non-current liabilities

     0.1         0.2         0.1         1.1         1.5   

Purchase obligations4)

     5.4         —           —           —           5.4   

Trade payables

     20.5         —           —           —           20.5   

Commitments for customer finance5)

     6.4         —           —           —           6.4   

Total

     41.1         6.7         7.5         17.7         73.0   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Including interest payments.
2) See Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments.”
3) See Note C27, “Leasing.”
4) The amounts of purchase obligations are gross, before deduction of any related provisions.
5) See also Note C14, “Trade receivables and customer finance.”

For information about financial guarantees, see Note C24, “Contingent liabilities.”

Except for those transactions described in this report, the Company has not been a party to any material contracts over the past three years other than those entered into during the ordinary course of business.

 

92


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

Internal control over finacial reporting

Ericsson’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company. Ericsson’s internal control system related to financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) and includes those policies and procedures that:

 

   

pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company;

 

   

provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS), and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and

 

   

provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Although the purpose of internal control systems is to ensure adequate risk management all internal control systems, no matter how well designed, have inherent limitations which may result in that misstatements are not prevented or detected. Therefore, even systems determined to be effective can provide only reasonable assurance with respect to the reliability of financial statement preparation and presentation.

Ericsson’s management assessed the effectiveness of Ericsson’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013. In making this assessment, management used the criteria set forth in “Internal Control—Integrated Framework (1992)”, issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

Based on this assessment, management has concluded that, as of December 31, 2013, Ericsson’s internal control over financial reporting was effective at a reasonable assurance level.

Attestation report of registered public accounting firm

The effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2013, has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers AB, an independent registered public accounting firm. PricewaterhouseCoopers AB has issued an attestation report on Ericsson’s internal control over financial reporting, which appears on page 41.

Changes in internal control over financial reporting

During the period covered by the Annual Report 2013, there were no changes to the internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are likely to materially affect, the internal control over financial reporting.

 

93


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

RISK FACTORS

You should carefully consider all the information in this Annual Report and in particular the risks and uncertainties outlined below. Based on the information currently known to us, we believe that the following information identifies the most significant risk factors affecting our business. Any of the factors described below, or any other risk factors discussed elsewhere in this report, could have a material negative effect on our business, revenues, operating and after-tax results, financial condition, cash flow, liquidity, credit rating, marketshare, reputation, brand and/or our share price. Additional risks and uncertainties not presently known to us or that we currently believe to be immaterial may also materially adversely affect our business. Furthermore, our operating results may have a greater variability than in the past and we may have difficulties in accurately predicting future developments. See also “Forward-Looking Statements.”

MARKET, TECHNOLOGY AND BUSINESS RISKS

Challenging global economic conditions may adversely impact the demand and pricing for our products and services as well as limit our ability to grow.

Challenging global economic conditions could have adverse, wide-ranging effects on demand for our products and for the products of our customers. Adverse global economic conditions could cause operators and other customers to postpone investments or initiate other cost-cutting initiatives to improve their financial position. This could result in significantly reduced expenditures for network infrastructure and services, in which case our operating results would suffer. If demand for our products and services were to fall in the future, we could experience material adverse effects on our revenues, cash flow, capital employed and value of our assets and we could incur operating losses. Furthermore, if demand is significantly weaker or more volatile than expected, our credit rating, borrowing opportunities and costs as well as the trading price of our shares could be adversely impacted. When deemed necessary, we undertake specific restructuring or cost-saving initiatives; however, there are no guarantees that such initiatives will be sufficient, successful or executed in time to deliver any improvements in our earnings.

Should global economic conditions fail to improve, or worsen, other business risks we face could intensify and could also negatively impact the business prospects of operators and other customers. Some operators and other customers, in particular in markets with weak currencies, may incur borrowing difficulties and slower traffic development, which may negatively affect their investment plans and cause them to purchase less of our products and services.

The potential adverse effects of an economic downturn include:

 

   

Reduced demand for products and services, resulting in increased price competition or deferrals of purchases, with lower revenues not fully compensated through reduced costs

 

   

Risks of excess and obsolete inventories and excess manufacturing capacity

 

   

Risk of financial difficulties or failures among our suppliers

 

   

Increased demand for customer finance, difficulties in collection of accounts receivable and increased risk of counter party failures

 

   

Risk of impairment losses related to our intangible assets as a result of lower forecasted sales of certain products

 

   

Increased difficulties in forecasting sales and financial results as well as increased volatility in our reported results

 

   

A decline in the value in our pension plan assets and/or increased pension liabilities due to discount rate changes or other accounting or regulatory changes

 

   

End user demand could also be adversely affected by reduced consumer spending on technology, changed operator pricing, security breaches and trust issues.

The telecommunications industry fluctuates and is affected by many factors, including the economic environment, and decisions made by operators and other customers regarding their deployment of technology and their timing of purchases.

The telecommunications industry has experienced downturns in the past in which operators substantially reduced their capital spending on new equipment. While we expect the network service provider equipment market and telecommunications services market to grow in the coming years, the uncertainty surrounding the global economic recovery may materially harm actual market conditions. Moreover, market conditions are subject to substantial fluctuation, and could vary geographically and across technologies. Even if global conditions improve, conditions in the specific industry segments in which we participate may be weaker than in other segments. In that case, our operating results, may be adversely affected.

If capital expenditures by operators and other customers is weaker than we anticipate, our revenues and profitability may be adversely affected. The level of demand from operators and other customers who buy our products and services can change quickly and can vary over short periods of time, including from month to month. Due to the uncertainty and variations in the telecommunications industry, accurately forecasting revenues, results, and cash flow remains difficult.

Sales volumes and gross margin levels are affected by the variation and short order time of our products and services.

Our sales to operators and other customers represent a mix of equipment, software and services, which normally generate different gross margins. We sell our own products as well as third party products, which normally have lower margins than our own products. As a consequence, our reported gross margin in a specific period will be affected by the overall mix of products and services as well as the relative content of third party products. Further, network expansions and upgrades have much shorter lead times for delivery than initial network build outs. Orders for such network expansions and upgrades are normally placed at short notice by customers, often less than a month in advance,

 

94


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

and consequently variations in demand are difficult to forecast. As a result, changes in our product and service mix and the short order time for certain of our products may affect our ability to accurately forecast sales and margins or detect in advance whether actual results will deviate from market consensus. Short-term variation could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition and cash flow.

We may not be able to properly respond to market trends in the industries in which we operate, including the ongoing convergence of the telecom, data and media industries, which may harm our market position relative to our competitors.

We are affected by market conditions and trends within the industries in which we operate, including the convergence of the telecom, data and media industries. Convergence is largely driven by technological development related to IP-based communications. This has changed the competitive landscape and affects our objective-setting, risk assessment and strategies. Competitors new to our business may enter this new business context and negatively impact our market share in selected areas. If we fail to understand the market development, or fail to acquire the necessary competencies to develop and sell products, services and solutions that are competitive in this changing business environment, our business, operating results and financial condition will suffer.

Our business depends upon the continued growth of mobile communications and the acceptance of new services. If growth slows or new services do not succeed, operators’ investment in networks may slow or stop, harming our business.

A substantial portion of our business depends on the continued growth of mobile communications in terms of both the number of subscriptions and usage per subscriber, which in turn drives the continued deployment and expansion of network systems by our customers. If operators fail to increase the number of subscribers and/or stimulate increased usage, our business and operating results could be materially adversely affected. Also, if operators fail to monetize new services, fail to introduce new business models or experience a decline in operator revenues or profitability, their willingness to further invest in their network systems may decrease which will reduce their demand for our products and services and have an adverse effect on our business, operating results and financial condition.

Fixed and mobile networks converge and new technologies, such as IP and broadband, enable operators to deliver a range of new types of services in both fixed and mobile networks. We are dependent upon market acceptance of such services and the outcome of regulatory and standardization activities in this field, such as spectrum allocation. If delays in standardization, regulation, or market acceptance occur, this could adversely affect our business, operational results and financial condition.

We face intense competition from our existing competitors as well as new entrants, including IT companies entering the telecommunications market, and this could materially adversely affect our results.

The markets in which we operate are highly competitive in terms of price, functionality, service quality, customization, timing of development, and the introduction of new products and services. We face intense competition from significant competitors, many of which are very large, with substantial technological and financial resources and established relationships with operators. Further, certain competitors, Chinese companies in particular, have become relatively stronger in recent years. We may also encounter increased competition from new market entrants, alternative technologies or due to evolving industry standards. In particular, we may face competition from large IT companies entering the telecommunications market who benefit from economies of scale due to being active in several industries. We cannot assure that we will be able to compete successfully with these companies. Our competitors may implement new technologies before we do, offer more attractively priced or enhanced products, services or solutions, or they may offer other incentives that we do not provide. Some of our competitors may also have greater resources in certain business segments or geographic markets than we do. Increased competition could result in reduced profit margins, loss of market share, increased research and development costs as well as increased sales and marketing expenses. Traffic development on cellular networks could be affected if more traffic is offloaded to Wi-Fi networks. Further, alternative services provided over-the-top have profound effects on operator voice/ SMS revenues with possible reduced capital expenses consequences.

Additionally, we operate in markets characterized by rapidly changing technology. This results in continuous price erosion and increased price competition for our products and services. If our counter measures, including enhanced products and business models or cost reductions cannot be achieved or do not occur in a timely manner, there could be adverse impacts on our business, operating results, financial condition and market share.

Vendor consolidation may lead to stronger competitors who are able to benefit from integration, scale and greater resources.

Industry convergence and consolidation among equipment and services suppliers could potentially result in stronger competitors that are competing as end-to-end suppliers as well as competitors more specialized in particular areas. Consolidation may also result in competitors with greater resources than we have or in reduction of our current scale advantages. This could have a materially adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition and market share.

A significant portion of our revenue is currently generated from a limited number of key customers, and operator consolidation may increase our dependence on key customers.

We derive most of our business from large, multi-year agreements with a limited number of significant customers. Many of these agreements are opened up on a yearly basis to renegotiate the price for our products and services and do not contain committed purchase volumes. Although no single customer represents more than 8% of our sales in 2013, our ten largest customers accounted for 44% of our sales in 2013. A loss of or a reduced role with a key customer could have a significant adverse impact on sales, profit and market share for an extended period.

In recent years, network operators have undergone significant consolidation, resulting in fewer operators with activities in several countries. This trend is expected to continue, and intra-country consolidation is likely to accelerate as a result of competitive pressure. A market with fewer and larger operators will increase our reliance on key customers and may negatively impact our bargaining position and profit margins. Moreover, if the combined companies operate in the same geographic market, networks may be shared and less network equipment and fewer associated services may be required. Network investments could be delayed by the consolidation process, which may include, among others, actions relating to merger or acquisition agreements, securing necessary regulatory approvals, or integration of businesses. Network operators have started to

 

95


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

share parts of their network infrastructure through cooperation agreements rather than legal consolidations, which may adversely affect demand for network equipment. Accordingly, operator consolidation may have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results and financial condition.

Certain long-term agreements with customers still include commitments to future price reductions, requiring us to constantly manage and control our cost base.

Long-term agreements with our customers are typically awarded on a competitive bidding basis. In some cases, such agreements also include a commitment to future price reductions. In order to maintain our gross margin with such price reductions, we continuously strive to reduce the costs of our products through design improvements, negotiation of better purchase prices from our suppliers, allocation of more production to low-cost countries and increased productivity in our own production. However, there can be no assurance that our actions to reduce costs will be sufficient or quick enough to maintain our gross margin in such contracts, which may have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results and financial condition.

Growth of our managed services business is difficult to predict, and requires taking significant contractual risks.

Operators increasingly outsource parts of their operations to reduce cost and focus on new services. To address this opportunity, we offer operators various services in which we manage their networks. The growth rate in the managed services market is difficult to forecast and each new contract carries a risk that transformation and integration of the operations will not be as fast or smooth as planned. Additionally, early contract margins are generally low and the mix of new and old contracts may negatively affect reported results in a given period. Contracts for such services normally cover several years and generate recurring revenues. However, contracts have been, and may in the future be, terminated or reduced in scope, which has negative impacts on sales and earnings. While we believe we have a strong position in the managed services market, competition in this area is increasing, which may have adverse effects on our future growth and profitability.

We depend upon the development of new products and enhancements to our existing products, and the success of our substantial research and development investments is uncertain.

Rapid technological and market changes in our industry require us to make significant investments in technological innovation. We invest significantly in new technology, products and solutions. In order for us to be successful, those technologies, products and solutions must be accepted by relevant standardization bodies and by the industry as a whole. The failure of our research and development efforts to be technically or commercially successful could have adverse effects on our business, operating results and financial condition. If we invest in the development of technologies, products and solutions that do not function as expected, are not adopted by the industry, are not ready in time, or are not successful in the marketplace, our sales and earnings may materially suffer. Additionally, it is common for research and development projects to encounter delays due to unforeseen problems. Delays in production may increase the cost of research and development efforts and put us at a disadvantage against our competition. This could have a material adverse effect upon our business, operating results and financial condition.

We engage in acquisitions and divestments which may be disruptive and require us to incur significant expenses.

In addition to in-house innovation efforts, we make strategic acquisitions in order to obtain various benefits such as reduced time-to-market, access to technology and competence, increased scale or to broaden our product portfolio or customer base. Future acquisitions could result in the incurrence of contingent liabilities and an increase in amortization expenses related to goodwill and other intangible assets, which could have a material adverse effect upon our business, operating results, financial condition and liquidity. Risks we could face with respect to acquisitions include:

 

   

Difficulties in the integration of the operations, technologies, products and personnel of the acquired company

 

   

Risks of entering markets in which we have no or limited prior experience

 

   

Potential loss of employees

 

   

Diversion of management’s attention away from other business concerns

 

   

Expenses of any undisclosed or potential legal liabilities of the acquired company.

From time to time we also divest parts of our business to optimize our product portfolio or operations. Any decision to dispose of or otherwise exit businesses may result in the recording of special charges, such as workforce reduction costs and industry- and technology-related write-offs. We cannot assure that we will be successful in consummating future acquisitions or divestments on favorable terms or at all. The risks associated with such acquisitions and divestments could have a material adverse effect upon our business, operating results, financial condition and liquidity.

We are in, and may enter into new, JV arrangements and have, and may have new, partnerships which may not be successful and expose us to future costs.

Our JV and partnering arrangements may fail to perform as expected for various reasons, including an incorrect assessment of our needs, our inability to take action without the approval of our partners or the capabilities or financial stability of our strategic partners. Our ability to work with these partners or develop new products and solutions may become constrained, which could harm our competitive position in the market.

Additionally, our share of any losses from or commitments to contribute additional capital to such partnerships may adversely affect our business, operating results, financial condition and cash flow.

We rely on a limited number of suppliers of components, production capacity and R&D and IT services, which exposes us to supply disruptions and cost increases.

Our ability to deliver according to market demands and contractual commitments depends significantly on obtaining a timely and adequate supply of materials, components, production capacity and other vital services on competitive terms. Although we strive to avoid single-source supplier solutions, this is not always possible. Accordingly, there is a risk that we will be unable to obtain key supplies we need to produce our products and provide our services on commercially reasonable terms, or at all. Failure by any of our suppliers could interrupt our product or services supply or operations and significantly limit sales or increase our costs. To find an alternative supplier or redesign products to replace components may take significant time which could cause significant delays or interruptions in the delivery of our products and services. We have from time to time experienced interruptions of supply and we may experience such interruptions in the future.

 

96


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Furthermore, our procurement of supplies requires us to predict future customer demands. If we fail to anticipate customer demand properly, an over or under supply of components and production capacity could occur. In many cases, some of our competitors utilize the same manufacturers and if they have purchased capacity ahead of us we could be blocked from acquiring the needed products. This factor could limit our ability to supply our customers or could increase costs. At the same time, we commit to certain capacity levels or component quantities, which, if unused, will result in charges for unused capacity or scrapping costs. We are also exposed to financial counterpart risks to suppliers when we pay in advance for supplies. Such supply disruptions and cost increases may negatively affect our business, operating results and financial condition.

Product or service quality issues could lead to reduced revenue and gross margins and declining sales to existing and new customers.

Sales contracts normally include warranty undertakings for faulty products and often include provisions regarding penalties and/ or termination rights in the event of a failure to deliver ordered products or services on time or with required quality. Although we undertake a number of quality assurance measures to reduce such risks, product quality or service performance issues may negatively affect our reputation, operating results and financial condition. If significant warranty obligations arise due to reliability or quality issues, our operating results and financial position could be negatively impacted by costs associated with fixing software or hardware defects, high service and warranty expenses, high inventory obsolescence expense, delays in collecting accounts receivable or declining sales to existing and new customers.

Due to having a significant portion of our costs in SEK and revenues in other currencies, our business is exposed to foreign exchange fluctuations that could negatively impact our revenues and operating results.

We incur a significant portion of our expenses in SEK. As a result of our international operations, we generate, and expect to continue to generate, a significant portion of our revenue in currencies other than SEK. To the extent we are unable to match revenue received in foreign currencies with costs paid in the same currency, exchange rate fluctuations could have a negative impact on our consolidated income statement, balance sheet and cash flows when foreign currencies are exchanged or translated to SEK, which increases volatility in reported results.

As market prices are predominantly established in USD or EUR, we presently have a net revenue exposure in foreign currencies which means that a stronger SEK exchange rate would generally have a negative effect on our reported results. Our attempts to reduce the effects of exchange rate fluctuations through a variety of hedging activities may not be sufficient or successful, resulting in an adverse impact on our results and financial condition.

Our ability to benefit from intellectual property rights (IPR) which are critical to our business may be limited by changes in regulation limiting patents, inability to prevent infringement, the loss of licenses from third parties, infringement claims brought against us by competitors and others and changes in the area of open standards, especially in light of recent attention on licensing of open standard patents.

Although we have a large number of patents, there can be no assurance that they will not be challenged, invalidated, or circumvented, or that any rights granted in relation to our patents will in fact provide us with competitive advantages.

We utilize a combination of trade secrets, confidentiality policies, nondisclosure and other contractual arrangements in addition to relying on patent, copyright and trademark laws to protect our intellectual property rights. However, these measures may not be adequate to prevent or deter infringement or other misappropriation. In addition, we rely on many software patents, and limitations on the patentability of software may materially affect our business.

Moreover, we may not be able to detect unauthorized use or take appropriate and timely steps to establish and enforce our proprietary rights. In fact, existing legal systems of some countries in which we conduct business offer only limited protection of intellectual property rights, if at all. Our solutions may also require us to license technologies from third parties. It may be necessary in the future to seek or renew licenses and there can be no assurance that they would be available on acceptable terms, or at all. Moreover, the inclusion in our products of software or other intellectual property licensed from third parties on a non-exclusive basis could limit our ability to protect proprietary rights in our products.

Many key aspects of telecommunications and data network technology are governed by industry-wide standards usable by all market participants. As the number of market entrants and the complexity of technology increases, the possibility of functional overlap and inadvertent infringement of intellectual property rights also increases. Third parties have asserted, and may assert in the future, claims, directly against us or against our customers, alleging infringement of their intellectual property rights. Defending such claims may be expensive, time-consuming and divert the efforts of our management and/or technical personnel. As a result of litigation, we could be required to pay damages and other compensation directly or to indemnify our customers for such damages and other compensation, develop non-infringing products/technology or enter into royalty or licensing agreements. However, we cannot be certain that such licenses will be available to us on commercially reasonable terms or at all, and such judgments could have a materially adverse effect on our business, reputation, operating results and financial condition.

Recent attention on licensing of patents necessary to conduct an open standard (e.g. 2G, 3G and 4G technology), investigations held by antitrust authorities and legislative change could potentially affect Ericsson’s ability to benefit from its patent portfolio in the area of such open standards, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, reputation, operating results and financial condition. Ericsson holds a leading patent portfolio in open standards and possible changes regarding such a portfolio may materially affect our business.

We are involved in lawsuits and investigations which, if determined against us, could require us to pay substantial damages, fines and/or penalties.

In the normal course of our business we are involved in legal proceedings. These lawsuits include such matters as commercial

 

97


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

disputes, claims regarding intellectual property, antitrust, tax and labour disputes. Litigation can be expensive, lengthy and disruptive to normal business operations. Moreover, the results of complex legal proceedings are difficult to predict. An unfavorable resolution of a particular lawsuit could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition and reputation.

As a publicly listed company, Ericsson may be exposed to lawsuits in which plaintiffs allege that the Company or its officers have failed to comply with securities laws, stock market regulations or other laws, regulations or requirements. Whether or not there is merit to such claims, the time and costs incurred to defend the Company and its officers and the potential settlement or compensation to the plaintiffs could have significant impact on our reported results and reputation. For additional information regarding certain of the lawsuits in which we are involved, see “Legal Proceedings” in the Board of Directors’ Report.

Our operations are complex and several critical operations are centralized in a single location. Any disruption of our operations, whether due to natural or man-made events, may be highly damaging to the operation of our business.

Our business operations rely on complex operations and communications networks, which are vulnerable to damage or disturbance from a variety of sources. Having outsourced a significant portion of our IT operations, we depend partly on security and reliability measures of external companies. Regardless of protection measures, our systems and communications networks are susceptible to disruption due to failure, vandalism, computer viruses, security breaches, natural disasters, power outages and other events. We also have a concentration of operations on certain sites, including R&D, production, network operation centers, and logistic centers and shared services centers, where business interruptions could cause material damage and costs. The delivery of goods from suppliers, and to customers, could also be hampered for the reasons stated above. Interruptions to our systems and communications may have an adverse effect on our operations and financial condition.

Cyber security incidents affecting our business may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, reputation and brand.

Ericsson’s business operations involve areas that are particularly vulnerable to cyber security incidents such as data breaches, intrusions, espionage, know-how and data privacy infringements, leakage and general malfeasance. Examples of these areas include, among others, research and development, managed services, usage of cloud solutions, software development, lawful interception and product engineering. Any cyber security incident including unintended use, involving our operations, product development, services, our third party providers or installed product base, could cause severe harm to Ericsson and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, reputation and brand.

Ericsson relies heavily on third parties to whom we have outsourced significant aspects of our IT infrastructure, product development and engineering services. While we have taken precautions relating to the selection, integration and ongoing management of these third parties, any event or attack that is caused as a result of vulnerabilities in their operations or products supplied to us could have a material adverse effect upon Ericsson, our business, financial condition, reputation and brand, potentially slowing operations, leaking valuable intellectual property or damaging our products which have been installed in our customers’ networks.

We must continue to attract and retain highly qualified employees to remain competitive.

We believe that our future success largely depends on our continued ability to hire, develop, motivate and retain engineers and other qualified personnel needed to develop successful new products, support our existing product range and provide services to our customers.

Competition for skilled personnel and highly qualified managers in the telecommunications industry remains intense. We are continuously developing our corporate culture, remuneration, promotion and benefits policies as well as other measures aimed at empowering our employees and reducing employee turnover. However, there are no guarantees that we will be successful in attracting and retaining employees with appropriate skills in the future, and failure in retention and recruiting could have a material adverse effect on our business and brand.

If our customers’ financial conditions decline, we will be exposed to increased credit and commercial risks.

After completing sales to customers, we may encounter difficulty collecting accounts receivables and could be exposed to risks associated with uncollectable accounts receivable. We regularly assess the credit worthiness of our customers and based on that we determine a credit limit for each one of them. Challenging economic conditions have impacted some of our customers’ ability to pay their accounts receivables. Although our credit losses have historically been low and we have policies and procedures for managing customer finance credit risk we may be unable to avoid future losses on our trade receivables. We have also experienced demands for customer financing, and in adverse financial markets or more competitive environments, those demands may increase. Upon the financial failure of a customer, we may experience losses on credit extended and loans made to such customer, losses relating to our commercial risk exposure, and the loss of the customer’s ongoing business. If customers fail to meet their obligations to us, we may experience reduced cash flows and losses in excess of reserves, which could materially adversely impact our operating results and financial condition.

We rely on various capital sources for short-term and long-term capital for the funding of our business. Should such capital become unavailable or available in insufficient amounts or unreasonable terms, our business, financial condition and cashflow may materially suffer.

If we do not generate sufficient amounts of capital to support our operations, service our debt and continue our research and development and customer finance programs, or if we cannot raise sufficient amounts of capital at the required times and on the set terms, our business is likely to be adversely affected. Access to funding may decrease or become more expensive as a result of our operational and financial condition, market conditions, including financial conditions in the Eurozone, or due to deterioration in our credit rating. There can be no assurance that additional sources of funds that we may need from time to time, will be available or available on reasonable terms. If we cannot access capital on a commercially viable basis, our business, financial condition and cashflow could materially suffer.

 

98


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Impairment of goodwill may negatively impact financial condition.

An impairment of goodwill or other intangible assets could adversely affect our financial condition or results of operations. We have a significant amount of goodwill and intangible assets; for example, patents, customer relations, trademarks and software. Goodwill is the only intangible asset the company has recognized to have indefinite useful life.

Other intangible assets are mainly amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives, but for no more than ten years, and are reviewed for impairment whenever events such as product discontinuances, product dispositions or other changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be wholly recoverable. Those not yet in use are tested for impairment annually.

Historically, we have recognized impairment charges related to intangible assets mainly due to restructuring. Additional impairment charges may be incurred in the future that could be significant due to various reasons, including restructuring actions or adverse market conditions that are either specific to us or the broader telecommunications industry or more general in nature and that could have an adverse effect on our operating results and financial condition.

Negative deviations in actual cash flows compared to estimated cash flows as well as new estimates that indicate lower future cash flows might result in recognition of impairment charges. Estimates require management judgment as well as the definition of cash-generating units for impairment testing purposes. Other judgments might result in significantly different results and may differ from the actual financial condition in the future.

REGULATORY, COMPLIANCE AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE RISKS

Our business may suffer as a result of changes in laws or regulations which could subject us to liability, increase costs, or reduce product demand.

Telecommunications is an industry which is subject to regulations. Changes to these regulations may adversely affect both our customers’ and our own operations. For example, regulations imposing more stringent, time-consuming or costly planning and zoning requirements or building approvals for radio base stations and other network infrastructure could adversely affect the timing and costs of network construction or expansion, and ultimately the commercial launch and success of these networks. Similarly, tariff and roaming regulations or rules on network neutrality could also affect operators’ ability or willingness to invest in network infrastructure, which in turn could affect the sales of our systems and services. Additionally, delay in radio frequency spectrum allocation, and allocation between different types of usage may adversely affect operator spending or force us to develop new products to be able to compete.

Further, we develop many of our products and services based on existing regulations and technical standards. Changes to existing regulations and technical standards, or the implementation of new regulations and technical standards relating to products and services not previously regulated, could adversely affect our development efforts by increasing compliance costs and causing delay. Demand for those products and services could also decline. Regulatory changes in license fees, environmental, health and safety, privacy and other regulatory areas may increase costs and restrict our operations or the operations of network operators and service providers. Also indirect impacts of such changes and regulatory changes in other fields, such as pricing regulations, could have an adverse impact on our business even though the specific regulations may not apply directly to our products or us.

Ericsson may fail or be unable to comply with laws or regulations and could experience adverse rulings in enforcement or other proceedings, which could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition and brand.

Our substantial international operations are subject to uncertainties which could affect our operating results.

We conduct business throughout the world and are subject to the effects of general global economic conditions as well as conditions unique to specific countries or regions. We have customers in more than 180 countries, with a significant proportion of our sales to emerging markets in the Asia Pacific region, Latin America, Eastern Europe, the Middle East and Africa.

Our extensive operations are subject to numerous additional risks, including civil disturbances, economic and political instability, the imposition of exchange controls, economies which are subject to significant fluctuations, nationalization of private assets or other governmental actions affecting the flow of goods and currency, and difficulty of enforcing agreements and collecting receivables through local legal systems. Further, in certain markets in which we operate, there is a risk of protectionist governmental measures implemented to assist domestic market participants at the expense of foreign competitors. The implementation of such measures could adversely affect our sales or our ability to purchase critical components.

We must always comply with relevant export control regulations and sanctions or other trade embargoes in force, not only at the time of sale but also at the time of delivery. The political situation in parts of the world, particularly in the Middle East, remains uncertain and the level of sanctions are still high. A universal element of these sanctions is the financial restrictions with respect to individuals and/or legal entities, but sanctions can also restrict certain exports and ultimately lead to a complete trade embargo towards a country. In particular, the sanctions towards Iran are still significant in scope, although in part temporarily and conditionally recently relieved. The EU exemption for certain standard telecom equipment is still maintained. Even so, there is a risk in many of these countries of unexpected changes in regulatory requirements, tariffs and other trade barriers, price or exchange controls, or other governmental policies which could limit our operations and decrease our profitability. Further export control regulations, sanctions or other forms of trade restrictions imposed on countries in which we are active may result in a reduction of commitment in those countries. The need to terminate activities as a result of further trade restrictions may also expose us to customer claims and other actions. Although we seek to comply with all such regulations, there can be no assurance that we are, or will be in the future, compliant with all relevant regulations and such violations, even unintentional violations, could have material adverse effects on our business, operating results, reputation and brand.

There has been a growing concern reported by media and others, that certain countries may use features of their telecommunications systems in violation of human rights. This may adversely affect the telecommunications business and may have a negative impact on our reputation and brand.

As a result of the credit crisis in Europe, concerns persist regarding the debt burden of certain Eurozone countries and their

 

99


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

ability to meet future financial obligations, the overall stability of the euro and the suitability of the euro as a single currency given the diverse economic and political circumstances in individual member states. These and other concerns could in worst case lead to the re-introduction of individual currencies in one or more member states, or, in more extreme circumstances, the possible dissolution of the euro entirely. These potential developments, or market perceptions concerning these and related issues, could adversely affect our operations and have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results and financial condition.

We may fail to comply with our corporate governance standards which could negatively affect our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation and our brand.

We are subject to corporate governance laws and regulations and are also committed to several corporate responsibility and sustainability initiatives. In some of the countries where we operate, corruption risks are high. In addition, there is higher focus on anticorruption, with changed legislation in many countries. To ensure that our operations are executed in accordance with applicable requirements, our management system includes a Code of Business Ethics, a Code of Conduct and a Sustainability Policy, as well as other policies and directives to govern our processes and operations. Our commitment to apply the UN Global Compact principles, the UN Guiding Principles for Business and Human Rights and principles of the Partnering Against Corruption Initiative to our operation cannot fully prevent unintended or unlawful use of our technology by non-democratic regimes, corruption or violations of our Code of Conduct in the supply chain. While we attempt to monitor and audit internal compliance with the policies and directives as well as our suppliers’ adherence to our Code of Conduct and strive for continuous improvements, we cannot provide any assurances that violations will not occur which could have material adverse effects on our business, operating results, reputation and brand.

Failure to comply with environmental, health and safety regulations in many jurisdictions may expose us to significant penalties and other sanctions.

We are subject to certain environmental, health and safety laws and regulations that affect our operations, facilities and products in each of the jurisdictions in which we operate. While we believe that we are in compliance with all material laws and regulations related to the environment, health, and safety, we can provide no assurance that we have been, are, or will in the future be compliant with these regulations. If we have failed or fail to comply with these regulations, we could be subject to significant penalties and other sanctions that could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation and brand. Additionally, there is a risk that we may have to incur expenditures to cover environmental and health liabilities to maintain compliance with current or future laws and regulations or to undertake any necessary remediation. It is difficult to reasonably estimate the future impact of environmental matters, such as climate change and weather events, including potential liabilities. This is due to several factors, particularly the length of time often involved in resolving such matters. Adverse future events, regulations, or judgments could have a material adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation and brand.

Potential health risks related to electromagnetic fields may subject us to various product liability claims and result in regulatory changes.

The mobile telecommunications industry is subject to claims that mobile handsets and other devices that generate electromagnetic fields expose users to health risks. At present, a substantial number of scientific studies conducted by various independent research bodies have indicated that electromagnetic fields, at levels within the limits prescribed by public health authority safety standards and recommendations, cause no adverse effects to human health. However, any perceived risk or new scientific findings of adverse health effects from mobile communication devices and equipment could adversely affect us through a reduction in sales or through liability claims. Although Ericsson’s products are designed to comply with all current safety standards and recommendations regarding applicable electromagnetic fields, we cannot guarantee that we will not become the subject of product liability claims or be held liable for such claims or be required to comply with future regulatory changes that may have an adverse effect on our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation and brand.

Regulations related to “conflict minerals” may cause us to incur additional expenses, and may make our supply chain more complex.

In 2012, the US Securities and Exchange Commission ( the “SEC”) adopted a new rule requiring disclosures beginning in 2014 of specified minerals (“conflict minerals”) that are necessary to the functionality or production of products manufactured or contracted to be manufactured by companies registered with the SEC, whether or not these products or their components are manufactured by third parties. While we believe that we will be able to fulfill these requirements without materially affecting our costs or access to materials we can provide no assurance that there will not be material costs associated with complying with the disclosure requirements.

While we work and strive to be able to sufficiently verify the origins of these minerals, our supply chain is complex, and we may not be able to sufficiently verify the origins of the relevant minerals used in our products through the due diligence procedures that we implement, which may harm our reputation. In addition we may encounter challenges if customers require that all of the components of our products be certified as conflict-free. These new disclosure requirements may negatively affect our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation and brand.

RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH OWNING ERICSSON SHARES

Our share price has been and may continue to be volatile, especially as technology companies, securities and markets as a whole remain volatile.

Our share price has been volatile due to various factors, including our operating performance as well as the high volatility in the securities markets generally and volatility in telecommunications and technology companies’ securities in particular. Our share price is also likely to be affected by future developments in our market, our reported financial results and the expectations of financial analysts, as well as statements and market speculation regarding our future prospects or the timing or content of any public communications, including reports of operating results, by us or our competitors.

 

100


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Factors other than our financial results that may affect our share price include, but are not limited to:

 

   

A weakening of our brand name or other circumstances with adverse effects on our reputation

 

   

Announcements by our customers, competitors or us regarding capital spending plans of our customers

 

   

Financial difficulties for our customers

 

   

Awards of large supply or service contracts

 

   

Speculation in the press or investment community about the business level or growth in the telecommunications market

 

   

Technical problems, in particular those relating to the introduction and viability of new network systems, including LTE/4G and new platforms such as the RBS 6000 (multi-standard radio base station) platform

 

   

Actual or expected results of ongoing or potential litigation

 

   

Announcements concerning bankruptcy or investigations into the accounting procedures of ourselves or other telecommunications companies

 

   

Our ability to forecast and communicate our future results in a manner consistent with investor expectations.

Currency fluctuations may adversely affect share value or value of dividends.

Because our shares are quoted in SEK on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm (our primary stock exchange), but in USD on NASDAQ New York (ADSs), fluctuations in exchange rates between SEK and USD may affect the value of our shareholders’ investments. In addition, because we pay cash dividends in SEK, fluctuations in exchange rates may affect the value of distributions when converted into other currencies. An increasing part of the trade in our shares is carried out on alternative exchanges or markets, which may lead to less accurate share price information on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm or NASDAQ New York.

 

101


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This Annual Report includes forward-looking statements, including statements reflecting management’s current views relating to the growth of the market, future market conditions, future events and expected operational and financial performance. The words “believe,” “expect,” “foresee,” “anticipate,” “assume,” “intend,” “may,” “could,” “plan,” “estimate,” “forecast,” “will,” “should,” “predict,” “aim,” “ambition,” “target,” “might,” or, in each case, their negative, and similar words are intended to help identify forward-looking statements.

Forward-looking statements may be found throughout this document, and include statements regarding:

 

   

Our goals, strategies and operational or financial performance expectations

 

   

Development of corporate governance standards, stock market regulations and related legislation

 

   

The future characteristics of the markets in which we operate

 

   

Projections and other characterizations of future events

 

   

Our liquidity, capital resources, capital expenditures, our credit ratings and the development in the capital markets, affecting our industry or us

 

   

The expected demand for our existing as well as new products and services

 

   

The expected operational or financial performance of joint ventures and other strategic cooperation activities

 

   

The time until acquired entities will be accretive to income

 

   

Technology and industry trends including regulatory and standardization environment, competition and our customer structure

 

   

Our plans for new products and services including research and development expenditures.

Although we believe that the expectations reflected in these and other forward-looking statements are reasonable, we cannot assure you that these expectations will materialize. Because forward-looking statements are based on assumptions, judgments and estimates, and are subject to risks and uncertainties, actual results could differ materially from those described or implied herein.

Important factors that could affect whether and to what extent any of our forward-looking statements materialize include, but are not limited to:

 

   

Challenging global economic conditions may adversely impact the demand and pricing for our products and services as well as limit our ability to grow.

 

   

The telecommunications industry fluctuates and is affected by many factors, including the economic environment, and decisions made by operators and other customers regarding their deployment of technology and their timing of purchases.

 

   

Sales volumes and gross margin levels are affected by the variation and short order time of our products and services.

 

   

We may not be able to properly respond to market trends in the industries in which we operate, including the ongoing convergence of the telecom, data and media industries, which may harm our market position relative to our competitors.

 

   

Our business depends upon the continued growth of mobile communications and the acceptance of new services. If growth slows or new services do not succeed, operators’ investment in networks may slow or stop, harming our business.

 

   

We face intense competition from our existing competitors as well as new entrants, including IT companies entering the telecommunications market, and this could materially adversely affect our results.

 

   

Vendor consolidation may lead to stronger competitors who are able to benefit from integration, scale and greater resources.

 

   

A significant portion of our revenue is currently generated from a limited number of key customers, and operator consolidation may increase our dependence on key customers.

 

   

Certain long-term agreements with customers still include commitments to future price reductions, requiring us to constantly manage and control our cost base.

 

   

Growth of our managed services business is difficult to predict, and requires taking significant contractual risks.

 

   

We depend upon the development of new products and enhancements to our existing products, and the success of our substantial research and development investments is uncertain.

 

   

We engage in acquisitions and divestments which may be disruptive and require us to incur significant expenses.

 

   

We are in, and may enter into new JV arrangements and have, and may have new, partnerships which may not be successful and expose us to future costs.

 

   

We rely on a limited number of suppliers of components, production capacity and R&D and IT services, which exposes us to supply disruptions and cost increases.

 

   

Product or service quality issues could lead to reduced revenue and gross margins and declining sales to existing and new customers.

 

   

Due to having a significant portion of our costs in SEK and revenues in other currencies, our business is exposed to foreign exchange fluctuations that could negatively impact our revenues and operating results.

 

   

Our ability to benefit from intellectual property rights (IPR) which are critical to our business may be limited by changes in regulation limiting patents, inability to prevent infringement, the loss of licenses from third parties, infringement claims brought against us by competitors and others and changes in the area of open standards, especially in light of recent attention on licensing of open standard patents.

 

   

We are involved in lawsuits and investigations which, if determined against us, could require us to pay substantial damages, fines and/or penalties.

 

   

Our operations are complex and several critical operations are centralized in a single location. Any disruption of our operations, whether due to natural or man-made events, may be highly damaging to the operation of our business.

 

102


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

   

Cyber security incidents affecting our business may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, reputation and brand.

 

   

We must continue to attract and retain highly qualified employees to remain competitive.

 

   

If our customers’ financial conditions decline, we will be exposed to increased credit and commercial risks.

 

   

We rely on various capital sources for short-term and long-term capital for the funding of our business. Should such capital become unavailable or available in insufficient amounts or unreasonable terms, our business, financial condition and cashflow may materially suffer.

 

   

Impairment of goodwill may negatively impact financial condition.

 

   

Our business may suffer as a result of changes in laws or regulations which could subject us to liability, increase costs, or reduce product demand.

 

   

Our substantial international operations are subject to uncertainties which could affect our operating results.

 

   

We may fail to comply with our corporate governance standards which could negatively affect our business, operating results, financial condition, reputation and our brand.

 

   

Failure to comply with environmental, health and safety regulations in many jurisdictions may expose us to significant penalties and other sanctions.

 

   

Potential health risks related to electromagnetic fields may subject us to various product liability claims and result in regulatory changes.

 

   

Regulations related to “conflict minerals” may cause us to incur additional expenses, and may make our supply chain more complex

 

   

Our share price has been and may continue to be volatile, especially as technology companies, securities and markets as a whole remain volatile.

 

   

Currency fluctuations may adversely affect share value or value of dividends.

Certain of these risks and uncertainties are described further in “Risk factors.” We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements included in this Annual Report, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as required by applicable law or stock exchange regulation.

 

103


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REPORT 2013

Corporate governance describes how rights and responsibilities are distributed among corporate bodies according to applicable laws, rules and internal processes. Corporate governance also defines the decision-making systems and structure through which owners directly or indirectly control a company.

“Building trust, both within an organization and in relation to external stakeholders, is a key factor for successful business operations. Good corporate governance forms the basis for building a robust corporate culture throughout a global organization. Ericsson’s corporate governance work focuses both on establishing efficient and reliable controls and procedures and on establishing a global business culture where business is conducted with integrity, applying Ericsson’s core values: professionalism, respect and perseverence.

One of the Board of Directors’ tasks is to support Group management and to exercise critical review of its work. As Chairman of the Board, I therefore work to enable an open and meaningful dialogue between the Board and the Group management. I believe that this dialogue is crucial to allow the Board to adequately set Ericsson’s strategy and to add value to and exercise due control of Ericsson’s business operations.

I am confident that the continuous corporate governance focus within Ericsson builds trust, which in turn generates shareholder value.”

Leif Johansson

Chairman of the Board of Directors

This Corporate Governance Report is rendered as a separate report added to the Annual Report in accordance with the Annual Accounts Act ((SFS 1995:1554) Chapter 6, Sections 6 and 8) and the Swedish Corporate Governance Code.

The report has been reviewed by Ericsson’s auditor in accordance with the Annual Accounts Act. A report from the auditor is appended hereto.

 

LOGO

 

104


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

REGULATION AND COMPLIANCE

External rules

As a Swedish public limited liability company with securities quoted on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm as well as on NASDAQ New York, Ericsson is subject to a variety of rules that affect its governance. Major external rules include:

 

   

The Swedish Companies Act

 

   

The Rule Book for issuers of NASDAQ OMX Stockholm

 

   

The Swedish Corporate Governance Code (the “Code”)

 

   

NASDAQ Stock Market Rules, including applicable NASDAQ New York corporate governance requirements (subject to certain exemptions principally reflecting mandatory Swedish legal requirements)

 

   

Applicable requirements of the US Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”).

Internal rules

In addition, to ensure compliance with legal and regulatory requirements and the high standards that we set for ourselves, Ericsson has adopted internal rules that include:

 

   

A Code of Business Ethics

 

   

Group Steering Documents, including Group policies and directives, instructions and business processes for approval, control and risk management

 

   

A Code of Conduct, to be applied in product development, production, supply and support of Ericsson products and services worldwide.

The articles of association and the work procedure for the Board of Directors also include internal corporate governance rules.

Compliance with the Swedish Corporate Governance Code

Ericsson is committed to complying with best-practice corporate governance on a global level wherever possible. This includes continued compliance with the Code. Ericsson does not report any deviations from the rules of the Code in 2013. The Code is published on the website of the Swedish Corporate Governance Board which administrates the Code: www.corporategovernanceboard.se.

Compliance with applicable stock exchange rules

In 2013, there has been no infringement of applicable stock exchange rules and no breach of good practice on the securities market reported by the stock exchange’s disciplinary committee or the Swedish Securities Council.

Code of Business Ethics

Ericsson’s Code of Business Ethics summarizes the Group’s basic policies and directives and contains rules to ensure that business is conducted with a strong sense of integrity. This is critical to maintain trust and credibility with Ericsson’s customers, partners, employees, shareholders and other stakeholders.

The Code of Business Ethics has been translated into 30 languages. This ensures that it is accessible to everyone working for Ericsson. During recruitment, employees acknowledge that they are aware of the principles of the Code of Business Ethics. This procedure is repeated during the term of employment. Through this process, Ericsson strives to raise awareness throughout its global operations.

Everyone working for Ericsson has an individual responsibility to ensure that business practices adhere to the Code of Business Ethics.

GOVERNANCE STRUCTURE

Shareholders may exercise their decision-making rights in the Company at General Meetings of shareholders.

A Nomination Committee is appointed each year by the major shareholders in accordance with the Instruction for the Nomination Commit-tee adopted by the Annual General Meeting of shareholders. The tasks of the Nomination Committee include the proposal of an external auditor and Board members for election by the Annual General Meeting of shareholders and proposals of Board member and auditor remuneration.

In addition to the Board members elected by shareholders, the Board of Directors consists of employee representatives and their deputies, which the unions have the right to appoint under Swedish law. The Board of Directors is ultimately responsible for the strategy and the organization of Ericsson and the management of its operations.

The President and CEO, appointed by the Board of Directors, is responsible for handling the day-to-day management of Ericsson in accordance with instructions from the Board. The President and CEO is supported by the Executive Leadership Team (ELT).

The external auditor of Ericsson is elected by the General Meeting of shareholders.

 

LOGO

SHAREHOLDERS

Ownership structure

As of December 31, 2013, Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (the “Parent Company”) had 516,922 registered shareholders, of which 503,668 were resident or located in Sweden (according to the share register kept by Euroclear Sweden AB). Swedish institutions held almost 57% of the votes. The largest shareholders as of December 31, 2013 were Investor AB, with 21.50% of the votes, and AB Industrivärden, with 19.96% of the votes

 

105


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

(together with Svenska Handelsbankens Pensionsstiftelse and Pensionskassan SHB Försäkringsförening).

A significant number of the shares held by foreign investors are nominee-registered, i.e. held off-record by banks, brokers and/or nominees. This means that the actual shareholder is not displayed in the share register or included in the shareholding statistics.

More information on Ericsson’s shareholders can be found in the chapter “Share Information” in the Annual Report.

 

LOGO

Shares and voting rights

The share capital of the Parent Company consists of two classes of listed shares: A and B shares. Each Class A share carries one vote and each Class B share carries one tenth of one vote. Class A and B shares entitle the holder to the same proportion of assets and earnings and carry equal rights to dividends.

The Parent Company may also issue Class C shares, which shares are used to create treasury stock to finance and hedge long-term variable remuneration programs resolved by the General Meeting of shareholders. Class C shares are converted into Class B shares before they are used for long-term variable remuneration programs.

In the United States, the Ericsson Class B share is listed on NASDAQ New York in the form of American Depositary Shares (ADS) evidenced by American Depositary Receipts (ADR). Each ADS represents one Class B share.

The members of the Board of Directors and the Executive Leadership Team have the same voting rights on shares as other shareholders holding the same class of shares.

GENERAL MEETINGS OF SHAREHOLDERS

Decision-making at General Meetings

The decision-making rights of Ericsson’s shareholders are exercised at General Meetings of shareholders. Most resolutions at General Meetings are passed by a simple majority. However, the Swedish Companies Act requires qualified majorities in certain cases, for example in case of:

 

   

Amendment of the Articles of Association

 

   

Resolution to transfer treasury stock to employees participating in long-term variable remuneration programs.

The Annual General Meeting of shareholders

The Annual General Meeting of shareholders (AGM) is held in Stockholm. The date and venue for the meeting is announced on the Ericsson website no later than at the time of release of the third-quarter interim financial report.

Shareholders who cannot participate in person may be represented by proxy. Only shareholders registered in the share register have voting rights. Nominee-registered shareholders who wish to vote must request to be entered into the share register by the record date for the AGM.

The AGM is held in Swedish and is simultaneously interpreted into English. All documentation provided by the Company is available in both Swedish and English.

The AGM gives shareholders the opportunity to raise questions relating to the operations of the Group. Normally, the majority of the members of the Board of Directors and the Executive Leadership Team is present to answer such questions. Shareholders and other interested parties may also correspond in writing with the Company at any time.

The external auditor is always present at the AGM.

Ericsson’s Annual General Meeting 2013

Including shareholders represented by proxy, 2,885 shareholders were represented at the AGM held on April 9, 2013, making up approximately 69% of the votes.

The meeting was also attended by members of the Board of Directors, members of the Executive Leadership Team (ELT) and the external auditor.

Decisions of the AGM 2013 included:

 

   

Payment of a dividend of SEK 2.75 per share

 

   

Re-election of Leif Johansson as Chairman of the Board of Directors

 

   

Re-election of members of the Board of Directors: Roxanne S. Austin, Sir Peter L. Bonfield, Börje Ekholm, Alexander Izosimov, Ulf J. Johansson, Sverker Martin-Löf, Hans Vestberg and Jacob Wallenberg

 

   

Election of Nora Denzel, Kristin Skogen Lund and Pär Östberg as new members of the Board of Directors

 

   

Board of Directors’ fees:

 

   

Chairman: SEK 3,850,000 (previously SEK 3,750,000)

 

   

Other non-employee Board members: SEK 900,000 each (previously SEK 875,000)

 

   

Chairman of the Audit Committee: SEK 350,000 (unchanged)

 

106


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

   

Other non-employee members of the Audit Committee: SEK 250,000 each (unchanged)

 

   

Chairmen of the Finance and Remuneration Committees: SEK 200,000 each (unchanged)

 

   

Other non-employee members of the Finance and Remuneration Committees: SEK 175,000 each (unchanged)

 

   

Approval for part of the Directors’ fees to be paid in the form of synthetic shares

 

   

Approval of Guidelines for remuneration to Group Management

 

   

Implementation of a Long-Term Variable Remuneration Program 2013.

The minutes from the AGM 2013 are available on Ericsson’s website.

CONTACT THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson

The Board of Directors Secretariat

SE-164 83 Stockholm

Sweden

boardsecretariat@ericsson.com

CONTACT THE NOMINATION COMMITTEE

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson

The Nomination Committee

c/o General Counsel’s Office

SE-164 83 Stockholm

Sweden

nomination.committee@ericsson.com

ANNUAL GENERAL MEETING 2014

Ericsson’s AGM 2014 will take place on April 11, 2014 at Stockholm Waterfront Congress Centre in Stockholm. Further information is available on Ericsson’s website.

PROPOSALS TO THE NOMINATION COMMITTEE

Shareholders may submit proposals to the Nomination Committee at any time, but should do so in due time before the AGM to ensure that the proposals can be considered by the Committee. Further information is available on Ericsson’s website.

NOMINATION COMMITTEE

The Annual General Meeting of shareholders has adopted an Instruction for the Nomination Committee that includes the tasks of the Nomination Committee and the procedure for appointing its members. The instruction applies until the General Meeting of shareholders resolve otherwise. Under the instruction, the Nomination Committee shall consist of:

 

   

Representatives of the four largest shareholders by voting power by the end of the month in which the AGM was held, and

 

   

The Chairman of the Board of Directors.

The Committee may also include additional members following a request by a shareholder. The request must be justified by changes in the shareholder’s ownership of shares and be received by the Nomination Committee no later than December 31. No fees are paid to the members of the Nomination Committee.

Members of the Nomination Committee

The current Nomination Committee consists of the Chairman of the Board of Directors, Leif Johansson, and of representatives appointed by the four shareholders with the largest voting power as of April 30, 2013. The current Nomination Committee members are:

 

   

Carl-Olof By (AB Industrivärden, Svenska Handelsbankens Pensionsstiftelse), Chairman of the Nomination Committee

 

   

Leif Johansson, Chairman of the Board of Directors

 

   

Petra Hedengran (Investor AB)

 

   

Johan Held (AFA Försäkring)

 

   

Marianne Nilsson (Swedbank Robur Fonder).

The tasks of the Nomination Committee

The main task of the Committee is to propose Board members for election by the AGM. The Committee must orient itself on the Company’s strategy and future challenges to be able to assess the competence and experience that is required by the Board. In addition, the Committee must consider independence rules applicable to the Board of Directors and its committees.

The Nomination Committee also makes the following proposals, for resolution by the AGM:

 

   

Proposal for remuneration to non-employee Directors elected by the AGM and remuneration to the auditor

 

   

Proposal for election of auditor, whereby candidates are selected in cooperation with the Audit Committee of the Board

 

   

Proposal for election of Chairman at the AGM.

Work of the Nomination Committee for the AGM 2014

The Nomination Committee started its work by going through a checklist of all its duties according to the Code and the Instruction for the Nomination Committee and by setting a time plan for its work ahead. A good understanding of Ericsson’s business and strategy is important for the members of the Committee. Therefore, the President and CEO was invited to, together with the Chairman of the Board, present their views on the Company’s position and strategy.

The Committee was thoroughly informed of the results of the evaluation of the Board work and procedures, including the performance of the Chairman of the Board. On this basis, the Committee was able to assess the competence and experience required by Board members. In proposing Board members, the Nomination Committee considered, among other things, necessary experience and competence, as well as the value of diversity, renewal and gender balance. The Committee also considered whether the proposed Directors have the capability to devote necessary time and care to the Board work.

In addition, the Committee acquainted itself with the assessments made by the Company and the Audit Committee of the quality and efficiency of external auditor work, and received recommendations on external auditor and audit fees.

As of March 5, 2014 the Nomination Committee has held six meetings.

 

107


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

BOARD OF DIRECTORS

The Board of Directors is ultimately responsible for the organization of Ericsson and the management of Ericsson’s operations. The Board appoints the President and CEO who is responsible for managing the day-to-day operations in accordance with guidelines from the Board. The President and CEO ensures that the Board is updated regularly on issues of importance to Ericsson. This includes updates on business development, results, financial position and liquidity.

Directors serve from the close of one AGM to the close of the next, but can serve any number of consecutive terms.

The President and CEO may be elected a Director of the Board, but, under the Swedish Companies Act, the President of a public company may not be elected Chairman of the Board.

Conflicts of interest

Ericsson maintains rules and regulations regarding conflicts of interest. Directors are disqualified from participating in any decision regarding agreements between themselves and Ericsson. The same applies to agreements between Ericsson and any third party or legal entity in which the Board member has an interest that may be contrary to the interests of Ericsson.

The Audit Committee has implemented a procedure for related-party transactions and a pre-approval process for non-audit services carried out by the external auditor.

Composition of the Board of Directors

The current Board of Directors consists of 12 Directors elected by the shareholders at the AGM 2013 for the period until the close of the AGM 2014. It also consists of three employee representatives, each with a deputy, appointed by the trade unions for the same period of time. The President and CEO, Hans Vestberg, is the only Board member who was also a member of Ericsson’s management during 2013.

Work procedure

Pursuant to the Swedish Companies Act, the Board of Directors has adopted a work procedure that outlines rules for the distribution of tasks between the Board and its Committees as well as between the Board, its Committees and the President and CEO. This complements rules in the Swedish Companies Act and in the Articles of Association of the Company. The work procedure is reviewed, evaluated and adopted by the Board as required and at least once a year.

Independence

The Board of Directors and its Committees are subject to a variety of independence rules under applicable Swedish law, the Code and applicable US securities laws, SEC rules and the NASDAQ Stock Market Rules. However, Ericsson can rely on exemptions from certain US requirements.

The composition of the Board of Directors meets all applicable independence criteria. The Nomination Committee concluded before the AGM 2013 that, for purposes of the Code, at least seven of the nominated Directors were independent of Ericsson, its senior management and its major shareholders. These were Roxanne S. Austin, Sir Peter L. Bonfield, Nora Denzel, Alexander Izosimov, Leif Johansson, Ulf J. Johansson and Kristin Skogen Lund.

Structure of the work of the Board of Directors

The work of the Board follows a yearly cycle. This enables the Board to appropriately address each of its duties and to keep strategy, risk assessment and value creation high on the agenda. In addition to Board meetings, the annual work cycle of the Board includes two Board Strategic Days held in connection with Board meetings. The Board Strategic Days are described below under Training and Board Strategic Days.

As the Board is responsible for financial oversight, financial information is presented and evaluated at each Board meeting. Furthermore, the Chairmen of each Committee, generally report on Committee work at each Board meeting and minutes from Committee meetings are distributed to all Directors prior to the Board meetings.

At every Board meeting, the President and CEO reports on business and market developments as well as on the financial performance of the Group. Strategic issues and risks are also addressed at most Board meetings. The Board is regularly informed of developments in legal and regulatory matters of importance.

The annual work cycle of the Board:

 

   

Statutory meeting

The yearly cycle starts with the statutory Board meeting which is held in connection with the AGM. At this meeting, members of each of the three Board Committees are appointed and the Board resolves on signatory power.

 

   

First interim report meeting

At the next ordinary meeting, the Board handles the interim financial report for the first quarter of the year.

 

   

Main strategy meeting

Various strategic issues are addressed at most Board meetings and, in accordance with the annual cycle for the strategy process, a main strategy Board meeting is held, in essence dedicated to short- and long-term strategies of the Group. Following the Board’s input on, and approval of, the

 

108


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

overall strategy, the strategy is cascaded throughout the entire organization, starting at the Global Leadership Summit with Ericsson’s top 250 leaders.

 

   

Second interim report meeting

At the second interim report meeting, the Board handles the interim financial report for the second quarter of the year.

 

   

Follow-up strategy and risk management meeting

Following the summer, a meeting is held to address particular strategy matters in further detail and to finally confirm the Group strategy. The meeting also addresses the overall risk management of the Group.

 

   

Board Strategic Day

A Board Strategic Day, focusing on deepening Board member knowledge of matters of strategic importance for Ericsson, is held in connection with a Board meeting in the fall.

 

   

Third interim report meeting

A Board meeting is held to handle the interim financial report for the third quarter of the year. At this meeting, the results of the Board evaluation are presented to and discussed by the Board.

 

   

Budget and financial outlook meeting

A meeting is held for the Board to address the budget and financial outlook as well as to further analyze internal and external risks.

 

   

Fourth-quarter and full-year financial results meeting

Following the end of the calendar year, the Board holds a meeting which focuses on the financial results of the entire year and handles the fourth-quarter financial report.

 

   

Board Strategic Day

A Board Strategic Day, focusing on deepening Board member knowledge of matters of strategic importance for Ericsson, is held in connection with a Board meeting in the spring.

 

   

Annual Report meeting

The Annual Report meeting closes the yearly cycle of work of the Board of Directors. At this meeting the Board approves the Annual Report.

The Board’s annual work cycle

The annual cycle applied to the Board’s work allows the Board to appropriately address its duties during the year. It also facilitates the organization in aligning its global processes to allow appropriate Board involvement. This is particularly relevant for the Group’s strategy process and risk management.

 

LOGO

Training and Board Strategic Days

All new Directors receive comprehensive training tailored to their individual needs. Introductory training typically includes meetings with the heads of the business units and Group functions, as well as training arranged by NASDAQ OMX Stockholm on listing issues and insider rules. In addition, the company arranges training for Board members at regular intervals.

During 2013, Ericsson took steps to further improve the recurring Board training by instituting bi-annual Board Strategic Days. The Board Strategic Days are arranged for Board members in conjunction with the ordinary Board meetings, and normally span one full day in the spring and one full day in the fall. The Board Strategic Days focus on combining strategy issues with making deep dives into issues of importance for the Ericsson Group. The purpose of the Board Strategic Days is to ensure that members of the Board have knowledge and understanding of the business activities of the Group, the business environment and of the Group’s strategic options and challenges. Directors’ knowledge in these fields is crucial to allow well-founded Board resolutions, and to ensure that the Company take due advantage of the different compentences of the Directors.

As a rule, the Board Strategic Days also include Sustainability and Corporate Responsibility training for the Board members.

Auditor involvement

The Board meets with Ericsson’s external auditor in closed sessions at least once a year to receive and consider the auditor’s observations. The auditor reports to management on the accounting and financial reporting practices of the Group.

 

 

109


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

The Audit Committee also meets with the auditor to receive and consider observations on the interim reports and the Annual Report. The auditor has been instructed to report on whether the accounts, the management of funds and the general financial position of the Group are presented fairly in all material respects.

In addition, the Board reviews and assesses the process for financial reporting, as described later in “Internal control over financial reporting 2013”. Combined with internal controls, the Board’s and the auditor’s review of interim and annual reports are deemed to give reasonable assurance on the internal controls over financial reporting.

Work of the Board of Directors in 2013

In 2013, nine Board meetings were held. For attendance at Board meetings, see the table on page 113. Among the matters addressed by the Board this year (apart from regular matters in the annual Board work cycle) were:

 

   

A number of acquisitions, including the Devoteam Telecom & Media operations in France, Microsoft Mediaroom, TelcoCell, Red Bee Media (the completion of the acquisition of Red Bee Media is still subject to approval by the UK Competition Commission after referral to the Competition Commission by The Office of Fair Trading in the UK) and the EVDO business of Airvana Network Solutions

 

   

Completion of the transaction to split up the joint venture ST-Ericsson

 

   

Refinancing of Ericsson’s USD 2 billion revolving credit facility

 

   

A number of divestments, including the power cable operations and part of the telecom cable operations, and the former research and engineering arm of Telcordia Technologies, ACS (Applied Communication Sciences)

 

   

Continued strong focus on risk management, strategy and the competitive market development, as well as on sustainability and corporate responsibility matters.

Board work evaluation

A key objective of the Board evaluation is to ensure that the Board work is functioning well. This includes gaining an understanding of the issues that the Board thinks warrant greater focus, as well as determining areas where additional competence is needed within the Board. The evaluation also serves as guidance for the work of the Nomination Committee.

Each year, the Chairman of the Board initiates and leads the evaluation of the Board and Committee work and procedures. Evaluation tools include detailed questionnaires and discussions. The services of an external corporate advisory firm have been retained by the Company to assist in developing questionnaires, carrying out surveys and summarizing responses. As part of the evaluation process, the Chairman of the Board also had individual discussions with each of the Directors.

In 2013, all Directors responded to written questionnaires, covering the Director’s individual performance, Board work in general, Committee work and the Chairman’s performance. The Chairman was not involved in the development or compilation of the questionnaire which related to his performance, nor was he present when his performance was evaluated. The evaluations were thoroughly discussed and an action plan was developed in order to further improve the work of the Board.

COMMITTEES OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS

The Board of Directors has established three Committees: the Audit Committee, the Finance Committee and the Remuneration Committee. Members of each Committee are appointed for one year from amongst the Board members.

The task of the Committees is mainly to prepare matters for resolution by the Board. However, the Board has authorized each Committee to determine certain issues in limited

 

110


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

areas. It may also on occasion provide extended authorization for the Committees to determine specific matters.

If deemed appropriate, the Board of Directors and each Committee have the right to engage independent external expertise, either in general or with respect to specific matters.

 

LOGO

Prior to the Board meetings, each Committee submits the minutes from Committee meetings to the Board. The Chairman of the Committee also reports on the Committee work at each Board meeting.

Audit Committee

On behalf of the Board, the Audit Committee monitors the following:

 

   

The scope and correctness of the financial statements

 

   

Compliance with legal and regulatory requirements

 

   

Internal control over financial reporting

 

   

Risk management

 

   

The effectiveness and appropriateness of the Group’s anti-corruption program.

The Audit Committee also reviews the annual and interim financial reports and oversees the external audit process, including audit fees. This involves:

 

   

Reviewing, with management and the external auditor, the financial statements (including their conformity with generally accepted accounting principles)

 

   

Reviewing, with management, the reasonableness of significant estimates and judgments made in preparing the financial statements, as well as the quality of the disclosures in the financial statements

 

   

Reviewing matters arising from reviews and audits performed.

The Audit Committee itself does not perform audit work. Ericsson has an internal audit function which reports directly to the Audit Committee. Ericsson also has an external auditor elected by the AGM.

The Committee is involved in the preparatory work of proposing an auditor for election by the AGM. It also monitors Group transactions and the ongoing performance and independence of the auditor with the aim to avoid conflicts of interest.

In order to ensure the auditor’s independence, the Audit Committee has established pre-approval policies and procedures for non-audit related services to be performed by the external auditor. Pre-approval authority may not be delegated to management. The Audit Committee also oversees:

 

   

The process for reviewing transactions with related parties

 

   

The whistleblower procedure for the reporting of alleged violations of laws or the Code of Business Ethics that (i) are conducted by Group or local management, and (ii) relate to corruption, questionable accounting or auditing matters or otherwise seriously affect vital interests of the Group or personal health and safety.

Violations reported through the whistleblower procedure are handled by Ericsson’s Group Compliance Forum, consisting of representatives from Ericsson’s internal audit function, Group Function Legal Affairs, Group Security, and Group Function Human Resources. Information regarding any incident is reported to the Audit Committee. Reports include measures taken, details of the responsible Group function and the status of any investigation.

 

LOGO

Members of the Audit Committee

The Audit Committee consists of four Board members appointed by the Board. The Audit Committee members appointed by the Board in connection with the AGM 2013 are Ulf J. Johansson (Chairman of the Committee), Sir Peter L. Bonfield, Kristina Davidsson and Pär Östberg.

The composition of the Audit Committee meets all applicable independence requirements. The Board of Directors has determined that each of Ulf J. Johansson, Sir Peter L. Bonfield and Pär Östberg is an audit committee financial expert, as defined under the SEC rules. Each of them is considered

 

111


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

independent under applicable US securities laws, SEC rules and NASDAQ Stock Market Rules and each of them is financially literate and familiar with the accounting practices of an international company, such as Ericsson.

Work of the Audit Committee in 2013

The Audit Committee held seven meetings in 2013. Directors’ attendance is reflected in the table on page 113. During the year, the Audit Committee reviewed the scope and results of external financial audits and the independence of the external auditor. It also monitored the external audit fees and approved non-audit services performed by the external auditor in accordance with the Committee’s pre-approval policies and procedures.

The Committee approved the annual audit plan for the internal audit function and reviewed its reports. Prior to publishing it, the Committee also reviewed and discussed each interim report and the annual report with the external auditor.

The Committee monitored the continued compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act as well as the internal control and risk management process. It also reviewed certain related-party transactions in accordance with its established process.

The Committee reviewed and evaluated the effectiveness and appropriateness of the Group’s anti-corruption program.

Finance Committee

The Finance Committee is primarily responsible for:

 

   

Handling matters related to acquisitions and divestments

 

   

Handling capital contributions to companies inside and outside the Ericsson Group

 

   

Raising loans, issuing guarantees and similar undertakings, and approving financial support to customers and suppliers

 

   

Continuously monitoring the Group’s financial risk exposure.

The Finance Committee is authorized to determine matters such as:

 

   

Direct or indirect financing

 

   

Provision of credits

 

   

Granting of guarantees and similar undertakings

 

   

Certain investments, divestments and financial commitments.

Members of the Finance Committee

The Finance Committee consists of four Board members appointed by the Board. The Finance Committee members appointed by the Board in connection with the AGM 2013 are: Leif Johansson (Chairman of the Committee), Pehr Claesson, Sverker Martin-Löf and Jacob Wallenberg.

Work of the Finance Committee in 2013

The Finance Committee held nine meetings in 2013. Directors’ attendance is reflected in the table on page 113. During the year, the Finance Committee approved numerous customer finance credit arrangements and reviewed a number of potential mergers and acquisitions and real estate investments. The Finance Committee spent significant time discussing and securing an adequate capital structure, as well as examining cash flow and working capital performance. It has also continuously monitored Ericsson’s financial position, foreign exchange and credit exposures.

Remuneration Committee

The Remuneration Committee’s main responsibilities include:

 

   

Reviewing and preparing for resolution by the Board, proposals on salary and other remuneration, including retirement compensation, for the President and CEO

 

   

Reviewing and preparing for resolution by the Board, proposals to the AGM on guidelines for remuneration to the ELT

 

   

Approving proposals on salary and other remuneration, including retirement compensation, for the Executive Vice Presidents and other CEO direct reports

 

   

Reviewing and preparing for resolution by the Board, proposals to the AGM on the Long-Term Variable Remuneration Program and similar equity arrangements.

In its work, the Remuneration Committee considers trends in remuneration, legislative changes, disclosure rules and the general global executive remuneration environment. The Committee reviews salary survey data before approving any salary adjustment for CEO direct reports and before preparing salary adjustments for the President and CEO for resolution by the Board.

Members of the Remuneration Committee

The Remuneration Committee consists of four Board members appointed by the Board. The Remuneration Committee members appointed by the Board in connection with the AGM 2013 are: Leif Johansson (Chairman of the Committee), Börje Ekholm, Roxanne S. Austin and Karin Åberg.

An independent expert advisor, Piia Pilv, has been appointed by the Remuneration Committee to advise and assist the Committee.

Work of the Remuneration Committee in 2013

The Remuneration Committee held six meetings in 2013. Directors’ attendance is reflected in the table on page 113.

The Committee reviewed and prepared a proposal for the LTV 2013 for resolution by the Board. This was approved by the AGM 2013. The Committee further resolved on salaries and

 

112


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Short-Term Variable remuneration (STV) for 2013 for certain CEO direct reports and prepared proposals regarding remuneration to the President and CEO, for resolution by the Board. The Committee also prepared guidelines for remuneration to the ELT, for resolution by the Board, which were subsequently referred by the Board to the AGM for approval.

The Remuneration Committee additionally concluded its analysis of the current LTV structure and executive remuneration. The resulting proposals on LTV and guidelines for remuneration to the ELT will be referred to the AGM 2014 for resolution.

For further information on fixed and variable remuneration, please see Notes to the consolidated financial statements—Note C28 “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees” and the “Remuneration Report” included in the Annual Report.

Directors’ attendance and fees 2013

 

     Fees resolved by the
AGM 2013
     Number of Board/Committee
meetings attended in 2013
 

Board member

   Board
fees, SEK 1)
    Committee
fees, SEK
     Board      Audit
Committee
     Finance
Committee
     Remuneration
Committee
 

Leif Johansson

     3,850,000        400,000         9            9         6   

Sverker Martin-Löf2)3)

     900,000        175,000         9         2         7      

Jacob Wallenberg

     900,000        175,000         9            9      

Roxanne S. Austin4)

     900,000        175,000         9               5   

Sir Peter L. Bonfield

     900,000        250,000         8         6         

Nora Denzel5)

     900,000           7            

Börje Ekholm

     900,000        175,000         9               6   

Alexander Izosimov

     900,000           9            

Ulf J. Johansson

     900,000        350,000         9         7         

Anders Nyrén6)

     —             2            2      

Nancy McKinstry6)

     —             2               1   

Kristin Skogen Lund5)

     900,000           7            

Hans Vestberg

     —             9            

Michelangelo Volpi6)

     —             1            

Pär Östberg5)7)

     900,000        250,000         7         5         

Pehr Claesson

     13,500 8)         9            9      

Kristina Davidsson

     13,500 8)         9         7         

Karin Åberg

     12,000 8)         8               6   

Rickard Fredriksson

     13,500 8)         9            

Karin Lennartsson

     13,500 8)         9            

Roger Svensson

     13,500 8)         9            
       

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total number of meetings

          9         7         9         6   
       

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Non-employee Directors can choose to receive part of their Board fee (exclusive of Committee fees) in the form of synthetic shares.
2) Member of the Finance Committee since April 9, 2013.
3) Resigned from the Audit Committee as of April 9, 2013.
4) Member of the Remuneration Committee since April 9, 2013.
5) Elected Board member as of April 9, 2013.
6) Resigned as Board member as of April 9, 2013.
7) Member of the Audit Committee since April 9, 2013.
8) Employee representative Board members and their deputies are not entitled to a Board fee but compensation in the amount of SEK 1,500 per attended Board meeting.

REMUNERATION TO BOARD MEMBERS

Remuneration to Board members not employed by the Company is proposed by the Nomination Committee for resolution by the AGM.

The AGM 2013 approved the Nomination Committee’s proposal for fees to the non-employee Board members for Board and Committee work. For further information on Board of Directors’ fees 2013, please refer to Notes to the consolidated financial statements—Note C28 “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees” in the Annual Report.

The AGM 2013 also approved the Nomination Committee’s proposal that Board members may be paid part of their Board fee in the form of synthetic shares.

A synthetic share gives the right to receive a future cash payment of an amount which corresponds to the market value of a Class B share in Ericsson at the time of payment. The Director’s right to receive payment with regard to allocated synthetic shares occurs, as a main rule, after the publication of the Company’s year-end financial statement during the fifth year following the General Meeting that resolved on the allocation of the synthetic shares. The purpose of paying part of the Board of Directors’ fee in the form of synthetic shares is to further align the Directors’ interests with shareholder interests. For more information on the terms and conditions of the synthetic shares, please refer to the notice convening the AGM 2013 and to the minutes from the AGM 2013, which are available at Ericsson’s website.

 

113


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

MEMBERS OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS

Board members elected by the AGM 2013

 

LOGO

Leif Johansson (first elected 2011)

Chairman of the Board of Directors, Chairman of the Remuneration Committee and of the Finance Committee

Born 1951. Master of Science in Engineering, Chalmers University of Technology, Gothenburg, Sweden.

Board Chairman: Astra Zeneca PLC, European Round Table of Industrialists and the International Advisory Board of the Nobel Foundation.

Board Member: Svenska Cellulosa Aktiebolaget SCA and Ecolean AB.

Holdings in Ericsson: 41,933 Class B shares1), and 12,000 Class B shares held via endowment insurance2) .

Principal work experience and other information: President of the Royal Swedish Academy of Engineering Sciences since 2012. President and CEO of AB Volvo 1997–2011. Executive Vice President of AB Electrolux 1988–1991, President 1991–1994 and President and CEO of AB Electrolux 1994–1997. Holds honorary Doctorates at Blekinge Institute of Technology, the University of Gothenburg and Chalmers University of Technology. Awarded the Large Gold Medal of the Royal Swedish Academy of Engineering Sciences in 2011.

 

LOGO

Sverker Martin-Löf (first elected 1993)

Deputy Chairman of the Board of Directors, Member of the Finance Committee

Born 1943. Doctor of Technology and Master of Engineering, KTH Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, Sweden.

Board Chairman: Svenska Cellulosa Aktiebolaget SCA, SSAB and AB Industrivärden.

Deputy Board Chairman: Svenska Handelsbanken AB.

Board Member: Skanska AB.

Holdings in Ericsson: 10,400 Class B shares1)

Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Svenska Cellulosa Aktiebolaget SCA 1990–2002, where he was employed 1977–1983 and 1986–2002. Previous positions at Sunds Defibrator and Mo och Domsjö AB.

 

LOGO

Jacob Wallenberg (first elected 2011)

Deputy Chairman of the Board of Directors, Member of the Finance Committee

Born 1956. Bachelor of Science in Economics and Master of Business Administration, Wharton School, University of Pennsylvania, USA. Officer of the Reserve, Swedish Navy.

Board Chairman: Investor AB.

Deputy Board Chairman: SAS AB and SEB Skandinaviska Enskilda Banken AB (SEB).

Board Member: ABB Ltd, The Coca-Cola Company, The Knut and Alice Wallenberg Foundation and Stockholm School of Economics.

Holdings in Ericsson: 2,413 Class B shares1), and 12,050 synthetic shares3) .

Principal work experience and other information: Chairman of the Board of Investor AB since 2005. President and CEO of SEB in 1997 and Chairman of SEB’s Board of Directors 1998–2005. Executive Vice President and CFO of Investor AB 1990–1993. Honorary Chairman of IBLAC (Mayor of Shanghai’s International Business Leaders Advisory Council) and member of The European Round Table of Industrialists.

 

LOGO

Roxanne S. Austin (first elected 2008)

Member of the Remuneration Committee

Born 1961. Bachelor of Business Administration in Accounting, University of Texas, San Antonio, USA.

Board Member: Abbott Laboratories, AbbVie Inc., Teledyne Technologies Inc. and Target Corporation.

Holdings in Ericsson: 3,000 Class B shares1), and 31,296 synthetic shares3).

Principal work experience and other information: President of Austin Investment Advisors since 2004. President and CEO of Move Networks Inc. 2009–2010. President and COO of DirecTV 2001–2003. Corporate Senior Vice President and CFO of Hughes Electronics Corporation 1997–2000, which she joined in 1993. Previously a partner at Deloitte & Touche. Member of the California State Society of Certified Public Accountants and the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants.

The Board memberships and holdings in Ericsson reported above are as of December 31, 2013.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related natural and legal persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.
2) Shares held via endowment insurance include shares held under an insurance under which the insurance holder may make investment decisions with respect to the shares (Sw: “kapitalförsäkring” or “depĺförsäkring”) and include holdings by related natural and legal persons, as well as holdings of ADS, if applicable.
3) Since 2008, the AGM has each year resolved that part of the Board fee may be received in the form of synthetic shares. A synthetic share is a right to receive in the future a payment corresponding to the value of the Class B share in Ericsson at the time of payment. Please see page 113, for further information.

 

114


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

LOGO

Sir Peter L. Bonfield (first elected 2002)

Member of the Audit Committee

Born 1944. Honors degree in Engineering, Loughborough University, Leicestershire, UK.

Board Chairman: NXP Semiconductors N.V.

Board Member: Mentor Graphics Inc., Sony Corporation and Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Company, Ltd.

Holdings in Ericsson: 4,400 Class B shares1), and 10,660 synthetic shares3).

Principal work experience and other information: CEO and Chairman of the Executive Committee of British Telecommunications plc 1996–2002. Chairman and CEO of ICL plc 1985–1996. Positions with STC plc and Texas Instruments Inc. Member of the Advisory Boards of New Venture Partners LLP and the Longreach Group. Board Mentor of CMi. Senior Advisor, Rothschild, London. Chair of Council and Senior Pro-Chancellor, Loughborough University, UK. Fellow of the Royal Academy of Engineering.

 

LOGO

Nora Denzel (first elected 2013)

Born 1962. Master of Science in Business Administration, Santa Clara University, USA. Bachelor of Science in Computer Science, State University of New York, USA.

Board Member: Outerwall, Inc. and Saba Software.

Holdings in Ericsson: None1).

Principal work experience and other information: Intuit Software (2008–2012)–Senior Vice President Big Data, Marketing and Social Product Design and General Manager QuickBooks Payroll Division. Previous positions include Senior Vice President and General Manager of HP’s Global Software, Storage and Consulting Divisions (2000-2006), Senior Vice President Product Operations Legato Systems (bought by EMC) and various engineering, marketing and executive positions at IBM. Board member of YWCA of Silicon Valley and the Anita Borg Institute.

 

LOGO

Börje Ekholm (first elected 2006)

Member of the Remuneration Committee

Born 1963. Master of Science in Electrical Engineering, KTH Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, Sweden. Master of Business Administration, INSEAD, France.

Board Chairman: KTH Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm and NASDAQ OMX Group Inc.

Board Member: Investor AB, AB Chalmersinvest and EQT Partners AB.

Holdings in Ericsson: 30,760 Class B shares1), and 40,398 synthetic shares3).

Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Investor AB since 2005. Formerly Head of Investor Growth Capital Inc. and New Investments. Previous positions at Novare Kapital AB and McKinsey & Co Inc.

 

LOGO

Alexander Izosimov (first elected 2012)

Born 1964. Master of Business Administration, INSEAD, France and Master of Science in Production Management Systems and Computer Science, Moscow Aviation Institute, Russian Federation.

Board Member: East Capital AB, Modern Times Group MTG AB, EVRAZ Group S.A., Dynasty Foundation, Transcom WorldWide SA and International Chamber of Commerce (ICC).

Holdings in Ericsson: 1,600 Class B shares1), 50,000 Class B shares held via endowment insurance2), and 6,296 synthetic shares3).

Principal work experience and other information: CEO and President of VimpelCom 2003-2011. Previous positions with Mars Inc., including Member of the Global Executive Board and Regional President for CIS, Central Europe and Nordics. Earlier positions with McKinsey & Co as consultant in the Stockholm and London offices. Served as GSMA Board member 2005–2008 and Chairman of GSMA 2008–2010.

The Board memberships and holdings in Ericsson reported above are as of December 31, 2013.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related natural and legal persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.
2) Shares held via endowment insurance include shares held under an insurance under which the insurance holder may make investment decisions with respect to the shares (Sw: “kapitalförsäkring” or “depĺförsäkring”) and include holdings by related natural and legal persons, as well as holdings of ADS, if applicable.
3) Since 2008, the AGM has each year resolved that part of the Board fee may be received in the form of synthetic shares. A synthetic share is a right to receive in the future a payment corresponding to the value of the Class B share in Ericsson at the time of payment. Please see page 113, for further information.

 

115


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Board members elected by the AGM 2013

 

LOGO

Ulf J. Johansson (first elected 2005)

Chairman of the Audit Committee

Born 1945. Doctor of Technology and Master of Science in Electrical Engineering, KTH Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, Sweden.

Board Chairman: Acando AB, Eurostep Group AB and Trimble Navigation Ltd.

Board Member: European Institute of Innovation and Technology.

Holdings in Ericsson: 6,435 Class B shares1), and 14,720 synthetic shares2).

Principal work experience and other information: Founder of Europolitan Vodafone AB, where he was the Chairman of the Board 1990–2005. Previous positions at Spectra-Physics AB as President and CEO and at Ericsson Radio Systems AB. Member of the Royal Academy of Engineering Sciences.

 

LOGO

Kristin Skogen Lund (first elected 2013)

Born 1966. Master of Business Administration, INSEAD, France. Bachelor in International Studies and Business Administration, University of Oregon, USA.

Board Member: None

Holdings in Ericsson: 2,804 synthetic shares2).

Principal work experience and other information: Director General of the Confederation of Norwegian Enterprise (NHO) since 2012. Executive Vice President and Head of Digital Services and Broadcast and Executive Vice President and Head of Nordic Region, Group Executive Management at Telenor 2010–2012. Previous positions include Chief Executive Officer and Commercial Director at Aftenposten, Chief Executive Officer at Scanpix, Managing Director and Editor in Chief at Scandinavia Online, and several positions at the Coca-Cola Company, Unilever and Norges Eksportråd.

 

LOGO

Hans Vestberg (first elected 2010)

Born 1965. Bachelor of Business Administration and Economics, University of Uppsala, Sweden.

Board Chairman: Svenska Handbollförbundet.

Board Member: Thernlunds AB.

Holdings in Ericsson: 217,185 Class B shares1).

Principal work experience and other information: President and CEO of Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson since January 1, 2010. Previously, First Executive Vice President, CFO and Head of Group Function Finance and Executive Vice President and Head of Business Unit Global Services. Various positions in the Group since 1988, including Vice President and Head of Market Unit Mexico and Head of Finance and Control in USA, Brazil and Chile. International advisor to the Governor of Guangdong, China and co-chairman of the Russian-Swedish Business Council. Founding member of the Broadband Commission for Digital Development, and heading the Commission’s task group on the post 2015 development agenda. Member of the Leadership Council of the United Nations Sustainable Development Solutions Network.

 

LOGO

Pär Östberg (first elected 2013)

Member of the Audit Committee

Born 1962. Master of Business Administration, Gothenburg School of Economics, Gothenburg, Sweden.

Board Member: Skanska AB and SSAB.

Holdings in Ericsson: None.

Principal work experience and other information: Executive Vice President of AB Industrivärden since 2012. Executive Vice President at Volvo Group Truck Joint Ventures between January 2012 and October 2012. Several senior managerial positions within the Volvo group including Senior Vice President and President Trucks Asia at AB Volvo, Chairman of the Board of VE Commercial Vehicles Ltd, Senior Vice President and CFO at AB Volvo, CFO at Volvo Trucks France and senior positions at Volvo Treasury Asia Ltd, Singapore and Volvo Treasury Europe AB. Previous positions also include Senior Vice President, CFO at Renault Trucks and positions within Renault Crédit International (RCI) and Renault SA.

The Board memberships and holdings in Ericsson reported above are as of December 31, 2013.

 

1) The number of shares reflects ownership as of December 31, 2013 and includes holdings by related natural and legal persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.
2) Since 2008, the AGM has each year resolved that part of the Board fee may be received in the form of synthetic shares. A synthetic share is a right to receive in the future a payment corresponding to the value of the Class B share in Ericsson at the time of payment. Please see page 113, for further information.

 

116


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Board members and deputies appointed by the unions

 

LOGO

Pehr Claesson (first appointed 2008)

Employee representative, Member of the Finance Committee

Born 1966. Appointed by the union The Swedish Association of Graduate Engineers.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1,319 Class B shares1). Employed since 1997. Working with marketing and communication for Consulting and Systems Integration within Business Unit Global Services.

 

LOGO

Kristina Davidsson (first appointed 2006)

Employee representative, Member of the Audit Committee

Born 1955. Appointed by the union IF Metall.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1,856 Class B shares1). Employed since 1995. Previously working as a repairer within Business Unit Networks and currently working full time as union representative.

 

LOGO

Karin Åberg (first appointed 2007)

Employee representative, Member of the Remuneration Committee

Born 1959. Appointed by the union Unionen.

Holdings in Ericsson: 3,156 Class B shares1). Employed since 1995. Working as a Service Engineer within the IT organization.

 

LOGO

Rickard Fredriksson (first appointed 2012)

Deputy employee representative

Born 1969. Appointed by the union IF Metall.

Holdings in Ericsson: 1,249 Class B shares1). Employed since 2000. Previously working as machine operator within Business Unit Networks and currently working full time as union representative.

 

LOGO

Karin Lennartsson (first appointed 2010)

Deputy employee representative

Born 1957. Appointed by the union Unionen.

Holdings in Ericsson: 571 Class B shares1). Employed since 1976. Working as Process Expert within Group Function Business Excellence & Common Functions.

 

LOGO

Roger Svensson (first appointed 2011)

Deputy employee representative

Born 1971. Appointed by the union The Swedish Association of Graduate Engineers.

Holdings in Ericsson: 9,724 Class B shares1). Employed since 1999. Working as Senior Specialist within Business Unit Networks.

Hans Vestberg was the only Director who held an operational management position at Ericsson in 2013. No Director has been elected pursuant to an arrangement or understanding with any major shareholder, customer, supplier or other person.

At the Annual General Meeting 2013, Nora Denzel, Kristin Skogen Lund and Pär Östberg were elected new members of the Board of Directors, replacing Nancy McKinstry, Anders Nyrén and Michelangelo Volpi.

 

1) The number of shares reflects ownership as of December 31, 2013 and includes holdings by related natural and legal persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.

 

117


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

MANAGEMENT

The President/CEO and the Executive Leadership Team

The Board of Directors appoints the President and CEO and the Executive Vice Presidents. The President and CEO is responsible for the management of day-to-day operations and is supported by the Executive Leadership Team (the “ELT”). The ELT members as of December 31, 2013, are presented on page 122.

The role of the ELT is to:

 

   

Establish a strong corporate culture, a long-term vision and Group strategies and policies, all based on objectives stated by the Board

 

   

Determine targets for operational units, allocate resources and monitor unit performance

 

   

Secure operational excellence and realize global synergies through efficient organization of the Group.

Remuneration to the Executive Leadership Team

Guidelines for remuneration to the ELT were approved by the AGM 2013. For further information on fixed and variable remuneration, see the Remuneration Report and Notes to the consolidated financial statements—Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees” in the Annual Report.

The Ericsson Group Management System

Ericsson has one global management system, known as the “Ericsson Group Management System” (EGMS) to drive corporate culture and to ensure that the business is managed:

 

   

To fulfill the objectives of Ericsson’s major stakeholders (customers, shareholders, employees)

 

   

Within established risk limits and with reliable internal control

 

   

In compliance with relevant applicable laws, listing requirements, governance codes and corporate social responsibilities.

The EGMS is a framework consisting of rules and requirements for Ericsson’s business, specified through process and organization descriptions, policies, directives and instructions. The management system is applied in all Ericsson’s operations globally, and its consistency and global reach is designed to build trust in the way Ericsson works. The EGMS is founded on ISO 9001 (international standard for quality management systems) but is designed as a dynamic governance system, enabling Ericsson to adapt the system to evolving demands and expectations, including new legislation as well as customers’ and other stakeholders’ requirements. Ericsson does not implement external requirements without analyzing them and putting them into the Ericsson context.

The EGMS comprises three elements:

 

   

Management and control

 

   

Ericsson business processes

 

   

Organization and resources.

 

LOGO

Management and control

Ericsson’s strategy and target-setting processes consider the demands and expectations of customers as well as other key stakeholders. Ericsson uses balanced scorecards as tools for translating strategic objectives into a set of performance indicators for its operational units. Based on annual strategy work, these scorecards are updated with targets for each unit for the next year and are communicated throughout the organization.

Group-wide policies and directives govern how the organization works and are core elements in managing and controlling Ericsson. The Group Policies and Directives include, among other things, a Code of

 

118


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Business Ethics, a Code of Conduct and accounting and reporting directives to fulfill external reporting requirements.

The Group Steering Documents Committee works to ensure that the policies and directives cover relevant issues; that they are aligned and consistent with Group strategies, values and structures; and that they are not in conflict with legal and regulatory requirements. In addition, the Group Steering Documents Committee works to ensure that the said strategies, values and structures are implemented by the responsible function.

Ericsson business processes

As a market leader, Ericsson utilizes the competitive advantages that are gained through global scale and has implemented common processes and IT tools across all operational units worldwide. Customer requirements are identified, clarified and formalized in Ericsson Business Processes where requirements transform from theory to practice. Ericsson attempts to reduce costs with efficient and effective process flows and with standardized internal controls and performance indicators.

Organization and resources

Ericsson is operated in two dimensions: one operational structure and one legal structure. The operational structure aligns accountability and authority regardless of country borders and supports the process flow with cross-country operations. In the operational structure, Ericsson is organized in group functions, business units and regions. The legal structure is the basis for legal requirements and responsibility as well as for tax and statutory reporting purposes. There are more than 200 legal entities within the Ericsson Group with representation (via legal entities, branch and representative offices) in more than 150 countries.

Chief Compliance Officer

Ericsson has a Chief Compliance Officer (CCO) whose primary focus is to further develop Ericsson’s anti-corruption compliance program. Attention from senior-management level on anti-corruption and compliance is crucial, as is ensuring that these matters are addressed from a cross-functional perspective. Ericsson’s anti-corruption compliance program is reviewed and evaluated by the Audit Committee at least annually.

Audits, assessments and certification

The purpose of audits and assessments is to determine levels of compliance and to provide valuable information for understanding, analyzing and continually improving performance. Management monitors compliance with policies, directives and processes through internal self-assessment within all units. This is complemented by internal and external audits.

Due to demands and requirements from customers and other external stakeholders, Ericsson sometimes needs to take decisions on certification in order to stay competitive in the market. Certification means that Ericsson’s interpretation of standards or requirements are confirmed by a third party assessment.

As the EGMS is a global system, group-wide certificates are issued by a third party certification body proving that the system is efficient throughout the whole organization. Ericsson is currently globally certified to ISO 9001 (Quality), ISO 14001 (Environment) and OHSAS 18001 (Health & Safety). Selected Ericsson units are also certified to additional standards, for example ISO 27001 (Information Security) and TL 9000 (telecom-specific standard). EGMS is also audited within the scope of the audit plan of Ericsson’s internal audit function.

Ericsson’s external financial audits are performed by PricewaterhouseCoopers, and ISO/management system audits by Intertek. Internal audits are performed by the company’s internal audit function which reports to the Audit Committee.

Ericsson conducts audits of suppliers in order to secure compliance with Ericsson’s Code of Conduct, which includes rules that suppliers to the Ericsson Group must comply with.

Risk management

Ericsson’s risk management is integrated into the operational processes of the business, and is a part of the EGMS to ensure accountability, effectiveness, efficiency, business continuity and compliance with corporate governance, legal and other requirements. The Board of Directors is also actively engaged in the Company’s risk management. Risks related to long-term objectives are discussed and strategies are formally approved by the Board as part of the annual strategy process. Risks related to annual targets for the Company are also reviewed by the Board and then monitored continuously during the year. Certain transactional risks require specific Board approval, e.g. acquisitions, management remuneration, borrowing or customer finance in excess of pre-defined limits.

Strategic and tactical risks

Strategic risks constitute the highest risk to the Company if not managed properly as they could have a long-term impact. Ericsson therefore reviews its long-term objectives, main strategies and business scope on an annual basis and continuously works on its tactics to reach these objectives and to mitigate any risks identified.

In the annual strategy and target setting process, objectives are set for the next three to

 

119


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

five years. Risks and opportunities are assessed and strategies are developed to achieve the objectives. The strategy process in the Company is well established and involves regions, business units and Group functions. The strategy is summarized and discussed in a yearly Leadership Summit with approximately 250 leaders from all parts of the business. By involving all parts of the business in the process, potential risks are identified early and mitigating actions can be incorporated in the strategy and in the annual target-setting process following the finalization of the strategy.

Key components in the evaluation of risk related to Ericsson’s long-term objectives. include technology development, industry and market fundamentals, the development of the economy and laws and regulations.

The outcome of the strategy process forms the basis for the annual target-setting process, which involves regions, business units and Group functions. Risks related to the targets are identified as part of this process together with actions to mitigate the identified risks. Follow-up of targets, risks and mitigating actions are reported and discussed continuously in business unit and region steering groups and are reviewed by the Board of Directors.

Ericsson continuously strives to improve its risk management and believes that it is important that the entire global organization takes part in the risk management and strategy work. The risk management framework implemented during 2012 has been further developed and qualified during 2013. For more information on risks related to Ericsson’s business, see the chapter “Risk factors” in the Annual Report.

Operational and financial risks

Operational risks are owned and managed by operational units. Risk management is embedded in various process controls, such as decision tollgates and approvals. Certain cross-process risks are centrally coordinated, such as information security, IT security, corporate responsibility and business continuity and insurable risks. Financial risk management is governed by a Group policy and carried out by the Treasury and Customer Finance functions, both supervised by the Finance Committee. The policy governs risk exposures related to foreign exchange, liquidity/financing, interest rates, credit risk and market price risk in equity instruments. For further information on financial risk management, see Notes to the consolidated financial statements—Note C14, “Trade receivables and customer finance,” Note C19, “Interest-bearing liabilities” and Note C20, “Financial risk management and financial instruments” in the Annual Report.

Strategy, target-setting and risk management cycle

The annual strategy, target-setting and risk management cycle is part of Ericsson’s strategy process, which is well-established within the Group and involves regions, business units and Group functions.

 

LOGO

 

120


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Compliance risks

Ericsson has implemented Group policies and directives in order to comply with applicable laws and regulations, including a Code of Business Ethics and a Code of Conduct. Risk management is integrated in the Company’s business processes. Policies and controls are implemented to comply with financial reporting standards and stock market regulations.

Risk mitigation

Significant ongoing activities in order to mitigate risks include:

 

   

Establishing flexibility to cost-effectively accommodate to fluctuations in customer demand

 

   

Conducting regular supplier Code of Conduct audits

 

   

Continuously assessing and managing CR risks

 

   

Conducting business continuity management in an efficient way

 

   

Conducting corporate governance training as needed

 

   

Continuously monitoring information systems to guard against data breaches

 

   

Reviewing top risks and mitigating actions at various internal governance meetings.

 

LOGO

Example of risk heat map document

Risk heat maps are generated by business units, regions and Group functions in four risk categories:

 

   

Industry and market risk

 

   

Commercial risk

 

   

Operational risk

 

   

Compliance risk

 

LOGO

 

121


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

MEMBERS OF THE EXECUTIVE LEADERSHIP TEAM

Hans Vestberg

President and CEO (since 2010)

Born 1965. Bachelor of Business Administration and Economics, University of Uppsala, Sweden.

Board Chairman: Svenska Handbollförbundet.

Board Member: Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and Thernlunds AB.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 217,185 Class B shares.

Background: Previously, First Executive Vice President, CFO and Head of Group Function Finance and Executive Vice President and Head of Business Unit Global Services. Various positions in the Group since 1988, including Vice President and Head of Market Unit Mexico and Head of Finance and Control in USA, Brazil and Chile. International advisor to the Governor of Guangdong, China and co-chairman of the Russian-Swedish Business Council. Founding member of the Broadband Commission for Digital Development, and heading the Commission’s task group on the post-2015 development agenda. Member of the Leadership Council of the United Nations Sustainable Development Solutions Network.

Jan Frykhammar

Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Head of Group Function Finance (since 2009)

Born 1965. Bachelor of Business Administration and Economics, University of Uppsala, Sweden.

Board Member: The Swedish International Chamber of Commerce.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 22,985 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit Global Services. Various positions within Ericsson including Sales and Business Control in Business Unit Global Services, CFO in North America and Vice President, Finance and Commercial within the Global Customer Account Vodafone.

Magnus Mandersson

Executive Vice President (since 2011) and Head of Business Unit Global Services (since 2010)

Born 1959. Bachelor of Business Administration, University of Lund, Sweden.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 33,504 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Head of Business Unit CDMA, Market Unit Northern Europe, Global Customer Account Deutsche Telekom AG and Product Area Managed Services. Has also been President and CEO of SEC/ Tele2 Europe and COO of Millicom International Cellular S.A.

Johan Wibergh

Executive Vice President (since 2010) and Head of Business Unit Networks (since 2008)

Born 1963. Master of Computer Science, Linköping Institute of Technology, Sweden.

Board Member: Confederation of Swedish Enterprise, KTH Royal Institute of Technology and Teknikföretagen.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 55,012 Class B shares.

Background: Previously President of Ericsson Brazil, President of Market Unit Nordic and Baltics and Vice President and Head of Sales at Business Unit Global Services.

Per Borgklint

Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit Support Solutions (since 2011)

Born 1972. Master of Science in Business Administration, Jönköping International Business School, Sweden.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 5,000 Class B shares.

Background: Previously CEO of Net1 (Ice.net), Canal Plus Nordic and Versatel. Has also held several leading positions at Tele2.

Bina Chaurasia

Senior Vice President, Chief Human Resources Officer and Head of Group Function Human Resources (since 2010)

Born 1962. Master of Science in Management and Human Resources, Ohio State University, USA, and Master of Arts in Philosophy, University of Wisconsin, USA.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 22,677 Class B shares.

Background: Joined Ericsson from Hewlett Packard, where she was Vice President of Global Talent Management. Has held senior HR leadership roles at Gap, Sun Microsystems and PepsiCo/Yum.

Ulf Ewaldsson

Senior Vice President, Chief Technology Officer and Head of Group Function Technology (since 2012)

Born 1965. Master of Science in Engineering and Business Management, Linköping Institute of Technology, Sweden.

Board Member: Lund University.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 22,177 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Head of Product Area Radio within Business Unit Networks. Has held various managerial positions within Ericsson since 1990. Member of the European Cloud Partnership Steering Board.

Douglas L. Gilstrap

Senior Vice President and Head of Group Function Strategy (since 2009) and Chairman of Business Unit Modems (since 2013)

The Board memberships and Ericsson holdings reported above are as of December 31, 2013.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related natural and legal persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.

 

122


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Born 1963. Bachelor of Science in Accounting, University of Richmond, USA, and Master of Business Administration, Emory University, Atlanta, USA. Executive program at INSEAD, France.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 22,727 Class B shares.

Background: Has held various global managerial positions within the telecommunications sector for more than 18 years.

Nina Macpherson

Senior Vice President, General Counsel, Head of Group Function Legal Affairs and secretary to the Board of Directors (since 2011)

Born 1958. Master of Laws, LL.M., University of Stockholm, Sweden.

Board Member: The Association for Swedish Listed Companies and the Arbitration Institute of the Stockholm Chamber of Commerce (SCC).

Holdings in Ericsson1): 11,560 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Vice President and Deputy Head of Group Function Legal Affairs at Ericsson. Previous positions also include private practice and in-house attorney. Member of the Swedish Securities Council.

Helena Norrman

Senior Vice President, Chief Communications Officer and Head of Group Function Communications (since 2011)

Born 1970. Master of International Business Administration, Linköping University, Sweden.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 12,621 Class B shares.

Background: Previously Vice President, Communications Operations at Group Function Communications at Ericsson. Has held various positions within Ericsson’s global communications organization since 1998. Previous positions as communications consultant.

Mats H. Olsson

Senior Vice President and Head of Asia-Pacific (since January 2013)

Born 1954. Master of Business Administration, Stockholm School of Economics, Sweden. Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 75,754 Class B shares.

Background: International economic advisor to a number of Chinese provincial and municipal governments. Head of Region North East Asia, 2010–2012. Has held various executive positions across the Asia-Pacific region for more than 25 years, including Head of Market Unit Greater China and Head of Market Unit South East Asia.

Rima Qureshi

Senior Vice President Strategic Projects (since January 2013)

Born 1965. Bachelor of Information Systems and Master of Business Administration, McGill University, Montreal, Canada.

Board Member: MasterCard Incorporated.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 6,076 Class B shares.

Background: Also serves as Head of Ericsson Response. Head of Business Unit CDMA Mobile Systems 2010–2012. Previously Vice President of Strategic Improvement Program and Vice President Product Area Customer Support. Has held various positions within Ericsson since 1993.

Angel Ruiz

Head of Region North America (since 2010)

Born 1956. Bachelor of Electrical Engineering, University of Central Florida, USA, and Master of Management Science and Information Systems, Johns Hopkins University, USA.

Board Member: CTIA.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 59,933 Class B shares.

Background: Joined Ericsson in 1990 and has held a variety of technical, sales and managerial positions within the Company, including heading up the global account teams for Cingular/SBC/BellSouth (now AT&T). Was appointed President of Ericsson North America in 2001. Member of National Security Telecommunications Advisory Committee (NSTAC).

Anders Thulin

Senior Vice President, Chief Information Officer and Head of Group Function Business Excellence and Common Functions (since October 2013)

Born 1963. Degree in Economics and Business Administration from Stockholm School of Economics, Sweden, including MBA studies at the Western University, Ivey Business School, Canada.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson1): None.

Background: Joined Ericsson from McKinsey & Co where he was senior partner. Has more than 20 years of experience in implementing business excellence across diverse industries, including IT and telecom.

Jan Wäreby

Senior Vice President and Head of Sales and Marketing (since 2011)

Born 1956. Master of Science, Chalmers University, Gothenburg, Sweden.

Board Member: None.

Holdings in Ericsson1): 82,286 Class B shares.

Background: Senior Vice President and Head of Business Unit Multimedia and Executive Vice President and Head of Sales and Marketing for Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications.

The Board memberships and Ericsson holdings reported above are as of December 31, 2013.

 

1) The number of shares includes holdings by related natural and legal persons, as well as holdings of any ADS, if applicable.

 

123


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

AUDITOR

According to the Articles of Association, the Parent Company shall have no less than one and no more than three registered public accounting firms as external independent auditor. Ericsson’s auditor is currently elected each year at the AGM pursuant to the Swedish Companies Act, which provides that the mandate period of an auditor shall be one year, unless the Articles of Association provide for a longer mandate period of up to four years. The auditor reports to the shareholders at General Meetings.

The duties of the auditor include:

 

   

Updating the Board of Directors regarding the planning, scope and content of the annual audit work

 

   

Reviewing the interim reports for the third and fourth quarters and the year-end financial statements to assess that the financial statements are presented fairly in all material respects

 

   

Advising the Board of Directors of non-audit services performed, the consideration paid and other issues that determine the auditor’s independence.

For further information on the contacts between the Board and the auditor, please see “Work of the Board of Directors” earlier in this Corporate Governance Report.

Auditing work is carried out by the auditor continuously throughout the year. The auditor signs review opinions over Ericsson’s interim financial reports for the third and fourth quarters and signs an audit opinion over the Annual Report.

Current auditor

PricewaterhouseCoopers AB was elected auditor at the AGM 2013 for a period of one year, i.e. until the close of the AGM 2014.

PricewaterhouseCoopers AB has appointed Peter Nyllinge, Authorized Public Accountant, to serve as auditor in charge.

Fees to the auditor

Ericsson paid the fees (including expenses) for audit-related and other services listed in the table in Notes to the consolidated financial statements—Note C30, “Fees to auditors” in the Annual Report.

INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING 2013

This section has been prepared in accordance with the Annual Accounts Act and the Swedish Corporate Governance Code and is limited to internal control over financial reporting.

Since Ericsson is listed in the United States, the requirements outlined in the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX) apply. These regulate the establishment and maintenance of internal controls over financial reporting as well as management’s assessment of the effectiveness of the controls.

In order to support high quality reporting and to meet the requirement of SOX, the Company has implemented detailed documented controls and testing and reporting procedures based on the internationally established COSO framework for internal control (1992). The COSO framework is issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

During 2013, the Company has included operations of acquired entities as well as continued to improve the design and execution of its financial reporting controls.

Disclosure policies

Ericsson’s financial disclosure policies aim to ensure transparent, relevant and consistent communication with equity and debt investors on a timely, fair and equal basis. This will support a fair market value for Ericsson securities. Ericsson wants current and potential investors to have a good understanding of how the Company works, including operational performance, prospects and potential risks.

To achieve these objectives, financial reporting and disclosure must be:

 

   

Transparent—enhancing understanding of the economic drivers and operational performance of the business, building trust and credibility

 

   

Consistent—comparable in scope and level of detail to facilitate comparison between reporting periods

 

   

Simple—to support understanding of business operations and performance and to avoid misinterpretations

 

   

Relevant—with focus on what is relevant to Ericsson’s stakeholders or required by regulation or listing agreements, to avoid information overload

 

   

Timely—with regular scheduled disclosures as well as ad-hoc information, such as press releases on important events, performed in a timely manner

 

   

Fair and equal—where all material information is published via press releases to ensure that the whole investor community receives the information at the same time

 

   

Complete, free from material errors and a reflection of best practice – disclosure is compliant with applicable financial reporting standards and listing requirements and in line with industry norms.

Ericsson’s website comprises comprehensive information on the Group, including:

 

   

An archive of annual and interim reports

 

   

Access to recent news.

Disclosure controls and procedures

Ericsson has controls and procedures in place to allow for timely information disclosure under applicable laws and regulations, including the

 

124


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

US Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and under agreements with NASDAQ OMX Stockholm and NASDAQ New York. These procedures also require that such information is provided to management, including the CEO and CFO, so timely decisions can be made regarding required disclosure.

The Disclosure Committee comprises members with various expertise. It assists the management in fulfilling their responsibility regarding disclosures made to the shareholders and the investment community. One of the main tasks of the committee is to monitor the integrity and effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures.

Ericsson has investments in certain entities that the Company does not control or manage. With respect to such entities, disclosure controls and procedures are substantially more limited than those maintained with respect to subsidiaries.

Ericsson’s President and CEO and the CFO evaluated the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures and concluded that they were effective at a reasonable assurance level as of December 31, 2013. Any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving the desired control objectives.

Internal control over financial reporting

Ericsson has integrated risk management and internal control into its business processes. As defined in the COSO framework, internal control is an aggregation of components such as a control environment, risk assessment, control activities, information and communication and monitoring.

During the period covered by the Annual Report 2013, there were no changes to the internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the internal control over financial reporting.

Control environment

The Company’s internal control structure is based on the division of tasks between the Board of Directors and its Committees and the President and CEO. The Company has implemented a management system that is based on:

 

   

Steering documents, such as policies, directives and a Code of Business Ethics

 

   

A strong corporate culture

 

   

The Company’s organization and mode of operations, with well-defined roles and responsibilities and delegations of authority

 

   

Several well-defined Group-wide processes for planning, operations and support.

The most essential parts of the control environment relative to financial reporting are included in steering documents and processes for accounting and financial reporting. These steering documents are updated regularly to include, among other things:

 

   

Changes to laws

 

   

Financial reporting standards and listing requirements, such as IFRS and SOX.

The processes include specific controls to be performed to ensure high quality financial reports. The management of each reporting legal entity, region and business unit is supported by a financial controller function with execution of controls related to transactions and reporting. The financial controller functions are organized in a number of Company Control Hubs, each supporting a number of legal entities within a geographical area. A financial controller function is also established on Group level, reporting to the CFO.

Risk assessment

Risks of material misstatements in financial reporting may exist in relation to recognition and measurement of assets, liabilities, revenue and cost or insufficient disclosure. Other risks related to financial reporting include fraud, loss or embezzlement of assets and undue favorable treatment of counterparties at the expense of the Company.

Policies and directives regarding accounting and financial reporting cover areas of particular significance to support correct, complete and timely accounting, reporting and disclosure.

Identified types of risks are mitigated through well-defined business processes with integrated risk management activities, segregation of duties and appropriate delegation of authority. This requires specific approval of material transactions and ensures adequate asset management.

Control activities

The Company’s business processes include financial controls regarding the approval and accounting of business transactions. The financial closing and reporting process has controls regarding recognition, measurement and disclosure. These include the application of critical accounting policies and estimates, in individual subsidiaries as well as in the consolidated accounts.

Regular analyses of the financial results for each subsidiary, region and business unit cover the significant elements of assets, liabilities, revenues, costs and cash flow. Together with further analysis of the consolidated financial statements performed at Group level, these procedures are designed to produce financial reports without material errors.

For external financial reporting purposes, the Disclosure Committee performs additional control procedures to review whether the disclosure requirements are fulfilled.

 

125


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

The Company has implemented controls to ensure that financial reports are prepared in accordance with its internal accounting and reporting policies and IFRS as well as with relevant listing regulations. It maintains detailed documentation on internal controls related to accounting and financial reporting. It also keeps records on the monitoring of the execution and results of such controls. This allows the President and CEO and the CFO to assess the effectiveness of the controls in a way that is compliant with SOX.

Entity-wide controls, focusing on the control environment and compliance with financial reporting policies and directives, are implemented in all subsidiaries. Detailed process controls and documentation of controls performed are also implemented in almost all subsidiaries, covering the items with significant materiality and risk.

In order to secure compliance, governance and risk management in the areas of legal entity accounting and taxation, as well as securing funding and equity levels, the Company operates through a Company Control hub structure, covering subsidiaries in each respective geographical area.

Based on a common IT platform, a common chart of account and common master data, the hubs and shared services centers perform accounting and financial reporting services for most subsidiaries.

Information and communication

The Company’s information and communication channels support complete, correct and timely financial reporting by making all relevant internal process instructions and policies accessible to all the employees concerned. Regular updates and briefing documents regarding changes in accounting policies, reporting and disclosure requirements are also supplied.

Subsidiaries and operating units prepare regular financial and management reports for internal steering groups and Company management. These include analysis and comments on financial performance and risks. The Board of Directors receives financial reports monthly. Ericsson has established a whistleblower procedure for the reporting of alleged violations that (i) are conducted by Group or local management, and (ii) relate to corruption, questionable accounting or auditing matters or otherwise seriously affect vital interests of the Group or personal health and safety.

Monitoring

The Company’s process for financial reporting is reviewed annually by the management. This forms a basis for evaluating the internal management system and internal steering documents to ensure that they cover all significant areas related to financial reporting. The shared service center and company control hub management continuously monitor accounting quality through a set of performance indicators. Compliance with policies and directives is monitored through annual self-assessments and representation letters from heads and company controllers in all subsidiaries as well as in business units and regions.

The Company’s financial performance is also reviewed at each Board meeting. The Committees of the Board fulfill important monitoring functions regarding remuneration, borrowing, investments, customer finance, cash management, financial reporting and internal control. The Audit Committee and the Board of Directors review all interim and annual financial reports before they are released to the market. The Company’s internal audit function reports directly to the Audit Committee. The Audit Committee also receives regular reports from the external auditor. The Audit Committee follows up on any actions taken to improve or modify controls.

BOARD OF DIRECTORS

Stockholm, March 5, 2014

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ)

Org. no. 556016–0680

 

126


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

REMUNERATION REPORT

INTRODUCTION

This report outlines how the remuneration policy is implemented throughout Ericsson in line with corporate governance best practice, with specific references to Group management. The work of the Remuneration Committee in 2013 and the remuneration policy are explained at the beginning of the report, followed by descriptions of plans and their outcome.

More details of the remuneration of Group management and Board members’ fees can be found in the Notes to the Consolidated financial statements—Note C28, “Information regarding members of the Board of Directors, the Group management and employees.”

Board member remuneration is resolved annually by the Annual General Meeting.

THE REMUNERATION COMMITTEE

The Remuneration Committee advises the Board of Directors on a regular basis on the remuneration to the Group management, consisting of the Executive Leadership Team (ELT). This includes fixed salaries, pensions, other benefits and short-term and long-term variable compensation, all in the context of pay and employment conditions throughout Ericsson. The Remuneration Committee reviews and prepares for resolution by the Board:

 

   

Proposals on salary and other remuneration, including retirement compensation, for the President and CEO

 

   

Proposals on targets for the short-term variable compensation for the President and CEO

 

   

Proposals to the Annual General Meeting on guidelines for remuneration to the ELT

 

   

Proposals to the Annual General Meeting on long-term variable compensation and similar equity arrangements

The responsibility of the Remuneration Committee is also to:

 

   

Approve proposals on salary and other remuneration, including retirement compensation, for the Executive Vice Presidents and other ELT members.

 

   

Approve proposals on targets for the short-term variable compensation for the Executive Vice Presidents and other ELT members.

REMUNERATION POLICY

Remuneration at Ericsson is based on the principles of performance, competitiveness and fairness. The remuneration policy, together with the mix of remuneration elements, is designed to reflect these principles by creating a balanced remuneration package. The Guidelines for remuneration to Group management 2013, approved by the AGM, can be found in Note C28. The auditor’s report regarding whether the company has complied with the guidelines for compensation to the ELT during 2013 is posted on the Ericsson website.

 

   

Approve pay out of the short-term variable compensation for the ELT, based on achievements and performance.

The Remuneration Committee’s work forms the foundation for the governance of Ericsson’s remuneration processes, together with Ericsson’s internal systems and audit controls. The Committee is chaired by Leif Johansson and its other members are Börje Ekholm, Roxanne S. Austin, and Karin Åberg. All the members are non-executive directors, independent (except for the employee representative) as required by the Swedish Corporate Governance Code and have relevant knowledge and experience of remuneration matters.

The Company’s General Counsel acts as secretary to the Committee. The President and CEO, the Senior Vice President, Head of Human Resources and the Vice President, Head of Total Rewards attend Remuneration Committee meetings by invitation and assist the Committee in its considerations, except when issues relating to their own remuneration are being discussed.

The Remuneration Committee has appointed an independent expert advisor, Piia Pilv, to assist and advise the Committee. The independent advisor provided no other services to the Company during 2013. The Remuneration Committee is also furnished with national and international pay data collected from external survey providers and can call on other independent expertise, should it so require. The Chairman continues to ensure that contact is maintained, as necessary and appropriate, with shareholders regarding remuneration.

The purpose and function of the Remuneration Committee and its responsibilities can be found in the Corporate Governance Report. These responsibilities, together with the Guidelines for remuneration to Group management (ELT) and the Long-Term Variable compensation (LTV) program is reviewed and evaluated annually in light of matters such as changes to corporate governance best practice or changes to accounting, legislation, political opinion or business practices among peers. This helps to ensure that the policy continues to provide Ericsson with a competitive remuneration strategy.

The Guidelines for remuneration to Group management are, in accordance with Swedish law, brought to shareholders annually for approval.

The Remuneration Committee met six times during the year 2013.

The winter meetings focused on following up on results from the 2012 variable compensation programs and preparing proposals to shareholders for the 2013 Annual General Meeting (AGM). During the spring the committee determined the relocation package for a member of the ELT and proposed to the Board of Directors to approve the LTV 2010 vesting result. In the fall, the committee reviewed the Guidelines for remuneration to Group management and decided to continue the LTV program without any material changes and the STV plans with an increased weighting on functional targets for 2014. The committee based its considerations on the business needs, analyses and reviews of the global market trends and feedback from shareholders and institutions. Supported by the independent advisor, the Committee also reviewed the competitiveness of the ELT remuneration in the global market.

 

127


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Evaluation of the Guidelines for remuneration to Group management and of the LTV program

The Remuneration Committee supports the Board with the review and evaluation of the Guidelines for remuneration to Group management and Ericsson’s application of these guidelines. The Committee and the Board has concluded that the guidelines remain valid and right for Ericsson and that the guidelines should not be materially changed for 2014.

Furthermore, the Remuneration Committee is of the opinion that the LTV program fulfills the defined objectives to promote “One Ericsson” and to align the interests of employees with those of shareholders. The number of participants as of December 1, 2013 was approximately 29,000 employees, compared to 27,000 employees as of December 1, 2012. The evaluation also confirms that the Key Contributor Retention Plan meets the purpose of retaining our key employees. The voluntary attrition rate among Key Contributors is about two-thirds compared to the attrition rate in the total number of employees.

TOTAL REMUNERATION

When considering the remuneration of an individual, it is the total remuneration that matters. First, the total annual cash compensation is defined, consisting of the target level of short-term variable compensation plus fixed salary. Thereafter, target long-term variable compensation may be added to get to the total target compensation and, finally, pension and other benefits may be added to arrive at the total remuneration.

For the ELT, remuneration consists of fixed salary, short-term and long-term variable compensation, pension and other benefits. If the size of any one of these elements is increased or decreased when setting the remuneration, at least one other element has to change if the competitive position is to remain unchanged.

The remuneration costs for the CEO and the ELT are reported in Note C28.

Fixed salary

When setting fixed salaries, the Remuneration Committee considers the impact on total remuneration, including pensions and associated costs. The absolute levels are determined based on the size and complexity of the position and the year-to-year performance of the individual. Together with other elements of remuneration, ELT salaries are subject to an annual review by the Remuneration Committee, which considers external pay data to ensure that levels of pay remain competitive and appropriate to the remuneration policy.

Variable compensation

Ericsson strongly believes that, where possible, variable compensation should be encouraged as an integral part of total remuneration. First and foremost, this aligns employees with clear and relevant targets, but it also enables more flexible payroll costs and emphasizes the link between performance and pay.

All variable compensation plans have maximum award and vesting limits. Short-term variable compensation is to a greater extent dependent on the performance of the specific unit or function, while long-term variable compensation is dependent on the achievements of the Ericsson Group.

As described in the section “Our Performance,” Ericsson measures business performance according to five categories of measurements derived from the overall strategy: growing sales faster than market, best-in-class operating margin, strong cash conversion, customer satisfaction and employee engagement. These categories form the basis for our short- and long-term variable compensation programs and set the framework of what measurements shall be used for variable compensation.

Short-term variable compensation

Annual variable compensation is delivered through cash-based programs. Specific business targets are derived from the annual business plan approved by the Board of Directors and, in turn, defined by the Company’s long-term strategy. Ericsson strives to grow faster than the market with best-in-class margins and strong cash conversion and therefore the starting point is to have three core targets:

 

   

Net sales growth

 

   

Operating income

 

   

Cash flow.

For the ELT, targets are thus predominantly financial at either Group level (for Heads of Group functions) or at the individual unit level (for Heads of regions or business units) and may also include operational targets like customer satisfaction and employee engagement.

The chart below illustrates how payouts to the ELT have varied with performance over the past five years.

LOGO

 

128


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Summaries of 2013 short- and long-term variable compensation

 

What we call it

 

What is it?

 

What is the objective?

 

Who participates?

  How is it earned?

Short-term: Compensation delivered over twelve months or less

Fixed salary   Fixed compensation paid at set times   Attract and retain employees, delivering part of annual compensation in a predictable format   All employees   Market appropriate levels
set according to position
and evaluated according
to individual
performance
Short-Term Variable compensation (STV)   A variable plan that is measured and paid over a single year   Align employees with clear and relevant targets, providing an earnings opportunity in return for performance, and flexible cost   Enrolled employees, including Executive Leadership Team. Approximately 75,000 in 2013   Achievements against set
targets. Reward can
increase to up to twice
the target level and
decrease to zero,
depending on
performance

Sales Incentive Plans

  Tailored versions of the STV   As for STV, tailored for local or business requirements, such as sales   Employees in sales. Approximately 2,000 in 2013   Similar to STV. All plans
have maximum award
and vesting limits

Long-term: Compensation delivered over three years or more

Stock Purchase Plan (SPP)   All-employee stock-based plan   Reinforce a “One Ericsson” mentality and align employees’ interests with those of shareholders   All employees are eligible   Buy one share and it will
be matched by one share
after three years if still
employed
Key Contributor Retention Plan (KC)   Share-based plan for selected individuals   Recognize, retain and motivate key contributors for performance, critical skills and potential   Up to 10% of employees   If selected, get one more
matching share in
addition to the SPP one
Executive Performance Stock Plan (EPSP)   Share-based plan for senior managers   Compensation for long-term commitment and value creation   Senior managers, including Executive Leadership Team   Get up to four, six or, for
CEO, nine further shares
matched to each SPP
share for long-term
performance

The Board of Directors and the Remuneration Committee decide on all targets for Group management which are cascaded to unit-related targets throughout the Company, always subject to a two-level management approval process. The Remuneration Committee monitors the appropriateness and fairness of Group target levels throughout the performance year and has the authority to revise them should they cease to be relevant or stretching or to enhance shareholder value.

During 2013, approximately 77,000 employees participated in short-term variable compensation plans.

Long-term variable compensation

Share-based long-term variable compensation plans are submitted each year for approval by shareholders at the AGM. All long-term variable compensation plans are designed to form part of a well-balanced total remuneration package and to span over a minimum of three years. As these are variable plans, outcomes are unknown and rewards depend on long-term personal investment, corporate performance and resulting share price performance. During 2013, share-based compensation was made up of three different but linked plans: the all-employee Stock Purchase Plan, the Key Contributor Retention Plan and the Executive Performance Stock Plan.

The Stock Purchase Plan

The all-employee Stock Purchase Plan is designed to offer, where practicable, an incentive for all employees to participate. This reinforces “One Ericsson,” aligned with shareholder interests. Employees can save up to 7.5% of gross fixed salary (the President and CEO can save up to 10% of gross fixed salary and short-term variable compensation) for purchase of Class B shares at market price on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm or ADSs on NASDAQ New York (contribution shares) over a 12-month period. If the contribution shares are retained by the employee for three years after the investment and employment with the Ericsson Group continues during that time, the employee’s shares will be matched with a corresponding number of Class B shares or ADSs, as applicable. The plan was introduced in 2002 and employees in 71 countries participated during its first year. In December 2013, the number of participants was over 29,000, or approximately 29% of eligible employees in 100 countries.

Participants save each month, beginning with the August payroll, towards quarterly investments. These investments (in November, February, May and August) are matched on the third anniversary of each such investment and hence the matching spans over two financial years and two tax years.

The Key Contributor Retention Plan

The Key Contributor Retention Plan is part of Ericsson’s talent management strategy. It is designed to recognize individuals for performance, critical skills and potential as well as to encourage retention of key employees.

Under the program, operating units around the world can nominate up to 10% of employees worldwide. Each unit nominates individuals that have been identified according to performance, critical skills and potential. The nominations are calibrated in management teams locally and are reviewed by both local and corporate Human Resources to ensure that there is a minimum of bias and a strong belief in the system.

Participants selected obtain one extra matching share in addition to the one matching share for each contribution share purchased under the Stock Purchase Plan during a 12-month investment period. The plan was introduced in 2004.

 

129


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Short-term variable compensation structure

 

      Short-term variable compensation
as percentage of fixed salary
    Percentage of short-term variable
compensation maximal opportunity
 
     Target
level
    Maximum
level
    Actual paid
for 2012
    Group financial
targets
    Unit/functional
financial targets
    Non-financial
targets
 

CEO 2012

     40     80     32     90     0     10

CEO 2013

     40     80     25     100     0     0

Average ELT 20121)

     36     72     37     49     27     24

Average ELT 20131)

     37     74     36     53     25     22

 

1) Excludes CEO—differences in target and maximum levels from year to year are due to changes in the composition of the ELT.

The Executive Performance Stock Plan

The Executive Performance Stock Plan was first introduced in 2004. The plan is designed to focus management on driving long-term financial performance and to provide market-competitive remuneration. Senior managers, including the ELT, are selected to obtain up to four or six extra shares (performance-matching shares). This is in addition to the one matching share for each contribution share purchased under the all-employee Stock Purchase Plan. Performance matching is subject to the fulfillment of performance targets. Since 2010, the President and CEO may obtain up to nine performance-matching shares in addition to the Stock Purchase Plan matching share for each contribution share.

In the 2004 to 2010 plans, the performance targets were Earnings Per Share (EPS) targets.

To support the long-term strategy and value creation of the Company, new targets have been in place since the 2011 plan. At the AGM 2013, the following targets for the 2013 Executive Performance Stock Plan were resolved on proposal by the Board:

 

   

Net Sales Growth: Up to one-third of the award will vest if the compound annual growth rate of consolidated net sales is between 2 and 8% comparing 2015 financial results to 2012

 

   

Operating Income Growth: Up to one-third of the award will vest if the compound annual growth rate of consolidated operating income is between 5 and 15% comparing 2015 financial results to 2012

 

   

Cash Conversion: Up to one third of the award will vest if cash conversion is at or above 70% during each of the years 2013-2015 and vesting one ninth of the total award for each year the target is achieved.

Before the number of performance shares to be matched are finally determined, the Board of Directors shall examine whether the performance matching is reasonable considering the Company’s financial results and position, conditions on the stock market and other circumstances, and if not, as determined by the Board of Directors, reduce the number of performance shares to be matched to the lower number of shares deemed appropriate by the Board of Directors. When undertaking its evaluation of performance, the Board of Directors will consider, in particular, the impact of larger acquisitions, divestitures, the creation of joint ventures and any other significant capital event on the three targets on a case-by-case basis.

Benefits and terms of employment

Pension benefits follow the competitive practice in the employee’s home country and may contain various supplementary plans, in addition to any national system for social security. Where possible, pension plans are operated on a defined contribution basis. Under these plans, Ericsson pays in contributions but does not guarantee the ultimate benefit, unless local regulations or legislation prescribe that defined benefit plans that do give such guarantees have to be offered.

For the President and CEO and other members of the ELT employed in Sweden before 2011, a supplementary pension plan is applied in addition to the occupational pension plan for salaried staff on the Swedish labor market (ITP). The retirement age for these ELT members is normally 60 years.

The ELT members employed in Sweden from 2011 are normally covered by the defined contribution plan under the ITP1 scheme, with a retirement age of 65 years.

For members of the ELT who are not employed in Sweden, local market competitive pension arrangements apply.

Other benefits, such as company cars and medical insurance, are also set to be competitive in the local market. The ELT members may not receive loans from the Company.

The ELT members locally employed in Sweden have a mutual notice period of up to six months. Upon termination of employment by the Company, severance pay can amount to up to 18 months’ fixed salary. For other ELT members, different notice periods and severance pay agreements apply; however, no agreement exceeds the notice period of six months or the severance pay period of 18 months.

REMUNERATION POLICY IN PRACTICE

Ericsson has taken a number of measures since 2011 to enhance the understanding of how the company translates remuneration principles and policy into practice. The first step was the launch of an internal remuneration website in January 2011. The site contains e-learning and training programs targeted at line managers. It supports more informed decisions and better communication to the wider employee population. The next step in this development was the implementation of an Integrated Human Resources IT tool in 2012. The first phase was launched to all managers in Ericsson in November 2012 and covered performance management, talent planning, variable compensation and annual salary review. The second implementation phase of this IT tool, with enhancements and increased scope, was launched at the end of 2013.

 

130


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

SHARE INFORMATION

STOCK EXCHANGE TRADING

The Ericsson Class A and Class B shares are listed on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm. In the United States, the Class B shares are listed on NASDAQ New York in the form of American Depositary Shares (ADS) evidenced by American Depositary Receipts (ADR) under the symbol ERIC. Each ADS represents one Class B share.

In 2013, approximately 2.0 (2.4) billion shares were traded on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm and about 1.0 (1.1) billion shares were traded on NASDAQ New York. A total of 3.0 (3.5) billion Ericsson shares were thus traded on the exchanges where we are listed. Trading volume in Ericsson shares decreased by approximately 17% on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm and by approximately 12% on NASDAQ New York compared to 2012.

The Ericsson share is also traded on other venues such as BATS Europe, Burgundy, and Chi-X Europe.

The Ericsson share

 

Share listings

  

NASDAQ OMX Stockholm

  

NASDAQ New York

  

Share data

  

Total number of shares in issue

     3,305,051,735   

of which Class A shares, each carrying one vote1)

     261,755,983   

of which Class B shares, each carrying one tenth of one vote1)

     3,043,295,752   

Ericsson treasury shares, Class B

     73,968,178   

Quotient value

     SEK 5.00   

Market capitalization, December 31, 2013

     approx. SEK 258 b.   

ICB (Industry Classification Benchmark)

     9500   

Ticker codes

  

NASDAQ OMX Stockholm

     ERIC A/ERIC B   

NASDAQ New York

     ERIC   

Bloomberg NASDAQ OMX Stockholm

     ERICA SS/ERICB SS   

Bloomberg NASDAQ

     ERIC US   

Reuters NASDAQ OMX Stockholm

     ERICa.ST/ERICb.ST   

Reuters NASDAQ

     ERIC.O   

 

1) Both classes of shares have the same rights of participation in the net assets and earnings.

Changes in number of shares and capital stock 2008–2013

 

          Number of shares      Share capital  

2008

   June 2, reverse split 1:5      3,226,451,735         16,132,258,678   

2008

   July 23, new issue (Class C shares, later converted to Class B)      19,900,000         99,500,000   

2008

   December 31      3,246,351,735         16,231,758,678   

2009

   June 8, new issue (Class C shares, later converted to Class B)      27,000,000         135,000,000   

2009

   December 31      3,273,351,735         16,366,758,678   

2010

   December 31      3,273,351,735         16,366,758,678   

2011

   December 31      3,273,351,735         16,366,758,678   

2012

   June 29, new issue (Class C shares, later converted to Class B)1)      31,700,000         158,500,000   

2012

   December 31      3,305,051,735         16,525,258,678   

2013

   December 31      3,305,051,735         16,525,258,678   

Share performance indicators

 

     2013      2012      2011      2010      2009  

Earnings per share, diluted (SEK)1)

     3.69         1.78         3.77         3.46         1.14   

Operating income per share (SEK)2)3)

     5.53         3.25         5.58         7.42         5.8   

Stockholders’ equity per share, basic, end of period (SEK)4)

     43.39         42.51         44.57         45.34         43.79   

P/E ratio

     21         36         19         22         57   

Total shareholder return (%)

     25         –3         –7         22         15   

Dividend per share (SEK)5)

     3.00         2.75         2.50         2.25         2,00   

 

1) Calculated on average number of shares outstanding, diluted.
2) Calculated on average number of shares outstanding, basic.
3) For 2010 and 2009 excluding restructuring charges.
4) Calculated on number of shares, end of period.
5) For 2013 as proposed by the Board of Directors.

For definitions of the financial terms used, see Glossary and Financial Terminology.

 

131


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

SHARE TREND

In 2013, Ericsson’s total market capitalization increased by about 20% to SEK 258 billion, compared to a decrease by 7% reaching SEK 215 billion in 2012. The OMX Stockholm Index on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm increased by 23% and the NASDAQ composite index increased by 38%. The S&P 500 Index increased by 30%.

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

LOGO

 

132


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

SHARE AND ADS PRICES

Principal trading market—NASDAQ OMX Stockholm—share prices

The table below states the high and low share prices for our Class A and Class B shares as reported by NASDAQ OMX Stockholm for the last five years. Trading on the exchange generally continues until 5:30 p.m. (CET) each business day. In addition to trading on the exchange, there is trading off the exchange and on alternative venues during trading hours and also after 5:30 p.m. (CET).

NASDAQ OMX Stockholm publishes a daily Official Price List of Shares which includes the volume of recorded transactions in each listed stock, together with the prices of the highest and lowest recorded trades of the day. The Official Price List of Shares reflects price and volume information for trades completed by the members. The equity securities listed on the NASDAQ OMX Stockholm Official Price List of Shares currently comprise the shares of 256 companies.

Host market NASDAQ New York—ADS prices

The table below states the high and low share prices quoted for our ADSs on NASDAQ New York for the last five years. The NASDAQ New York quotations represent prices between dealers, not including retail markups, markdowns or commissions, and do not necessarily represent actual transactions.

Share prices on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm

 

(SEK)

   2013      2012      2011      2010      2009  

Class A at last day of trading

     74.50         63.90         69.55         74.00         65.00   

Class A high (September 16, 2013)

     86.95         72.00         93.60         88.40         78.80   

Class A low (November 14, 2013)

     50.00         55.55         59.05         65.20         55.40   

Class B at last day of trading

     78.50         65.10         70.40         78.15         65.90   

Class B high (September 16, 2013)

     90.95         71.90         96.65         90.45         79.60   

Class B low (January 9, 2013)

     64.50         55.90         61.70         65.90         55.50   

 

Source: NASDAQ OMX Stockholm.

Share prices on NASDAQ New York

 

(USD)

   2013      2012      2011      2010      2009  

ADS at last day of trading

     12.24         10.10         10.13         11.53         9.19   

ADS high (September 19, 2013)

     14.22         10.60         15.44         12.39         10.92   

ADS low (January 9, 2013)

     9.78         8.23         8.83         9.40         6.60   

 

Source: NASDAQ New York.

Share prices on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm and NASDAQ New York

 

     NASDAQ OMX Stockholm      NASDAQ New York  
     SEK per Class A share      SEK per Class B share      USD per ADS1)  

Period

       High              Low              High              Low              High              Low      

Annual high and low

                 

2009

     78.80         55.40         79.60         55.50         10.92         6.60   

2010

     88.40         65.20         90.45         65.90         12.39         9.40   

2011

     93.60         59.05         96.65         61.70         15.44         8.83   

2012

     72.00         55.55         71.90         55.90         10.60         8.23   

2013

     86.95         50.00         90.95         64.50         14.22         9.78   

Quarterly high and low

                 

2012 First Quarter

     72.00         59.25         71.90         58.15         10.53         8.58   

2012 Second Quarter

     69.70         58.75         69.95         59.60         10.60         8.23   

2012 Third Quarter

     67.00         55.95         67.80         55.90         10.05         8.23   

2012 Fourth Quarter

     64.90         55.55         66.85         56.60         10.21         8.31   

2013 First Quarter

     84.55         62.90         86.40         64.50         13.46         9.78   

2013 Second Quarter

     80.20         69.65         83.15         72.40         12.60         10.67   

2013 Third Quarter

     86.95         71.00         90.95         74.10         14.22         11.26   

2013 Fourth Quarter

     82.75         50.00         87.10         76.05         13.71         11.59   

Monthly high and low

                 

October 2013

     82.75         72.15         87.10         76.50         13.71         11.82   

November 2013

     80.00         50.00         83.75         76.85         12.64         11.84   

December 2013

     77.50         71.95         81.90         76.05         12.45         11.59   

January 2014

     78.45         71.55         82.50         75.05         12.58         11.52   

February 2014

     80.20         74.45         84.40         78.35         13.00         11.97   

March 2014

     82.00         76.50         86.25         80.20         13.37         12.52   

 

1) One ADS = 1 Class B share.

Source: NASDAQ OMX Stockholm and NASDAQ New York.

 

133


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

SHAREHOLDERS

As of December 31, 2013, the Parent Company had 516,922 shareholders registered at Euroclear Sweden AB (the Central Securities Depository—CSD), of which 1,008 holders had a US address. According to information provided by our depositary, Citibank, there were 201,138,791 ADSs outstanding as of December 31, 2013, and 4,310 registered holders of such ADSs. A significant number of Ericsson ADSs are held by banks, brokers and/or nominees for the accounts of their customers. As of January 3, 2014, the total number of bank, broker and/or nominee accounts holding Ericsson ADSs was 165,678.

According to information known at year-end 2013, approximately 81% of our Class A and Class B shares were owned by institutions, Swedish and international.

Our major shareholders do not have different voting rights than other shareholders holding the same classes of shares.

As far as we know, the Company is not directly or indirectly owned or controlled by another corporation, by any foreign government or by any other natural or legal person(s) separately or jointly.

 

LOGO

The table shows the total number of shares in the Parent Company owned by the Executive Leadership Team and Board members (including Deputy employee representatives) as a group as of December 31, 2013.

The Executive Leadership Team and Board members, ownership

 

     Number of
Class A
shares
     Number of
Class B
shares
     Voting
rights,
percent
 

The Executive Leadership Team and Board members as a group (32 persons)

     0         828,323         0,01

 

Includes shares held via endowment insurance, for more info see page 114 note 2 For individual holdings, see Corporate Governance Report.

The following table shows share information, as of December 31, 2013, with respect to our 15 largest shareholders, ranked by voting rights, as well as their percentage of voting rights as of December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011.

Largest shareholders, December 31, 2013 and percentage of voting rights, December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

 

Identity of person or group1)

  Number of
Class A

shares
    Of total
Class A
shares,
percent
    Number of
Class B
shares
    Of total
Class B
shares,
percent
    2013
Voting rights,
percent
    2012
Voting rights,
percent
    2011
Voting rights,
percent
 

Investor AB (Investment Management)

    115,762,803        44.23        59,284,545        1.95        21.50        21.37        21.48   

AB Industrivärden (Investment Management)

    86,052,615        32.88        500,000        0.02        15.21        14.96        14.34   

Handelsbankens Pensionsstiftelse

    20,465,220        7.82        0        0.00        3.62        3.72        4.20   

Swedbank Robur Fonder AB

    16,795        0.01        122,129,103        4.01        2.16        2.71        2.79   

AFA Försäkring AB

    11,423,000        4.36        4,465,519        0.15        2.10        2.18        2.31   

BlackRock Fund Advisors

    0        0.00        82,330,468        2.71        1.45        1.37        1.46   

Dodge & Cox, Inc.

    0        0.00        77,028,778        2.53        1.36        1.14        0.96   

AMF Pensionsförsäkring AB

    0        0.00        75,764,586        2.49        1.34        1.26        1.34   

Skandia Liv

    6,406,801        2.45        10,549,642        0.35        1.32        1.31        1.36   

Norges Bank Investment Management

    0        0.00        65,175,818        2.14        1.15        1.36        1.24   

Pensionskassan SHB Försäkringsföreningen

    6,381,570        2.44        0        0.00        1.13        1.13        1.39   

OppenheimerFunds, Inc.

    0        0.00        61,829,103        2.03        1.09        1.10        1.20   

Handelsbanken Fonder AB

    290,578        0.11        44,974,450        1.48        0.85        1.07        0.96   

State Street Global Advisors

    22,824        0.01        43,108,269        1.42        0.77        0.07        0.05   

Aberdeen Asset Managers Ltd.

    0        0.00        40,461,909        1.33        0.71        1.16        1.05   

Others

    14,933,777        5.71        2,355,693,562        77.41        44.25        44.10        43.87   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    261,755,983        100        3,043,295,752        100        100        100        100   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Source: King Worldwide

 

134


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION

The following information is provided to comply with certain requirements of Form 20-F which are not satisfied in full by the information in the Swedish Annual Report.

GENERAL FACTS ON THE COMPANY

Legal name of the Parent Company: Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson (publ). The terms “Ericsson”, the “Company”, the “Group”, “us”, “we”, and “our” all refer to Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and its subsidiaries.

Organization number: 556016-0680

Legal form of the Parent Company: A Swedish limited liability company, organized under the Swedish Companies Act.

Country of incorporation: Sweden.

Date of incorporation: The Parent Company was incorporated on August 18, 1918, as a result of a merger between AB LM Ericsson & Co. and Stockholms Allmänna Telefon AB.

Domicile: Our registered office is Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, SE–164 83 Stockholm, Sweden. Our headquarters are located at Torshamnsgatan 21, Kista, Sweden.

Telephone number: +46 10 719 0000

Website: www.ericsson.com

The information included on our website is not incorporated herein by reference.

Agent in the US: Ericsson Inc., Vice President Legal Affairs, 6300 Legacy Drive, Plano, Texas 75024. Telephone number: +1 972 583 0000.

Shares: Ericsson’s Class A and Class B shares are traded on NASDAQ OMX Stockholm. In the US, our American Depository Shares (ADS), each representing one underlying Class B share, are traded on NASDAQ New York.

Parent Company operations: The business of the Parent Company, Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, consists mainly of corporate management, holding company functions and internal banking activities. Parent Company operations also include customer credit management activities performed by Ericsson Credit AB on a commission basis.

Subsidiaries and associated companies: For a listing of our significant subsidiaries, please see section “Investments”. In addition to our joint venture ST-Ericsson (up until August 2, 2013), we are engaged in a number of minor joint ventures and cooperative arrangements. For more information regarding risks associated with joint ventures, strategic alliances and third-party agreements please see Risk Factors, “Market, Technology and Business Risks”.

Filings in the US: Annual reports and other information are filed with, or furnished to, the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) in the United States, pursuant to the rules and regulations that apply to foreign private issuers. Electronic access to these documents may be obtained from the SEC’s website, www.sec.gov, where they are stored in the EDGAR database.

COMPANY HISTORY AND DEVELOPMENT

Innovating to empower people, business and society

Our origins date back to 1876 when Alexander Graham Bell filed a patent application in the United States for the telephone. The same year, Lars Magnus Ericsson opened a small workshop in Stockholm to repair telegraph instruments and sell his own telephone equipment.

Today, Ericsson is a leading provider of communications equipment, telecom services and support solutions. Our customers, in over 180 countries, are mainly operators of communications networks worldwide. We manage networks, or parts of networks, for one billion subscribers.

EXCHANGE RATES

The following tables provide information with respect to the exchange rate for SEK per USD 1.00, based on the noon buying rate for cable transfers in SEK as certified for customs purposes by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York. The noon buying rate of March 28, 2014, was SEK 6.5024 per USD 1.00. The average is computed using the noon buying rate on the last business day of each month during the period indicated.

Average Exchange rates

 

Year ended December 31

   Average  

2009

     7.6232   

2010

     7.1895   

2011

     6.4263   

2012

     6.7247   

2013

     6.5152   

 

Exchange rates, monthly high and low      

Month

   High      Low  

September 2013

     6.3416         6.6700   

October 2013

     6.3237         6.5130   

November 2013

     6.4922         6.6600   

December 2013

     6.4127         6.5964   

January 2014

     6.5568         6.3476   

February 2014

     6.4764         6.2880   

March 2014 (last available data is for March 28)

     6.5024         6.3394   

Effects of exchange rate fluctuations on our business is described in the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements—Note C20, “Financial Risk Management and Financial Instruments.” Noon buying rates are not used in the preparation of our financial statements.

PRIMARY MANUFACTURING AND ASSEMBLY FACILITIES

We continuously adjust our production capacity to meet expected customer demand. At year-end 2013, our overall capacity utilization was close to 100%. The table “Primary manufacturing and assembly facilities” summarizes where we have major sites and the total floor space at year-end. The majority of the floor space within our production facilities is used for assembly and verification.

Primary manufacturing and assembly facilities

 

     2013      2012      2011  
     Sites      Thousands of
sq meters
     Sites      Thousands
of sq meters
     Sites      Thousands
of sq meters
 

Sweden

     4         67.2         7         125.1         7         125.1   

China

     5         32.8         5         83.5         5         91.1   

Estonia

     1         23.7         1         23.7         1         23.7   

Italy

     1         16.0         1         10.5         2         20.1   

Brazil

     1         25.3         1         37.4         1         33.7   

Mexico

     1         0.8         1         0.6         —           —     

India

     1         24.5         1         25.0         1         25.0   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     14         190.3         17         305.8         17         318.7   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

135


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

OPERATING RESULTS

YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2012 AND 2013

Please refer to Board of Directors’ Report.

YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2011 AND 2012

FINANCIAL RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

Abbreviated income statement

 

     IFRS     Restructuring charges  

SEK billion

   2012     2011     2010     2012      2011      2010  

Net sales

     227.8        226.9        203.3           

Cost of sales

     –155.7        –147.2        –129.1        –2.2         –1.2         –3.4   

Gross income

     72.1        79.7        74.3        –2.2         –1.2         –3.4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross margin %

     31.6     35.1     36.5        

Operating expenses

     –58.9        –59.3        –58.6        –1.2         –2.0         –3.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating expenses as % of sales

     25.8     26.1     28.8        

Other operating income and expenses

     9.0        1.3        2.0        —           —           —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating income before share in earnings of JVs and associated companies

     22.2        21.7        17.6        –3.4         –3.2         –6.8   

Operating margin % before share in earnings of JVs and associated companies

     9.7     9.6     8.7        
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share in earnings of JVs and associated companies

     –11.7        –3.8        –1.2        –0.3         –0.6         –0.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating income

     10.5        17.9        16.5        –3.8         –3.7         –7.3   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating margin %

     4.6     7.9     8.1        

Financial income and expenses, net

     –0.3        0.2        –0.7           

Taxes

     –4.2        –5.6        –4.5           

Net income

     5.9        12.6        11.2           

EPS diluted (SEK)

     1.78        3.77        3.46           
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Sales

2012 was a year with strong growth in Global Services and Support Solutions while Networks had a more challenging year. Sales for comparable units, adjusted for foreign currency exchange rates and hedging, decreased –2%. The acquired Telcordia operation added sales of SEK 4.2 billion, split 50/50 between the segments Global Services and Support Solutions.

In 2012, the Company continued to execute its strategy to leverage its strengths in the growth areas of mobile broadband, managed services as well as OSS and BSS. Due to the current technology cycle in which mobile broadband is being rolled out, the business mix in 2012 continued to include a higher share of coverage business than capacity business. Ericsson was also to a large extent engaged in network modernization projects in Europe with its lower margins.

Sales of CDMA equipment declined –40% to SEK 8.4 (14.0) billion. The decline in CDMA was expected and planned for, following operators migration to LTE. The growth in Global Services is primarily related to continued good momentum in managed services and consulting and systems integration as well as network rollout sales following a high share of coverage projects. The sales growth in Support Solutions is mainly driven by TV and media management, business support solutions (charging solutions) and the acquisition of Telcordia. The segments Global Services and Support Solutions together represented close to 50% of Group sales.

In 2012, five of our ten regions showed growth. The share of software sales was unchanged in 2012, at 23% (23%) of sales while the portion of hardware decreased to 35% (40%) and services increased to 42% (37%) of Group sales. Longer term, the software part is expected to increase following more expansions and upgrades of networks.

IPR (intellectual property rights) revenues showed a favorable development and amounted to SEK 6.6 (6.2) billion.

Seasonality

The Company’s quarterly sales, income and cash flow from operations are seasonal in nature, generally lowest in the first quarter of the year and highest in the fourth quarter. This is mainly a result of the seasonal purchase patterns of network operators.

Most recent five-year average seasonality

 

     First
quarter
    Second
quarter
    Third
quarter
    Fourth
quarter
 

Sequential change

     –21     7     –2     26

Share of annual sales

     23     24     24     30

Gross margin

Gross margin declined to 31.6% (35.1%). The decrease is due to increased share of Global Services sales, higher proportion of coverage than capacity projects and network modernization projects in Europe. Close to 50% of the gross margin decline is related to the increased services share.

Operating expenses

Total operating expenses declined slightly. Excluding acquisitions and restructuring charges, Group operating expenses amounted to SEK 55.1 billion, down –4% from 2011.

To secure continued technology leadership, focus is on innovation and R&D. R&D expenses (see table below) increased slightly due to higher restructuring charges and acquisitions. Selling and administrative expenses represented 11.4% of sales compared to 11.8% in 2011.

Research and development

 

     2012     2011     2010  

Expenses (SEK billion)

     32.8        32.6        31.6   

As percent of Net sales

     14.4     14.4     15.5

Employees within R&D as of December 311)

     24,100        22,400        20,800   

Patents1)

     33,000        30,000        27,000   

 

1) The number of employees and patents are approximate.

 

136


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Operating margin before JVs

Operating margin before share in JV earnings was 9.7% (9.6%). Excluding the gain related to the divestment of the share of Sony Ericsson, operating margin was 6.4%. The negative impact was due to the business mix having more coverage business than capacity business as well as network modernization projects in Europe.

Share in earnings of JVs

ST-Ericsson reported a loss in 2012. Ericsson’s share in ST-Ericsson’s income before tax, adjusted to IFRS, was SEK –3.7 (–2.7) billion. The reported loss of SEK –11.7 billion includes a write-down of investments of SEK 4.7 billion and a provision of SEK 3.3 billion.

Other Operating income and expenses

Other operating income and expenses includes a gain of SEK 7.7 billion related to the divestment of Sony Ericsson. It also includes a gain of SEK 0.2 billion from the divestment of the Multimedia brokering (IPX) operation.

Financial net

The financial net decreased mainly due to negative currency exchange revaluation effects on financial investments and liabilities.

Taxes

The tax rate for the year was 42% (31%) of income after financial items. The high tax rate is due to product and market mix as well as a reduction in corporate tax rate for 2013, decided by the Swedish Parliament. The lower corporate tax rate in Sweden reduced the deferred tax assets with approximately SEK 0.5 billion. Over time, the lower tax rate in Sweden will have a positive impact on taxes.

Net income

Net income decreased primarily due to the negative impact from ST-Ericsson and lower contribution from Networks.

Earnings per share, diluted

Earnings per share decreased –53% to SEK 1.78 (3.77). The Board of Directors proposes a dividend of SEK 2.75 (2.50). This represents an increase of 10% over 2011.

Restructuring charges

Restructuring charges were SEK 3.4 (3.2) billion, excluding joint ventures. Restructuring charges mainly relate to continued execution of the service delivery strategy as well as other ongoing cost reduction measures. Cash outlays that have been provided for were SEK 1.2 (3.2) billion. At the end of the year, cash outlays of SEK 1.2 (1.3) billion remain to be made. Ericsson’s share in ST-Ericsson’s restructuring charges was SEK 0.3 (0.1) billion.

FINANCIAL POSITION

Consolidated balance sheet (abbreviated)

 

December 31, SEK billion

   2012     2011      2010  

Assets

       

Non-current assets, total

     81.7        81.5         83.4   

of which intangible assets

     49.4        44.0         46.8   

of which property, plant and equipment

     11.5        10.8         9.4   

of which financial assets

     8.5        13.7         14.5   

of which deferred tax assets

     12.3        13.0         12.7   

Current assets, total

     193.3        198.8         198.4   

of which inventory

     28.8        33.1         29.9   

of which trade receivables

     63.7        64.5         61.1   

of which other receivables/financing

     24.1        20.7         20.2   

of which short-term investments, cash and cash equivalents

     76.7        80.5         87.2   

Total assets

     275.0 1)      280.3         281.8   

Equity and liabilities

       

Equity

     138.5        145.3         146.8   

Non-current liabilities

     39.1        38.1         38.3   

of which post-employment benefits

     9.5        10.0         5.1   

of which borrowings

     23.9        23.3         27.0   

of which other non-current liabilities

     5.7        4.8         6.2   

Current liabilities

     97.4        97.0         96.8   

of which provisions

     8.4        6.0         9.4   

of which current borrowings

     4.8        7.8         3.8   

of which trade payables

     23.1        25.3         25.0   

of which other current liabilities

     61.1        58.0         58.6   

Total equity and liabilities1)

     275.0        280.3         281.8   

 

1) Of which interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits SEK 38.2 (41.0) billion.

Ericsson’s strategy is to maintain a strong balance sheet, including a sufficiently large cash position to ensure the financial flexibility to invest in future growth and to capture business opportunities. This has been particularly important during the past years’ difficult macroeconomic and financial market situation. By maintaining a strong cash position, the Company gains competitive advantages and can maintain an active strategy for selective acquisitions.

The Company’s capital targets are to have an equity ratio above 40%, to generate a cash conversion rate above 70%, to have a positive net cash position and to achieve solid investment grade ratings.

An important focus area is the monitoring of working capital. Major efforts have been made during the year in order to reduce days sales outstanding and inventory turnover days as well as to increase payable days. The target for days sales outstanding was met, while the other two targets were not achieved. Efforts to further reduce working capital continued in 2013 and the working capital targets are the same as previous years.

For 2011, the dividend was SEK 2.50 per share. The Annual General Meeting 2013 resolved on a dividend of SEK 2.75 per share for 2012. This represents a total dividend of approximately SEK 9.1 (8.2) billion. The proposal reflects year 2012’s earnings and balance sheet structure, as well as coming years’ business plans and economic development, according to Ericsson’s dividend policy.

 

137


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Non-current assets

Intangible assets increased to SEK 49.4 (44.0) billion due to acquisitions during the year. Customer financing, current and non-current, increased to SEK 5.3 (4.2) billion.

Current assets

Inventory levels decreased at the end of the year. At year end, inventory was SEK 28.8 (33.1) billion. The target of inventory turnover days less than 65 days was not reached.

Trade receivables: Days sales outstanding reached 86 (91) days at year end due to strong sales and good collections. The Company’s credit losses have historically been low and continued to be so in 2012.

Net cash decreased by SEK 1.0 billion.

Equity

Equity decreased by SEK –6.8 billion primarily due to the non-cash charge of SEK 8.0 billion related to ST-Ericsson. The equity ratio was maintained at a healthy level of 50.4% (51.8%). Return on equity decreased to 4.1% (8.5%) due to lower profitability. Return on capital employed (ROCE) was 6.7% (11.3%).

Non-current liabilities

Post-employment benefits related to defined benefit plans declined to SEK 9.5 (10.0) billion. In 2012 there was a decrease in discount rates, which was offset as plan assets yielded higher than expected.

Non-current borrowings was almost unchanged at SEK 23.9 (23.3) billion. In 2012, Ericsson performed refinancing activities to extend its average debt maturity profile and to further diversify funding sources:

 

   

Issue of a USD-denominated 1 billion ten-year bond in order to refinance debt maturing in 2012 to 2014

 

   

Repurchase of EUR 441 million related to the 2013 and 2014 EMTN bonds in order to reduce gross debt and optimize net interest

 

   

Repayment of two SEK-denominated bonds with a total of SEK 3.5 billion at maturity

 

   

Taken up a loan with the Nordic Investment Bank of EUR 0.15 billion (or the equivalent in USD). The loan is divided into two equal tranches with seven-year and nine-year maturities respectively.

 

   

Signed loan agreement with the European Investment Bank of EUR 0.5 billion (or the equivalent in USD) with an option for disbursement until April 2014. The loan will mature seven years after disbursement

 

   

The Company also has unutilized committed credit facilities of USD 2.0 billion available, maturing in 2014.

Current liabilities

Provisions increased to SEK 8.4 (6.0) billion. SEK 1.2 (1.3) billion were related to restructuring. The cash outlays of provisions were SEK 3.5 (6.0) billion. The higher amount of provisions is due to a provision of SEK 3.3 billion related to ST-Ericsson. Provisions will fluctuate over time, depending on business mix, market mix and technology shifts.

Payable days decreased to 57 (62) days, reflecting the high level of network rollout where suppliers normally have shorter payment days. The target of payable days of more than 60 days was not met.

Off-balance sheet arrangements

There are currently no material off-balance sheet arrangements that have, or would be reasonably likely to have, a current or anticipated effect on the Company’s financial condition, revenues, expenses, result of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.

 

138


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

CASH FLOW

Cash flow (abbreviated) January 1–December 31

 

SEK billion

   2012     2011     2010  

Net income

     5.9        12.6        11.2   

Income reconciled to cash

     19.0        25.2        23.7   

Changes in operating net assets

     3.0        –15.2        2.9   

Cash flow from operating activities

     22.0        10.0        26.6   

Cash flow from investing activities

     –4.9        4.5        –12.5   

of which capital expenditures, sales of PP&E, product development

     –6.5        –6.1        –5.2   

of which acquisitions/divestments, net

     –2.1        –3.1        –2.8   

of which short-term investments for cash management purposes and other investing activities

     3.7        13.8        –4.5   

Cash flow before financing activities

     17.1        14.5        14.0   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flow from financing activities

     –9.4        –6.5        –5.7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash conversion (Cash flow from operating activities divided by income reconciled to cash)

     116     40     112
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross cash (Cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments)

     76.7        80.5 1)      87.2   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash (Gross cash less interest-bearing liabilities and post-employment benefits)

     38.5        39.5        51.3   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Including loan to ST-Ericsson of SEK 2.8 billion.

Cash conversion

Cash conversion was 116% (40%), above the target of 70%. Cash conversion in 2012 was positively impacted by lower working capital.

Cash flow from operating activities

The operating cash flow was positively impacted by reduced working capital.

Cash flow from investing activities

Cash outlays for regular investing activities increased to SEK –6.5 (–6.1) billion. Acquisitions and divestments during the year were net SEK –2.1 (–3.1) billion, with the major item being the USD 1.15 billion acquisition of Telcordia and the divestment of Sony Ericsson.

Cash flow from short-term investments for cash management purposes and other investing activities was net SEK 3.7 (13.8) billion, mainly attributable to changes between short-term investments and cash and cash equivalents.

Capital expenditures

Annual capital expenditures are normally around 2% of sales. This corresponds to the needs for keeping and maintaining the current capacity level, including the introduction of new technology and methods. Expenditures are largely related to test equipment in R&D units and network operations centers as well as manufacturing and repair operations.

The Board of Directors reviews the Company’s investment plans and proposals.

We believe that the Company’s property, plant and equipment and the facilities the Company occupies are suitable for its present needs in most locations. As of December 31, 2012, no material land, buildings, machinery or equipment were pledged as collateral for outstanding indebtedness.

Capital expenditures 2008–2012

 

SEK billion

   2012     2011     2010     2009     2008  

Capital expenditures

     5.4        5.0        3.7        4.0        4.1   

of which in Sweden

     1.3        1.7        1.4        1.3        1.6   

Share of annual sales

     2.4     2.2     1.8     1.9     2.0

Cash flow from financing activities

Cash flow from financing activities was SEK –9.4 (–6.5) billion, mainly impacted by dividend paid of SEK –8.6 (–7.5) billion. Other financing activities net amounted to SEK –0.8 (1.0) billion. However, substantial refinancing activities were performed during 2012 to extend the average debt maturity profile and to further diversify funding sources. For more information see section “Non-Current Liabilities”, on previous page.

Cash held in countries with exchange controls

The Company holds cash or cash equivalents in countries where exchange controls or legal restrictions apply. These restrictions normally refer to approval procedures prior to cross-border cash transfers. The amount of cash and cash equivalents in such countries is SEK 10.6 (13.9) billion, of which SEK 9.2 (12.8) billion can be used for repayment of external and internal liabilities as well as other operating needs. Therefore, net cash and cash equivalents that are not readily available for use by the Group is SEK 1.4 (1.1) billion.

Gross cash and net cash

The change in gross cash of SEK 3.8 billion is related to ST-Ericsson where loans of SEK 5.0 billion were converted into investments. The net income reconciled to cash was SEK 19.0 (25.2) billion. Net operating assets was SEK 3.0 (–15.2) billion and investing activities SEK –14.7 (–9.9) billion. Dividends to shareholders amounted to SEK –8.6 (–7.5) billion. This resulted in a decrease in net cash of SEK 1.0 billion.

 

139


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

BUSINESS RESULTS—REGIONS

Sales per region and segment 2012 and percent change from 2011

 

     Networks     Global Services     Support Solutions              

SEK billion

   2012     Percent
change
    2012     Percent
change
    2012     Percent
change
    Total
2012
    Percent
change
 

North America

     30.5        6     23.5        27     2.7        103     56.8        16

Latin America

     9.8        –15     10.6        12     1.6        65     22.0        0

Northern Europe and Central Asia

     6.3        –35     4.5        –10     0.5        –6     11.3        –25

Western and Central Europe

     6.2        –21     10.6        3     0.7        –27     17.5        –8

Mediterranean

     9.5        –11     13.0        10     0.8        –42     23.3        –2

Middle East

     6.8        –9     7.3        7     1.5        24     15.6        1

Sub-Saharan Africa

     6.4        10     3.9        14     1.0        16     11.3        12

India

     3.5        –42     2.5        –22     0.5        –14     6.5        –34

North East Asia

     22.4        –19     13.3        34     0.5        0     36.2        –5

South East Asia and Oceania

     8.0        6     6.6        18     0.5        –29     15.1        9

Other1)

     7.9        –14     1.2        –844     3.1        90     12.3        15
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     117.3        –11     97.0        16     13.5        26     227.8        0

Share of total

     51       43       6       100  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Region “Other” includes licensing revenues, sales of cables, broadcast services, power modules and other businesses. In the regional dimension, all of the Telcordia sales are reported in the Support Solutions segment except for North America where it is split 50/50 between Global Services and Support Solutions. The acquired Technicolor Broadcast Service Division is reported in region “Other”. Multimedia brokering (IPX) was previously reported in each region in segment Support Solutions. For the first three quarters 2012 it was part of region “Other”. Multimedia brokering (IPX) was divested end of Sept. 2012.

BUSINESS RESULTS—SEGMENTS

Networks

Sales

Sales were SEK 117.3 (132.4) billion following a strong 2011. The decline is primarily related to lower sales in China, Russia, India and South Korea. North America grew despite the –40% decline in CDMA equipment sales. The IP portfolio developed favorably, especially packet core products.

The decline in sales of CDMA equipment was expected. Sales of CDMA equipment amounted to SEK 8.4 (14.0) billion. In CDMA, the priority has been to support customers’ migration to Ericsson’s LTE solution and excel in life-cycle management. Ericsson is today a key supplier to all four major operators in North America.

Profitability

Operating margin decreased due to lower sales as well as negative impact from a business mix with more coverage than capacity projects. In addition, modernization projects in Europe impacted profitability negatively.

Business in 2012

In 2012, Ericsson maintained its share of global installed base of radio base stations of close to 40%, which is almost the size of number two and three combined.

For the key market areas the Company addresses: Radio, IP and Transport as well as Core, preliminary market data indicates that the combined market share was 24%, down from 27% in 2011. The decline is due to a lower market share in the mobile network equipment market; from 38% in 2011 to 35% in 2012, negatively impacted by the technology shift in China, where investments are moving from GSM to other technology areas where Ericsson has limited presence.

Operators’ focus on improving network performance and on service differentiation has been a main driver for mobile broadband investments throughout the year.

In 2012, AIR, the world’s first commercially deployed antenna-integrated radio and part of the RBS 6000 family, met accelerating demand. AIR provides enhanced radio performance and ease of deployment.

After the initial large-scale LTE rollouts in the US, Korea and Japan, Ericsson is now starting to see other countries following. Late 2012, Latin America started LTE rollouts and after executing awarded contracts Ericsson will have a strong LTE footprint in Latin America, substantially higher than its 3G market share in the region.

Up until the end of 2011, Ericsson had won a total of 38 contracts for LTE on five continents.

At the end of 2012, Ericsson had won more than 120 contracts for LTE on six continents. More than 60 LTE networks were in commercial use.

Ericsson´s global market share for LTE was twice as big as the largest competitor, measured in shipments for full year 2012.

In 2012, Ericsson put the world’s first converged multi-standard radio base station for LTE FDD/TDD into commercial operation.

The demand for IMS is increasing as operators are preparing to launch Voice over LTE (VoLTE). Ericsson has a number of contracts for VoLTE.

The demand for circuit-switched core will continue to decline.

During the year, the Smart Services Router (SSR) gained good traction and 39 contracts were signed.

Competitors

In the Networks segment, Ericsson competes mainly with telecommunication equipment suppliers such as Alcatel-Lucent, Cisco, Huawei, Juniper, Nokia Siemens Networks, Samsung and ZTE. The Company also competes with local and regional manufacturers and providers of telecommunications equipment.

Global Services

Two subareas are reported in Global Services: Professional Services and Network Rollout. Professional Services includes Managed services, Customer Support as well as Consulting and Systems Integration.

Sales

Sales were SEK 97.0 (83.9) billion.

The growth in Professional Services is mainly related to continued good momentum in Managed Services as well as in Consulting and Systems Integration. Operators continue to focus on increasing operational efficiency and reducing operating expenses through transformation activities in the voice, IP and OSS and BSS domains which drive demand for managed services and consulting and systems integration. More than 60% of Professional Services sales were recurrent.

 

140


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

The increase in Network Rollout is related to major activities in North East Asia, North America and Europe reflecting the high coverage project activity.

Profitability

Global Services’ operating margin development was stable, despite the continued loss in Network Rollout, due to continued efficiency gains and higher sales in Professional Services. Professional Services has over the past years shown an operating margin of 11–14%. Network Rollout is a low-margin business due to its high level of third-party suppliers for services such as civil works. The losses in 2012 are mainly a consequence of network modernization projects in Europe.

Restructuring charges from continuous transformation of the service delivery organization is a natural part of the services business.

Business in 2012

Market demand for services continued to grow in both subareas. Ericsson also strengthened its capabilities to address new markets and customers in areas such as IT Managed Services and Broadcast Services. The Company’s capability to deliver services remotely from the four global services centers expanded with the establishment of two new global network operation centers in Asia and Latin America.

The telecom services market is highly fragmented with a few global, but many local suppliers. In telecoms services, internal market data indicates that the Company reached a market share of 13% and is larger than any of its competitors in this fragmented market.

During 2012, 52 (70) managed services contracts were signed of which 19 (32) were expansions or extensions. In 2012, 24 (34) significant consulting and systems integration contracts were signed. At year end, there were approximately 950 (900) million subscribers in networks managed by Ericsson. Approximately 550 (500) million subscribers were in network operations contracts.

The number of services professionals also increased during the year from 56,000 end of 2011 to 60,000 end of 2012. The strategy to industrialize the service delivery continues and the capability of remote delivery has now reached a level of 23% in 2012 compared with 17% in 2011. This increases capacity and provides economies of scale.

Competitors

Competition in services includes the traditional telecommunication equipment suppliers. The Company also competes with companies such as Accenture, HP, IBM, Oracle, Tata Consultancy Services and Tech Mahindra. Among the competition is also a large number of smaller but specialized companies operating on a local or regional basis.

Support Solutions

SALES

Sales were SEK 13.5 (10.6) billion. Sales development was good in all four strategic focus areas, i.e. OSS, BSS, TV and Media Management and M-Commerce.

The acquired Telcordia operation added sales of SEK 2.1 billion, representing 50% of Telcordias total sales. The divested Multimedia brokering business (IPX) contributed with sales of SEK 1.2 billion for the first nine months of the year.

Profitability

Increased sales and execution on the new strategy, as well as portfolio streamlining and efficiency improvement, generated a higher operating margin. The divestment of IPX generated a capital gain of SEK 0.2 billion.

Business in 2012

The segment changed name in 2012 from Multimedia to Support Solutions following a change of strategy. Focus is now on OSS and BSS solutions, TV and Media management and M-Commerce.

Ericsson has a leading position in both OSS and BSS.

In BSS, Ericsson has 280 charging and billing installations which at year end served two billion subscriptions. Ericsson’s market share in prepaid is 31%.

In the media market, Ericsson is number one in broadcast video contribution, distribution and satellite direct-to-home. Customers include BSkyB, Chunghwa Telecom, Telekom A1, DirecTV, EBU and ESPN.

In M-Commerce, Ericsson is offering a mobile wallet platform and hosted services for interoperability between mobile and financial services. In 2012, the Company signed agreements for wallet payments with Western Union and MTN.

Competitors

The markets for BSS, OSS, TV and Media management and M-Commerce are fragmented with many local players. Competitors vary depending on the solution being offered. In the OSS and BSS market, they include many of the traditional telecommunication equipment suppliers as well as IT suppliers, such as Amdocs, Comverse and Oracle. Competition in the TV business includes Harmonic and Harris. Competition in M-Commerce includes Comviva, Sybase, Infosys and Gemalto.

The JV ST-Ericsson

ST-Ericsson was a 50/50 joint venture between STMicroelectronics and Ericsson, established in 2009. The Ericsson share of ST-Ericsson’s results was accounted for according to the equity method. ST-Ericsson’s main competitor was Qualcomm.

In December 2012, STMicroelectronics announced its intention to exit as a shareholder in ST-Ericsson. On the same day, Ericsson announced that it would continue to work together with STMicroelectronics to find a suitable strategic solution for ST-Ericsson. In December, Ericsson also stated that it would not acquire the full majority of ST-Ericsson and that the Company intended to write down investments and make a provision related to its 50% stake in ST-Ericsson.

This resulted in a non-cash charge of SEK 8.0 billion in 2012. The charge included write-down of SEK 4.7 billion of investments to reflect the best estimate of Ericsson’s share of the fair market value of the joint venture. The charge also included a provision of SEK 3.3 billion related to the available strategic options at hand for the future of the ST-Ericsson assets. As of year-end 2012, there were no more investments related to ST-Ericsson on Ericsson’s balance sheet.

Ericsson continues to believe that the modem technology, which it originally contributed to the JV, has a strategic value to the wireless industry.

Business and financial performance in 2012

Early 2012, ST-Ericsson set a new strategic direction aiming at lowering its break-even point and introducing new technologies as well as developing competitive system solutions either directly or with partners.

During 2012, ST-Ericsson reached key maturity milestones with its advanced LTE modem. The NovaThor ModAp is the world’s fastest integrated LTE modem and application processor platform. The ModAp delivers industry-leading performance while improving battery life.

ST-Ericsson sales in 2012 decreased –18% to USD 1.4 (1.7) billion. The operating loss for the year, adjusted for restructuring charges, was USD –0.8 (–0.7) billion. Adjustments for IFRS compliance mainly consist of capitalization of R&D expenses for hardware development.

ST-Ericsson’s net financial position was USD 37 (–798) million at year-end, reflecting the cancellation of the parents’ loan facility. Ericsson’s share in ST-Ericsson’s income before taxes, adjusted to IFRS, was SEK –11.7 (–2.7) billion including the non-cash charge of SEK 8.0 billion.

The JV Sony Ericsson

In February 2012, Ericsson announced the completion of the divestment of its 50% stake in Sony Ericsson Mobile Communications to Sony. The agreed cash consideration for the transaction was EUR 1.05 billion. The deal includes a broad IPR cross-licensing agreement.

 

141


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Sony Ericsson was consolidated until December 31, 2011, according to the equity method.

The divestment resulted in a gain of SEK 7.7 billion and a positive cash flow effect of SEK 9.1 billion.

MEMORANDUM AND ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson is registered under no. 556016–0680 in the Company Register kept by the Swedish Companies Registration Office. Our Company’s objective and purposes are described in §2 of the Articles of Association.

Our Articles of Association do not stipulate anything regarding:

 

   

a director’s power to vote on a proposal, arrangement, or contract in which the director is materially interested

 

   

our directors’ power to vote for compensation to themselves

 

   

our directors’ borrowing powers

 

   

retirements rules for our directors or

 

   

the number of shares required for a director’s qualification.

Applicable provisions are found in the Swedish Companies Act, as referred to in “Certain Powers of Directors and the President” below.

There are no age limit restrictions for directors and they are not required to own any shares in the Company.

Share Capital, Increases of Share Capital and Preferential Rights of Shareholders

The Articles of Association of Ericsson provide that the share capital of the Company may not be less than SEK 6,000,000,000 nor more than SEK 24,000,000,000, and that the number of shares in the Company shall amount to no less than 3,000,000,000 and no more than 12,000,000,000. The registered share capital is SEK 16,525,258,678 and the Company has in total issued 3,305,051,735 shares.

The Company’s shares are divided into three series: Class A shares, Class B shares and Class C shares; however, no Class C shares are currently outstanding. Under the Swedish Companies Act (2005:551) (the “Swedish Companies Act”), shareholders must approve each issue of additional shares either by deciding on the share issue at a shareholders’ meeting, or by a shareholders’ approval of a decision on a share issue by the Board, or by giving an authorization to the Board to decide about a share issue. If we decide to issue new Class A, Class B and Class C shares by means of a cash issue, or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, Class A, Class B and Class C shareholders (except for Ericsson and its subsidiaries, in the event they hold shares in Ericsson) have a primary preferential right to subscribe for new shares of the same type in relation to the number of shares previously held by them. Shares not subscribed for through a preferential right shall be offered to all shareholders for subscription on a pro rata basis. If we decide to issue new shares of only one series by means of a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, all shareholders, regardless of whether their shares are Class A, Class B or Class C, are entitled to a preferential right to subscribe for new shares in proportion to the number of shares previously held by them. Shareholders may vote to waive shareholders’ preferential rights at a general meeting.

If we decide to issue warrants or convertibles through a cash issue or an issue against payment through set-off of claims, the shareholders have preferential rights to subscribe to warrants as if the issue were of the shares that may be subscribed to pursuant to the warrant and, respectively, preferential rights to subscribe to convertibles as if the issue were of the shares that the convertibles may be converted to.

The above does not constitute any restriction to waive the shareholders’ preferential rights when deciding on either a cash issue, an issue against payment through set-off of claims, an issue of warrants or an issue of convertibles.

Dividends

Our Class A and Class B shareholders have the same right to dividends, while Class C shareholders have a right to a yearly dividend as described in article 15 of our Articles of Association. No Class C shares are currently outstanding.

Under Swedish law, only a general meeting of shareholders may decide on payment of dividends, which may not exceed the amount proposed by the Board of Directors (except in certain limited circumstances), and may only be paid from funds legally available for that purpose. Under Swedish law, no interim dividends may be paid in respect of any fiscal period for which audited financial statements of the company have not yet been adopted by the annual general meeting of shareholders. The market practice in Sweden is for dividends to be paid annually. Under the Swedish Companies Act, dividends to shareholders and other transfers of value from a company—such as purchases of own shares (see below)—may only be made in case the company’s restricted equity remains fully covered after the transfer of value has been made. The calculation shall be based upon the most recently adopted balance sheet, and any changes in the restricted equity that has occurred after the balance sheet date shall be taken into account. In addition, dividends to shareholders and other transfers of value from the company may only be made if this is justifiable taken into account the type of business activities of the company, their scope and risks related thereto and the company’s need for financial resources, its liquidity and financial position. In respect of parent companies, also the business activities of the group, their scope and risks related thereto and the group’s need for financial resources, its liquidity and financial position should be taken into account.

The Company’s shares are registered in the computerized book-entry share registration system administered by Euroclear Sweden AB (“Euroclear”). The rights attached to shares eligible for dividends accrue to those persons whose names are recorded in the register of shareholders on the record day. The dividends are then sent to a specified account as directed by the person registered with Euroclear, or to the address of that person. The relevant record day must, in most circumstances, be specified in the resolution declaring a dividend or resolving upon a capital increase or any similar matter in which shareholders have preferential rights, or the Board of Directors must be authorized to determine the relevant record day.

Where the registered holder is a nominee, the nominee receives, for the account of the beneficial owner, dividends and, on issues of shares with preferential rights for the shareholders, shares, as well as rights. Dividends are remitted in a single payment to the nominee who is responsible for the distribution of such dividends to the beneficial owner. A similar procedure is adopted for share issues. Specific authority to act as a nominee must be obtained from Euroclear. The nominee must issue a public report to Euroclear every third month, listing all beneficial holders of more than 500 shares. Euroclear is required to keep a register with regard to any holding on behalf of a single beneficial owner in excess of 500 shares in any one company. This list must reveal the names of the beneficial owner and must be open to public inspection.

Voting

In a general meeting of Ericsson, each Class A share shall carry one vote, each Class B share one tenth of one vote and each Class C share one-thousandth of one vote.

We are required to publish notices to attend annual general meetings no earlier than six weeks and no later than four weeks prior to the annual general meeting and the same notice period requirements apply regarding extraordinary general meetings concerning changes in our articles of association. Notices to attend other types of extraordinary general meetings at Ericsson must be published no earlier than six weeks and no later than three weeks prior to the general meeting.

Directors are elected during the annual general meeting for a period of one year at a time and do not stand for reelection at staggered intervals.

A shareholder may attend and vote at the meeting in person or by proxy. For companies whose shares are registered in a central securities

 

142


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

depositary register, proxies are valid for up to five years from the date of issuance. Any shareholder wishing to attend a general meeting must notify us no later than on the day specified in the notice, preferably before 4:00 p.m. (CET). We are required to accept all notifications of attendance received at least five business days (Saturdays normally included) prior to the meeting. A person designated in the register as a nominee (including the depositary of the ADSs) is not entitled to vote at a general meeting, nor is a beneficial owner whose share is registered in the name of a nominee (including the depositary of the ADSs) unless the beneficial owner first arranges to have such owner’s own name entered in the register of shareholders maintained by Euroclear no later than the designated record day.

Under the Swedish Companies Act, resolutions are passed by a simple majority of votes cast at the meeting with the chairman of the meeting having a decisive vote (except in respect of elections), unless otherwise required by law or a company’s articles of association. Under the Swedish Companies Act, certain resolutions require special quorums and majorities, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

  A a resolution to amend the articles of association requires a majority of two-thirds of the votes cast as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting, except in those circumstances described in B—D below;

 

  B a resolution to amend the articles of association which reduces any shareholder’s rights to profits or assets, restricts the transferability of shares or alters the legal relationship between shares, normally requires the unanimous approval of the shareholders present at the meeting and who hold nine-tenths of all outstanding shares;

 

  C a resolution to amend the articles of association for the purpose of limiting the number of shares with which a shareholder may vote at a general meeting or allocating part of the net profit for the fiscal year to a restricted fund or limiting the use of the company’s profits or assets in a liquidation or dissolution, normally requires the approval of shareholders representing two-thirds of the votes cast and nine-tenths of the shares represented at the meeting;

 

  D a resolution of the kind referred to under B or C above may, however, be taken with a lower supermajority requirement if the amendments referred to therein will only adversely affect specific shares or classes of shares. In such cases, the requirement under a above will apply together with the following separate supermajority: (a) where only a class of shares is adversely affected, approval of the owners of one-half of all shares of such class and nine-tenths of the shares of such class represented at the meeting, or (b) where the shares adversely affected do not constitute a class of shares, the unanimous approval of all such affected outstanding shares present at the meeting and who hold nine-tenths of all outstanding shares adversely affected;

 

  E a resolution to issue, approve or authorize the issuance for cash of new shares, warrants or convertibles with a deviation from the preferential right for existing shareholders requires a two-thirds majority of votes cast at the meeting as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting;

 

  F a resolution to reduce the outstanding share capital requires a two-thirds majority of votes cast at the meeting as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting. In case there are several classes of shares in a company, the above described majority requirement shall apply also within each share class represented at the meeting and for which the rights of the shares are adversely affected; and

 

  G a resolution to approve a merger requires a two-thirds majority of the votes cast at the meeting and two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting (however, under certain circumstances a higher majority is required).

At a general meeting of shareholders, a shareholder or proxy for one or more shareholders may cast full number of votes represented by the holder’s shares.

Purchase of Own Shares

A Swedish public limited liability company whose shares are traded on a regulated market place within the European Economic Area (“EEA”) or a market place comparable to a regulated market place outside the EEA is entitled to purchase its own shares under certain conditions. A purchase by us of our own shares may take place only if (a) the purchase has been decided upon by a general meeting of shareholders or the Board has been authorized by a general meeting of shareholders, in both cases by a two thirds majority of votes cast at the meeting as well as two-thirds of the shares represented at the meeting, (b) the purchase is effected on a regulated market place within the EEA or a market place comparable to a regulated market place outside the EEA (in the latter case with the approval of the Swedish Financial Supervisory Authority the “SFSA”) or pursuant to an offer to all shareholders or holders of a specific class of shares, (c) the Company’s restricted equity will still be fully covered and the purchase is justifiable taken into account the type of business activities of the Company and the group, their scope and risks related thereto and the Company’s and the group’s need for financial resources, its liquidity and financial position, and (d) we and our subsidiaries do not hold or, as a result of purchase, will not hold in excess of 10% of all our outstanding shares. As of December 31, 2013, the Company held an aggregate of 73,968,178 treasury stock of Class B shares.

Investment Restrictions

There are no limitations imposed by Swedish law or by our Articles of Association in respect of the rights of non-residents or foreign persons to purchase, own or sell securities issued by us.

There are, however, certain flagging and ownership examination rules that apply, irrespective of nationality.

Pursuant to the Swedish Financial Instruments Trading Act any change in a holding of shares, depository receipts with voting rights or financial instruments that entitle the holder to acquire shares in issue in a Swedish limited liability company whose shares are admitted for trading on a regulated market place within the EEA shall be reported by the holder to the company and the SFSA, where the change entails that the holder’s portion of all shares or votes in the company reaches, exceeds or falls below any of the limits of 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 50, 66 2/3 or 90 per cent. Such a change should, as a main rule, be reported not later than the trading day following the day on which the party with a duty to report has entered into an agreement for the acquisition or transfer of shares or any other change to the shareholding has occurred.

In addition, the Act on Reporting Obligations Regarding Certain Holdings of Financial Instruments requires, among other things, certain individuals who own shares representing 10% or more of the share capital or the voting rights in a Swedish public limited liability company whose shares are traded on a regulated market within the EEA to report such ownership to the SFSA, which keeps a public register based on the information contained in such reports, and also to report any changes in such ownership within five business days.

EXCHANGE CONTROLS

There is no Swedish legislation affecting a) the import or export of capital or b) the remittance of dividends, interest or other payments to nonresident holders of our securities except that, subject to the provisions in any tax treaty, dividends are subject to withholding tax.

TAXATION

General

The taxation discussion set forth below does not purport to be a complete analysis or listing of all potential tax effects relevant to the acquisition, ownership or disposition of Class B shares or ADSs. The statements of United States and Swedish tax laws set forth below are based on the laws in force as of the date of this report and may be subject to any changes in United States or Swedish law, and in

 

143


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

any double taxation convention or treaty between the United States and Sweden, occurring after that date, which changes may then have retroactive effect.

Specific tax provisions may apply for certain categories of tax payers. Your tax treatment if you are a holder of Class B shares or ADSs depends in part on your particular situation. If you are a holder of Class B shares or ADSs, you should therefore consult a tax advisor as to the tax consequences relating to your particular circumstances resulting from the ownership of Class B shares or ADSs.

The tax consequences to holders of ADSs, as discussed below, apply equally to holders of Class B shares.

Certain Swedish Tax Considerations

This section describes the material Swedish income and net wealth tax consequences for a holder of ADSs or Class B shares who is not considered to be a Swedish resident for Swedish tax purposes. This section applies to you only if you are a holder of portfolio investments representing less than 10% of capital and votes and is not applicable if the ADSs or Class B shares pertain to a permanent establishment or fixed place of business in Sweden.

Taxation on Capital Gains

Generally, non-residents of Sweden are not liable for Swedish capital gains taxation with respect to the sale of ADSs or Class B shares. However, under Swedish tax law, capital gains from the sale of shares in Swedish companies and certain other securities by an individual may be taxed in Sweden at a rate of 30% if the seller has been a resident of Sweden or has lived permanently in Sweden at any time during the year of the sale or the 10 calendar years preceding the year of the sale (absent treaty provisions to the contrary). The provision is applicable on ADSs or Class B shares. From 1 January 2008 the rule has been extended so that it also applies to shares in foreign companies, provided that the shares were acquired during the time that the person was liable to tax in Sweden.

This provision may, however, be limited by tax treaties that Sweden has concluded with other countries. Under the tax treaty between Sweden and the United States (the “U.S. Tax Treaty”), this provision applies for ten years from the date the individual became a non-resident of Sweden.

Taxation on Dividends

A Swedish dividend withholding tax at a rate of 30% is imposed on dividends paid by a Swedish corporation, such as us, to non-residents of Sweden. The same withholding tax applies to certain other payments made by a Swedish corporation, including payments as a result of redemption of shares and repurchase of stock through an offer directed to its shareholders. Exemption from the withholding tax or a lower tax rate may apply by virtue of a tax treaty. Under the U.S. Tax Treaty, the withholding tax on dividends paid on portfolio investments to eligible U.S. holders is reduced to 15%.

Under all Swedish tax treaties, except the tax treaty with Switzerland, withholding tax at the applicable treaty rate should be withheld by the payer of the dividends. With regard to dividends paid from shares in corporations registered with the Euroclear Sweden (such as our shares), a reduced rate of dividend withholding tax under a tax treaty is generally applied at the source by the Euroclear Sweden or, if the shares are registered with a nominee, the nominee, as long as the person entitled to the dividend is registered as a non-resident and sufficient information regarding the tax residency of the beneficial owner is available to the Euroclear Sweden or the nominee.

In those cases where Swedish withholding tax is withheld at the rate of 30% and the person who received the dividends is entitled to a reduced rate of withholding tax under a tax treaty, a refund may be claimed from the Swedish tax authorities before the end of the fifth calendar year following the year that the distribution was made.

Taxation on Interest

No Swedish withholding tax is payable on interest paid to non-residents of Sweden.

Net Wealth Taxation

The Swedish net wealth tax has been abolished from 1 January 2007.

Certain United States Federal Income Tax Consequences

The following discussion is a summary of the material United States federal income tax consequences relevant to the ownership and disposition of ADSs or Class B shares. This discussion is based on the tax laws of the United States (including the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), its legislative history, existing and proposed regulations thereunder, published rulings and court decisions) as in effect on the date hereof, all of which are subject to change, possibly with retroactive effect. The discussion is not a full discussion of all tax considerations that may be relevant to the ownership and disposition of ADSs or Class B shares. The discussion applies only if you will hold the ADSs and/or the Class B shares as capital assets and you use the USD as your functional currency. It does not deal with the tax treatment of investors subject to special rules, such as grantor trusts, real estate investment trusts, regulated investment companies, banks, brokers or dealers in securities or currencies, traders in securities that elect to use a mark-to-market method of recording for their securities holdings, financial institutions, insurance companies, tax-exempt entities, investors liable for alternative minimum tax, holders (either actually or constructively) of 10% or more of the voting power of our shares, persons holding ADSs and/or Class B shares as part of a hedging, straddle, conversion or constructive sale transaction and persons who are resident or ordinarily resident in Sweden. In addition, investors holding ADSs and/or Class B shares indirectly through partnerships are subject to special rules not discussed below. You should consult your own tax advisors about the United States federal, state, local and foreign tax consequences to you of the ownership and disposition of the ADSs or Class B shares.

The discussion below applies to you only if you are a beneficial owner of ADSs and/or Class B shares not resident in Sweden for purposes of the U.S. Tax Treaty and you are, for United States federal income tax purposes, (1) a citizen or resident of the United States, (2) a corporation or any other entity treated as a corporation that is organized in or under the laws of the United States or its political subdivisions, including the District of Columbia, (3) a trust if all of the trust’s substantial decisions are subject to the control of one or more United States persons and the primary supervision of the trust is subject to a United States court, or if a valid election is in effect with respect to the trust to be taxed as a United States person, or (4) an estate the income of which is subject to United States federal income taxation regardless of its source.

The discussion below assumes that the representations contained in the deposit agreement governing the ADSs are true and that the obligations in the deposit agreement and any related agreement will be complied with in accordance with the terms. If you hold ADSs, you will be treated as the holder of the underlying Class B shares represented by those ADSs for United States federal income tax purposes.

Dividends

Subject to the passive foreign investment company rules discussed below, the gross amount of dividends paid (before reduction for any Swedish withholding taxes) with respect to the ADSs or Class B shares generally will be included in your gross income as ordinary income from foreign sources to the extent paid out of our current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for United States federal income tax purposes). Distributions in excess of earnings and profits will be treated as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of your adjusted tax basis in the ADSs or Class B shares and thereafter as capital gain. The dividends will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction

 

144


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

available to corporations in respect of dividends received from other U.S. corporations. The amount of any dividend paid in SEK will be the USD value of the dividend payment based on the exchange rate in effect on the date of receipt (or constructive receipt) by you, in the case of Class B shares or by the depositary, in the case of ADSs, whether or not the payment is converted into USD at that time. Your tax basis in the SEK received will equal such USD amount. Gain or loss, if any, recognized on a subsequent sale or conversion of the SEK will be U.S. source ordinary income or loss.

If you are a non-corporate holder of ADSs or Class B shares, dividends you receive on the ADSs or Class B shares may be taxed at the lower applicable capital gains rate provided that (1) we are not a passive foreign investment company (as discussed below) for either our taxable year in which the dividend was paid or the preceding taxable year, (2) certain holding period requirements are met, (3) you are not under any obligation to make related payments with respect to substantially similar or related property and (4) either (a) in the case of ADSs our ADSs continue to be listed on the Nasdaq Stock Market (or a national securities exchange that is registered under section 6 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) or (b) we are eligible for the benefits of the U.S. Tax Treaty. You should consult your own tax advisors regarding the availability of the lower rate for dividends paid with respect to ADSs or Class B shares.

Subject to certain limitations, you will generally be entitled to receive credit against your United States federal income tax liability (or a deduction against your United States federal taxable income) with respect to any Swedish tax withheld in accordance with the U.S. Tax Treaty and paid over to Sweden. If a refund of the tax withheld is available to you under the laws of Sweden or under the U.S. Tax Treaty, the amount of tax withheld that is refundable will not be eligible for such credit against your United States federal income tax liability (and will not be eligible for the deduction in computing your United States federal taxable income). For foreign tax credit limitation purposes, the dividend will be income from sources without the United States, and will generally be treated as “passive category income” (or, in the case of certain holders, “general category income”).

Sale or Exchange of ADSs or Class B shares

Subject to the passive foreign investment company rules discussed below, you will generally recognize capital gain or loss on the sale or other disposition of the ADSs or Class B shares equal to the difference between the USD value of the amount realized and your adjusted tax basis (determined in USD) in the ADSs or Class B shares. Such gain or loss will be capital gain or loss and will generally be treated as arising from U.S. sources for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.

The amount realized on a disposition of ADSs or Class B shares will generally be the amount of cash you receive for the ADSs or Class B shares (which, in the case of payment in a non-U.S. currency, will equal the USD value of the payment received determined on (a) the date of receipt of payment if you are a cash basis taxpayer and (b) the date of disposition if you are an accrual basis taxpayer). If the ADSs or Class B shares are treated as traded on an “established securities market,” if you are a cash basis taxpayer (or, if you are an accrual basis taxpayer, if you so elect) you will determine the USD value of the amount realized by translating the amount received at the spot rate of exchange on the settlement date of the sale.

You will have a tax basis in any foreign currency received equal to the USD amount realized. Any gain or loss you realize on a subsequent conversion of foreign currency will be U.S. source ordinary income or loss.

Passive Foreign Investment Company Status

A non-U.S. corporation is a passive foreign investment company (a “PFIC”) in any taxable year in which, after taking into account the income and assets of certain subsidiaries, either (a) at least 75% of its gross income is passive income or (b) at least 50% of the quarterly average value of its assets is attributable to assets that produce or are held to produce passive income. Based on the market value of our shares, the composition of our assets and income and our operations, we believe we were not a PFIC during the year 2013. However, whether or not we will be considered a PFIC will depend on the nature and source of our income and the value of our assets, as determined from time to time. If we are treated as a PFIC, we will not provide information necessary for the “qualified electing fund” election as the term is defined in the relevant provisions of the Code. You should consult your own tax advisors about the consequences of our potential classification as a PFIC.

If we were classified as a PFIC with respect to your ADSs or Class B shares for any taxable year we would generally continue to be a PFIC (unless certain conditions are met) and you would be subject to special rules with respect to:

 

   

any gain realized on the sale or other disposition of ADSs or Class B shares; or

 

   

any other “excess distribution” made to you (generally, any distributions to you in respect of ADSs or Class B shares during a single taxable year that are, in the aggregate, greater than 125% of the average annual distributions received by you in respect of ADSs or Class B shares during the three preceding taxable years or, if shorter, your holding period for ADSs or Class B shares).

Under these rules:

 

   

the gain or any other excess distribution would be allocated ratably over your holding period for ADSs or Class B shares;

 

   

the amount allocated to the taxable year in which the gain or excess distribution was realized and any year before we became a PFIC would be taxable as ordinary income and

 

   

the amount allocated to each prior year, other than the current year and any taxable year prior to the first taxable year in which we were a PFIC, would be subject to tax at the highest applicable marginal tax rate in effect for each such year; and an interest charge would be imposed.

If we are a PFIC for any taxable year, you will also be deemed to own shares in any of our subsidiaries that are also PFICs in such a year. As an alternative to the special rules described above, holders of “marketable stock” in a PFIC may elect mark-to-market treatment with respect to their ADSs or Class B shares. ADSs or Class B shares will not be considered marketable stock unless they are regularly traded on a qualified exchange or other market. If the mark-to-market election is available and you elect mark-to-market treatment you will, in general, include as ordinary income each year an amount equal to the increase in value of your ADSs or Class B shares for that year (measured at the close of your taxable year) and will generally be allowed a deduction for any decrease in the value of your ADSs or Class B shares for the year, but only to the extent of previously included mark-to-market income. In addition, any gain you recognize upon the sale or other disposition of the ADSs or Class B shares will be treated as ordinary income and any loss will be treated as ordinary loss, but only to the extent of previously included mark-to-market income. Any loss in excess of previously included mark-to-mark income will be treated as a capital loss. However, a mark-to-market election would likely be unavailable with respect to your proportionate share in any of our subsidiaries that are PFICs.

If you own ADSs or Class B shares during any year in which we are a PFIC, you will generally be required to make an annual return on IRS Form 8621.

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

In general, information reporting requirements may apply to dividends paid in respect of ADSs or Class B shares and the proceeds received on the sale or exchange of the ADSs or Class B shares within the United States or by a broker with certain United States connections. Backup withholding may apply to payments to you of dividends paid in respect of ADSs or Class B shares or the proceeds of a sale or other disposition of ADSs or Class B shares if you fail to provide an accurate taxpayer identification number (certified on IRS Form W–9) or, upon request, to

 

145


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

certify that you are not subject to backup withholding, or otherwise to comply with the applicable requirements of backup withholding. The amount of any backup withholding from a payment to you will be allowed as a credit against your United States federal income tax liability and a refund of any excess amount withheld under the backup withholding rules may be obtained by filing the appropriate claim for refund with the IRS and furnishing any required information.

Additional Reporting Requirements

Certain holders who are individuals may be required to report information relating to an interest in ADSs or Class B shares, subject to certain exceptions (including an exception for ADSs or Class B shares held in accounts maintained by certain financial institutions). Holders should consult their tax advisors regarding the effects, if any, of these requirements on their ownership and disposition of ADSs or Class B shares.

DEPOSITARY FEES AND CHARGES

Fees and charges payable by ADS holders

 

    

Service

  

Rate

  

By whom paid

1)    Receipt of deposits and issuance of receipts    Up to USD 5 per 100 American Depositary Shares of fraction thereof    Party to whom receipts are issued
2)    Delivery of deposited shares against surrender of receipts    Up to USD 5 per 100 American Depositary Shares or fraction thereof    Party surrendering receipts
3)    Distribution of Cash Dividends and Cash Proceeds    Up to USD 2 per 100 American Depositary Shares    All holders of American Depositary Shares
4)    Administration of the ADSs    Up to USD 2 per 100 American Depositary Shares per annum    All holders of American Depositary Shares

Except as otherwise provided in the Deposit Agreement, any and all other expenses of the Depositary, including without limitation, expenses or charges for printing, stationery, postage, insurances, cables, etc, are to be borne by the Depositary, or by the Company in accordance with agreements entered into from time to time with the Company.

Fees payable by the Depositary to the Issuer

Citibank N.A. (“Citibank”), as depositary through January 6, 2014, agreed to reimburse Ericsson USD 5 million per year for expenses related to our ADS program (the “Program”), including Program-related legal fees, expenses related to investor relations in the US, US investor presentations, ADS-related financial advertising and public relations, fees and expenses of Citibank as administrator of the ADS Direct Plan, fees in relation to our Form 20-F and SOX compliance.

Citibank further agreed to waive other ADS program related expenses amounting to USD 22,582.94 associated with the administration of the Program.

On January 7, 2014, Ericsson entered into a deposit agreement with Deutsche Bank Trust Company America (“Deutsche Bank”), which replaced Citibank as the depositary of our ADSs. Deutsche Bank has agreed to reimburse Ericsson USD 4.2 million per year for expenses related to our ADS program (the “Program”), including Program-related legal fees, expenses related to investor relations in the US, US investor presentations, fees in relation to the preparation of our Form 20-F and Form 6-K reports and SOX and NASDAQ compliance. In addition, Deutsche Bank has agreed to reimburse Ericsson a percentage of the revenues collected by Deutsche Bank as a result of charging fees from our ADS holders.

Deutsche Bank has further agreed to waive the costs associated with the administration of the Program and reporting services.

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE REQUIREMENTS

Ericsson is subject to a variety of corporate governance requirements. However, it can rely on exemptions from certain U.S. requirements, including those that are different from Swedish Law. Below is an exemption relied upon by Ericsson:

 

   

All members of the audit committee of a NASDAQ-listed company must be independent in accordance with the SEC and the NASDAQ rules. The SEC rules include a specific exemption from these independence requirements for audit committee members who are non-executive employee representatives appointed to the audit committee pursuant to local law.

        The Company relies on this exemption, and it does not consider that such reliance adversely affects the ability of the Audit Committee to act independently or satisfy other SEC requirements. In addition, foreign private issuers such as Ericsson may follow home country practices in lieu of certain NASDAQ corporate governance requirements. Below is a list of practices followed by Ericsson that differ from certain corporate governance requirements under the NASDAQ Marketplace Rules:

 

   

Employee representatives are elected to the Board of Directors and serve on Committees (including the Audit and the Remuneration Committees) in accordance with Swedish law

 

   

Employee representatives on the Board and Committees may attend all Board and respective Committee meetings (including those of the Audit and the Remuneration Committees) in accordance with Swedish laws

 

   

Shareholders participate in the appointment of members of the Nomination Committee in accordance with common Swedish market practice

 

   

The external auditor is proposed by the Nomination Committee in cooperation with the Audit Committee and elected by the shareholders

 

   

No minimum quorum requirements for shareholder meetings, except under certain circumstances.

AUDIT COMMITTEE PRE-APPROVAL POLICIES AND PROCEDURES

The Audit Committee reviews and approves the scope of audits to be performed (external and internal) and analyzes the results and costs of the audits. The Committee makes recommendations to the Board of Directors regarding the auditor’s performance. It also makes recommendations to the Nomination Committee regarding the external auditor’s fees. In order to ensure the auditor’s independence, the Audit Committee has established pre-approval policies and procedures for non-audit related services to be performed by the external auditor. Pre-approval authority may not be delegated to management. The policies and procedures include a list of prohibited services and services that require pre-approval by the Committee. Such services fall into two broad categories:

 

   

General pre-approval—certain services regarding taxes, transactions, risk management, business improvement, corporate finance, attestation and accounting and so called general services. These services have received general pre-approval by the Audit Committee, provided that the estimated fee for each project does not exceed SEK 1 million. The external auditor must advise the Audit Committee of services rendered under the general pre-approval policy.

 

   

Specific pre-approval—all other non-audit related services must receive specific pre-approval. The Audit CommitteeChairman has the delegated authority for specific pre-approval in between Committee meetings, provided that the fee in each case does not exceed SEK 2.5 million. The Chairman reports any pre-approval to the Audit Committee at its next meeting. For matters which may not be handled by the Chairman and require specific pre-approval by the Audit Committee, the auditor submits an application to the Parent Company for final approval by the Audit Committee.

 

146


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

DISCLOSURE PURSUANT TO SECTION 219 OF THE IRAN THREAT REDUCTION AND SYRIA HUMAN RIGHTS ACT OF 2013 (ITRA)

Ericsson has conducted business in Iran/Persia since the late nineteenth century, opened an office in Iran in 1973 and later established a local subsidiary in the country. Ericsson strongly believes in enabling communication for all and believes that access to communications can enable the right to health, education and freedom of expression. Ericsson’s business activities in Iran principally involve the sale of telecommunications infrastructure related products and services, including support, installation and maintenance services. Ericsson’s exports from the European Union (the “EU”) to Iran are performed under export licenses from the Swedish Agency for Non-Proliferation and Export Controls. The EU sanctions towards Iran grant an exemption for the supply of certain telecommunications equipment and software based on which these export licenses are granted.

Due to its operations in Iran, and having staff permanently in the country, Ericsson has contacts with its local customers and retains certain local suppliers and service providers. In addition, Ericsson has other dealings incidental to its local activities, such as making payments for taxes, salaries, rents, utilities and office and similar supplies and customs related services. As a result, Ericsson has contact with companies that may be owned or controlled by the government of Iran. While Ericsson seeks to obtain information regarding the ownership of customers and other counterparties in Iran, it is sometimes difficult to determine ownership and control with certainty, particularly with respect to determining whether an entity engaged in commercial activities is owned or controlled by the government.

During 2013, Ericsson sold telecommunications infrastructure related products and services in Iran to MTNIrancell and to Mobile Communication Company of Iran (“MCCI”), telecommunications companies operating in Iran. During 2013, Ericsson’s gross revenue related to sales to MTNIrancell and MCCI in Iran was approximately SEK 1,483 million. Ericsson does not normally allocate net profit on a country-by-country or activity-by-activity basis, other than as set forth in Ericsson’s consolidated financial statements prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB. However, Ericsson has estimated that its net profit from such sales, after internal cost allocation was less than SEK 160 million during 2013. In light of the recent international developments related to Iran, Ericsson has decided not to execute on the previously anticipated phase out of telecommunications infrastructure related products to customers in Iran. Ericsson intends to continue to engage with existing customers in Iran while continuously evaluating the situation.

In some instances, Ericsson has had to arrange performance bonds or similar financial guarantees to secure Ericsson’s performance of obligations under the commercial agreements Ericsson has entered into relating to the business in Iran. In such instances, Ericsson usually engages its banks outside Iran, who in turn engage local banks in the country. These local banks include Tejarat Bank, Melli Bank and Saderat Bank. Although some bonds and guarantees involving these banks are still in place, no new performance bonds or similar guarantees with respect to Ericsson’s business activities in Iran were issued during 2013, nor were payments made to beneficiaries under any such existing bond or guarantee.

During 2013, Ericsson’s Iranian subsidiary temporarily opened an account in Tejarat Bank for purposes of collecting interest income amounting to approximately SEK 0.6 million earned from Tejarat Bank prior to the closing of the subsidiary’s accounts with that bank in 2012. The account was closed once the amount had been collected and transferred to an account in another bank.

Some payments made to Ericsson’s local subsidiary and payments required to be made by the local subsidiary to suppliers involve banks controlled by the government of Iran, such as Bank Mellat, Tejarat Bank, Bank Melli, Saderat Bank, Keshavarzi Bank, Eghtesad Novin Bank, Refah Bank and Bank Sepah. Ericsson also received payments from customers to Ericsson’s accounts outside Iran.

 

147


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

INVESTMENTS

The following listing shows certain shareholdings owned directly and indirectly by the Parent Company as of December 31, 2013. A complete listing of shareholdings, prepared in accordance with the Swedish Annual Accounts Act and filed with the Swedish Companies Registration Office (Bolagsverket), may be obtained upon request to: Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, External Reporting, SE-164 83 Stockholm, Sweden.

Shares owned directly by the Parent Company

 

Type

 

Company

   Domicile    Percentage
of ownership
    Par value
in local
currency,
million
     Carrying
value,
SEK million
 

Subsidiary companies

          
I   Ericsson AB    Sweden      100        50         20,731   
I   Ericsson Shared Services AB    Sweden      100        361         2,216   
I   Netwise AB    Sweden      100        2         306   
II   AB Aulis    Sweden      100        14         6   
III   Ericsson Credit AB    Sweden      100        5         5   
  Other (Sweden)         —          —           1,847   
I   Ericsson Austria GmbH    Austria      100        4         65   
I   Ericsson Danmark A/S    Denmark      100        90         216   
I   Oy LM Ericsson Ab    Finland      100        13         196   
II   Ericsson Participations France SAS    France      100        26         524   
I   Ericsson Germany GmbH    Germany      100        —           4,232   
I   Ericsson Hungary Ltd.    Hungary      100        1,301         120   
II   LM Ericsson Holdings Ltd.    Ireland      100        2         15   
I   Ericsson Telecomunicazioni S.p.A.    Italy      100        44         5,357   
II   Ericsson Holding International B.V.    The Netherlands      100        222         3,200   
I   Ericsson A/S    Norway      100        75         114   
II   Ericsson Television AS    Norway      100        161         1,788   
I   Ericsson Corporatia AO    Russia      100        5         5   
I   Ericsson España S.A.    Spain      100        43         170   
I   Ericsson AG    Switzerland      100        —           —     
II   Ericsson Holdings Ltd.    United Kingdom      100        328         4,094   
  Other (Europe, excluding Sweden)         —          —           395   
II   Ericsson Holding II Inc.    United States      100        2,830         29,006   
I   Companía Ericsson S.A.C.I.    Argentina      95 1)      41         178   
I   Ericsson Canada Inc.    Canada      100        —           51   
I   Belair Networks    Canada      100        170         170   
I   Ericsson Telecom S.A. de C.V.    Mexico      100        n/a         1,050   
  Other (United States, Latin America)         —          —           67   
II   Teleric Pty Ltd.    Australia      100        20         100   
I   Ericsson Ltd.    China      100        2         2   
I   Ericsson (China) Company Ltd.    China      100        65         475   
I   Ericsson India Private Ltd.    India      100        725         147   
I   Ericsson India Global Services PVT. Ltd    India      100        389         64   
I   Ericsson-LG CO Ltd.    Korea      75        150         3,285   
I   Ericsson (Malaysia) Sdn. Bhd.    Malaysia      70        2         4   
I   Ericsson Telecommunications Pte. Ltd.    Singapore      100        2         1   
I   Ericsson South Africa PTY. Ltd    South Africa      100        —           128   
I   Ericsson Taiwan Ltd.    Taiwan      90        270         36   
I   Ericsson (Thailand) Ltd.    Thailand      49 2)      90         17   
  Other countries (the rest of the world)         —          —           373   
         

 

 

    

 

 

 
  Total              80,756   
         

 

 

    

 

 

 

Joint ventures and associated companies

          
II   ST-Ericsson SA    Switzerland      50        137         —     
I   Rockstar Consortium Group    Canada      21        1         7   
I   Ericsson Nikola Tesla d.d.    Croatia      49        65         330   
         

 

 

    

 

 

 
  Total              337   
         

 

 

    

 

 

 

Key to type of company

 

I Manufacturing, distribution and development companies
II Holding companies
III Finance companies
1) Through subsidiary holdings, total holdings amount to 100% of Compania Ericsson S.A.C.I.
2) Through subsidiary holdings, total holdings amount to 100% of Ericsson (Thailand) Ltd.

 

148


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Shares owned by subsidiary companies

 

Type

  

Company

   Domicile    Percentage
of ownership
 
Subsidiary companies      

II

   Ericsson Cables Holding AB    Sweden      100   

I

   Ericsson France SAS    France      100   

I

   Ericsson Telekommunikation GmbH 1)    Germany      100   

I

   LM Ericsson Ltd.    Ireland      100   

I

   Ericsson Telecommunicatie B.V.    The Netherlands      100   

I

   Ericsson Telekomunikasyon A.S.    Turkey      100   

I

   Ericsson Ltd.    United Kingdom      100   

I

   Ericsson Inc.    United States      100   

I

   Ericsson Wifi Inc.    United States      100   

I

   Drutt Corporation Inc.    United States      100   

I

   Optimi Corporation    United States      100   

I

   Redback Networks Inc.    United States      100   

I

   Telcordia Technologies Inc.    United States      100   

I

   Ericsson Telecomunicações S.A.    Brazil      100   

I

   Ericsson Australia Pty. Ltd.    Australia      100   

I

   Ericsson (China) Communications Co. Ltd.    China      100   

I

   Nanjing Ericsson Panda Communication Co. Ltd.    China      51   

I

   Ericsson Japan K.K.    Japan      100   

I

   Ericsson Communication Solutions Pte Ltd.    Singapore      100   

Key to type of company

 

I Manufacturing, distribution and development companies
II Holding companies

 

149


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

RECONCILIATIONS TO IFRS

This section includes a reconciliation of certain non-IFRS financial measures to the most directly comparable IFRS financial measures. The presentation of non-IFRS financial measures has limitations as analytical tools and should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for our related financial measures prepared in accordance with IFRS.

We present non-IFRS financial measures to enhance an investor’s evaluation of our ongoing operating results, to aid in forecasting future periods and to facilitate meaningful comparison of our results between periods. Our management uses these non-IFRS financial measures to, among other things, evaluate our ongoing operations in relation to historical results, for internal planning and forecasting purposes and in the calculation of certain performance-based compensation.

The non-IFRS financial measures presented in this report may differ from similarly-titled measures used by other companies.

Ericsson EBITA margin

 

SEK billion

   2013     2012     2011     2010     2009  

Net income

     12.2        5.9        12.6        11.2        4.1   

Interest

     0.7        0.3        –0.2        0.7        –0.3   

Tax

     4.9        4.2        5.6        4.5        2.1   

Amortization and write-downs of acquired intangibles

     4.5        4.6        4.5        5.9        7.8   

EBITA

     22.4        15.0        22.4        22.4        13.8   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net sales

     227.4        227.8        226.9        203.3        206.5   

EBITA margin (%)

     9.8     6.6     9.9     11.0     6.7
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Capital employed

 

     2013     2012     2011     2010     2009  

Total assets

     269,190        274,996        280,349        281,815        269,809   

Non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities

          

Provisions, non-current

     –222        –211        –280        –353        –461   

Deferred tax liabilities

     –2,650        –3,120        –2,250        –2,571        –2,270   

Other non-current liabilities

     –1,459        –2,377        –2,248        –3,296        –2,035   

Provisions, current

     –5,140        –8,427        –5,985        –9,391        –11,970   

Trade payables

     –20,502        –23,100        –25,309        –24,959        –18,864   

Other current liabilities

     –58,314        –61,108        –57,970        –58,605        –52,529   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Capital employed

     180,903        176,653        186,307        182,640        181,680   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Return on capital employed           
     2013     2012     2011     2010     2009  

Operating income

     17,845        10,458        17,900        16,455        5,918   

Financial income

     1,346        1,708        2,882        1,047        1,874   

Average capital employed1)

          

Capital employed at January 1

     176,653        186,307        182,640        181,680        182,439   

Capital employed at December 31

     180,903        176,653        186,307        182,640        181,680   

Average capital employed

     178,778        181,480        184,474        182,160        182,060   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Return on capital employed2)

     10.7     6.7     11.3     9.6     4.3
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Average capital employed is the average of the amounts of capital employed at January 1 and December 31.
2) Return on capital employed is the total of operating income and financial income as a percentage of average capital employed.

Gross cash and Net cash

 

      2013      2012      2011      2010      2009  

Cash and cash equivalents

     42,095         44,682         38,676         30,864         22,798   

Short term investments

     34,994         32,026         41,866         56,286         53,926   

Gross cash

     77,089         76,708         80,542         87,150         76,724   

Post-employment benefits

     –9,825         –9,503         –10,016         –5,092         –8,533   

Interest-bearing liabilities

              

Borrowings non-current

     –22,067         –23,898         –23,256         –26,955         –29,996   

Borrowings current

     –7,388         –4,769         –7,765         –3,808         –2,124   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash

     37,809         38,538         39,505         51,295         36,071   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

150


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

Return on equity

 

      2013     2012     2011     2010     2009  

Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company

     12,005        5,775        12,194        11,146        3,672   

Average stockholders’ equity1)

          

Stockholders’ equity at January 1

     136,883        143,105        145,106        139,870        140,823   

Stockholders’ equity at December 31

     140,204        136,883        143,105        145,106        139,870   

Average stockholders’ equity

     138,544        139,994        144,106        142,488        140,347   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Return on equity2)

     8.7     4.1     8.5     7.8     2.6
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1) Average stockholders’ equity is based on the amounts at January 1 and December 31.
2) Return on equity is Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company as a percentage of average Stockholders’ equity (based on the amounts at January 1 and December 31).

Working capital

 

      2013      2012      2011      2010      2009  

Current assets

     190,896         193,254         198,816         198,443         182,442   

Current non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities

              

Provisions, current

     –5,140         –8,427         –5,985         –9,391         –11,970   

Trade payables

     –20,502         –23,100         –25,309         –24,959         –18,864   

Other current liabilities

     –58,314         –61,108         –57,970         –58,605         –52,529   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Working capital1)

     106,940         100,619         109,552         105,488         99,079   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1) Working capital is Current assets less current non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities

Cash conversion

 

             2013     2012     2011     2010     2009  

Cash flow from operating activities

     A         17,389        22,031        9,982        26,583        24,476   

Net income

     B         12,174        5,938        12,569        11,235        4,127   

Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash

     C         9,828        13,077        12,613        12,490        16,856   
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash conversion = A/(B+C)

        79     116     40     112     117
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

151


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

GLOSSARY

2G

The first digital generation of mobile systems. Includes GSM, TDMA, PDC and cdmaOne.

3G

Third generation mobile system. Includes WCDMA/HSPA, CDMA2000 and TD-SCDMA.

4G

See LTE.

Backhaul

Transmission between radio base stations and the core network.

BSS

Business support systems.

CAGR

Compound Annual Growth Rate.

Carrier grade

(Also telecom grade) refers to a system, or a hardware or software component, with at least “five nines”, i.e. 99.999%, availability.

CDMA

Code Division Multiple Access. A radio technology on which the cdmaOne (2G) and CDMA2000 (3G) mobile communication standards are both based.

Cloud

When data and applications reside in the network.

EDGE

An enhancement of GSM. Enables the transmission of data at speeds up to 250 kbps (Evolved EDGE up to 1 Mbps.)

GSM

Global System for Mobile Communications. A first digital generation mobile system.

CO2e

The amount of a particular greenhouse gas, expressed as the amount of carbon dioxide that gives the same greenhouse effect.

EPC

Evolved Packet Core. The core network of the LTE system.

Heterogeneous network

Densification and enhancement of a network to increase capacity.

HSPA

High Speed Packet Access. Enhancement of 3G/WCDMA that enables mobile broadband.

ICT

Information and Communication Technology.

IMS

IP Multimedia Subsystem. A standard for voice and multimedia services over mobile and fixed networks using IP.

IP

Internet Protocol. Defines how information travels between network elements across the internet.

IPR

Intellectual Property Rights.

IPTV

IP Television. A technology that delivers digital television via fixed broadband access.

JV

Joint Venture.

LTE

Long-Term Evolution. 4G; the evolutionary step of mobile technology beyond HSPA, allowing data rate above 100 Mbps.

M-commerce

Mobile commerce.

M2M

Machine-to-machine communication.

Managed services

Management of operator networks and/or hosting of their services.

Mobile broadband

Wireless high-speed internet access using the HSPA, LTE and CDMA2000EV-DO technologies.

Networked Society

Ericsson’s vision of what will happen when everything that can benefit from being connected is connected, empowering people, business and society.

OSS

Operations Support Systems.

Penetration

The number of subscriptions divided by the population in a geographical area.

Psi Y

is a solution for mobile broadband (3G) coverage. The name reflects the shape of the solution with just one radio connected to three antennas.

SDN

Software-Defined Network.

WCDMA

Wideband Code Division Multiple Access. A 3G mobile communication standard. WCDMA builds on the same core network infrastructure as GSM.

xDSL

Digital Subscriber Line technologies for broadband multimedia communications in fixed-line networks. Examples: IP-DSL, ADSL and VDSL.

The terms “Ericsson,” “the Company,” “the Group,” “us,” “we,” and “our” all refer to Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson and its subsidiaries.

 

152


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

FINANCIAL TERMINOLOGY

Capex

Capital expenditure.

Capital employed

Total assets less non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities. (which includes: non-current provisions; deferred tax liabilities; other non-current liabilities; current provisions; trade payables; other current liabilities).

Capital turnover

Net sales divided by average capital employed.

Cash conversion

Cash flow from operating activities divided by the sum of net income and adjustments to reconcile net income to cash, expressed as percent.

Cash dividends per share

Dividends paid divided by average number of basic shares.

Compound annual growth rate (CAGR)

The year-over-year growth rate over a specified period of time.

Days sales outstanding (DSO)

Trade receivables balance at quarter end divided by net sales in the quarter and multiplied by 90 days. If the amount of trade receivables is larger than last quarter’s sales, the excess amount is divided by net sales in the previous quarter and multiplied by 90 days, and total DSO are the 90 days of the most current quarter plus the additional days from the previous quarter.

Earnings per share (EPS)

Basic earnings per share: profit or loss attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings per share: the weighted average number of shares outstanding are adjusted for the effects of all dilutive potential ordinary shares.

EBITA margin

Earnings before interest, taxes, amortization and write-downs of acquired intangibles (intellectual property rights, trademarks and other intangible assets; see Note C10 “Intangible assets”) as a percentage of net sales.

Equity ratio

Equity, expressed as a percentage of total assets.

Gross cash

Cash and cash equivalents plus short-term investments.

Inventory turnover days (ITO days)

365 divided by inventory turnover, calculated as total cost of sales divided by the average inventories for the year (net of advances from customers).

Net cash

Cash and cash equivalents plus short-term investments less interest-bearing liabilities (which include: non-current borrowings and current borrowings) and post-employment benefits.

P/E ratio

The P/E ratio is calculated as the price of a Class B share at last day of trading divided by basic earnings per share.

Payable days

The average balance of trade payables at the beginning and at the end of the year divided by cost of sales for the year, and multiplied by 365 days.

Payment readiness

Cash and cash equivalents and short-term investments less short-term borrowings plus long-term unused credit commitments. Payment readiness is also shown as a percentage of net sales.

Return on capital employed

The total of Operating income plus Financial income as a percentage of average capital employed (based on the amounts at January 1 and December 31).

Return on equity

Net income attributable to stockholders of the Parent Company as a percentage of average Stockholders’ equity (based on the amounts at January 1 and December 31).

Stockholders’ equity per share

Stockholders’ equity divided by the number of shares outstanding at end of period, basic.

Total Shareholder Return (TSR)

The increase or decrease in Class B share price during the period, adjusted for dividends paid, expressed as a percentage of the share price at the start of the period.

Trade receivables turnover

Net sales divided by average trade receivables.

Value at Risk (VaR)

A statistical method that expresses the maximum potential loss that can arise with a certain degree of probability during a certain period of time.

Working capital

Current assets less current non-interest-bearing provisions and liabilities (which include: current provisions; trade payables; other current liabilities).

EXCHANGE RATES

Exchange rates used in the consolidation

 

     January–December  
     2013      2012  

SEK/EUR

     

Average rate

     8.67         8.70   

Closing rate

     8.90         8.58   

SEK/USD

     

Average rate

     6.52         6.73   

Closing rate

     6.46         6.51   

 

153


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION

FOR PRINTED PUBLICATIONS

A printed copy of the Annual Report is provided on request.

Strömberg Distribution

SE-120 88 Stockholm, Sweden

Phone: +46 8 449 89 57

Email: ericsson@strd.se

IN THE UNITED STATES:

Ericsson’s Transfer Agent Deutsche Bank,

Deutsche Bank Shareholder Services

American Stock Transfer & Trust Company

Registered holders: Toll-free number: +1 (800) 937-5449

Interested investors: Direct dial: +1 (718) 921-8124

Email: DB@amstock.com

Ordering a hard copy of the Annual Report: +1 888 301 2504

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson’s shareholders are invited to participate in the Annual General Meeting to be held on Friday, April 11, 2014, at 3 p.m. at Stockholm Waterfront Congress Centre, Nils Ericsons Plan 4, Stockholm, Sweden.

Registration and notice of attendance

Shareholders who wish to attend the Annual General Meeting must:

 

   

Be recorded in the share register kept by Euroclear Sweden AB (the Swedish Securities Registry) on Saturday, April 5, 2014; and

 

   

Give notice of attendance to the Company at the latest on Monday April 7, 2014. Notice of attendance can be given by telephone: +46 8 402 90 54 on weekdays between 10a.m. and 4p.m., or on Ericsson’s website: www.ericsson.com.

Notice of attendance may also be given in writing to:

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson

General Meeting of Shareholders

Box 7835, SE-103 98 Stockholm, Sweden

When giving notice of attendance, please state name, date of birth or registration number, address, telephone number and number of assistants, if any.

The meeting will be conducted in Swedish and simultaneously interpreted into English.

Shares registered in the name of a nominee

In addition to giving notice of attendance, shareholders having their shares registered in the name of a nominee, must request the nominee to temporarily enter the shareholder into the share register as of Saturday, April 5, 2014, in order to be entitled to attend the meeting. Since the record day for attending the meeting is a Saturday, the shareholder should inform the nominee to that effect well before Friday, April 4, 2014.

Proxy

Shareholders represented by proxy shall issue and submit to the Company a power of attorney for the representative. A power of attorney issued by a legal entity must be accompanied by a copy of the entity’s certificate of registration, or if no such certificate exists, a corresponding document of authority. Such documents must not be older than one year unless the power of attorney explicitly provides that it is valid for a longer period, up to a maximum of five years. In order to facilitate the registration at the Annual General Meeting, the original power of attorney, certificates of registration and other documents of authority should be sent to the Company in advance to the address above for receipt by Thursday, April 10 , 2014. Forms of power of attorney in Swedish and English are available on Ericsson’s website: www.ericsson.com/investors.

Dividend

The Board of Directors has decided to propose the Annual General Meeting to resolve on a dividend of SEK 3.00 per share for the year 2013 and that Wednesday, April 16, 2014 will be the record date for dividend.

Financial information from Ericsson

 

Interim reports 2014:

           Q1, April 23, 2014            Q3, October 24, 2014
           Q2, July 18, 2014            Q4, January 27, 2015

Annual Report 2014: March 2015

2013 Form 20-F for the US market: April 2014

WHERE YOU CAN FIND OUT MORE

Information about Ericsson and its development is available on our website: www.ericsson.com.

Annual and interim reports and other relevant shareholder information can be found at: www.ericsson.com/investors

Ericsson headquarters

Torshamnsgatan 21

Kista, Stockholm, Sweden

Registered office

Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson

SE–164 83 Stockholm, Sweden

Investor relations

For questions on the Company,

please contact Investor Relations:

Telephone: +46 10 719 00 00

Email: investor.relations@ ericsson.com.

ERICSSON ANNUAL REPORT 2013:

Project management:

Ericsson Investor Relations

Design and production:

Addison Group and Paues Media

Group Management, Board of Directors

photography: Per Myrehed AB

Reprographics and printing:

Trosa Tryckeri AB 2014

 

154


Table of Contents

Ericsson Annual Report on Form 20-F 2013

 

SIGNATURES

The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this Annual Report on its behalf.

TELEFONAKTIEBOLAGET LM ERICSSON

April 8, 2014

 

By:

 

/s/    ROLAND HAGMAN        

  Roland Hagman

By:

 

/s/    NINA MACPHERSON        

  Nina Macpherson

 

155